SeismoStruct 2021 User Manual - ENG PDF
SeismoStruct 2021 User Manual - ENG PDF
User Manual
2021
Copyright
Copyright © 2002-2021 Seismosoft Ltd. All rights reserved.
SeismoStruct® is a registered trademark of Seismosoft Ltd. Copyright law protects the software and all
associated documentation.
No part of this manual may be reproduced or distributed in any form or by any means, without the
prior explicit written authorisation from Seismosoft Ltd.:
Seismosoft Ltd.
Piazza Castello, 19
27100 Pavia (PV) - Italy
e-mail: [email protected]
website: www.seismosoft.com
Every effort has been made to ensure that the information contained in this Manual is accurate.
Seismosoft is not responsible for printing or clerical errors.
Finally, mention of third-party products is for informational purposes only and constitutes neither an
engagement nor a recommendation.
______________________________________________________________________________________________________________________
Introduction .......................................................................................................................... 10
General ................................................................................................................................. 12
System Requirements ................................................................................................................................................................... 12
Installing/Uninstalling the software ...................................................................................................................................... 12
Opening the software and Registration options ............................................................................................................... 13
Main menu and Toolbar ............................................................................................................................................................... 14
Quick Start ............................................................................................................................ 19
Tutorial n.1 – Pushover Analysis of a Two-Storey Building ........................................................................................ 19
Tutorial n.2 – Pushover Analysis of a Two-Storey Building ........................................................................................ 49
Tutorial n.3 – Dynamic Time-history Analysis of a Two-Storey Building ............................................................. 54
Tutorial n.4 – Pushover Analysis of a Two-Storey Building ........................................................................................ 58
Tutorial n.5 – Eigenvalue Analysis of a Two-Storey Building ..................................................................................... 95
Tutorial n.6 – Dynamic Time-history Analysis of a Two-Storey Building .......................................................... 101
Building Modeller ........................................................................................................................................................................ 107
Basic Settings and Structural Configuration ................................................................................................................ 108
Advanced Settings .................................................................................................................................................................... 109
Building Modeller Main Window ....................................................................................................................................... 112
Insertion of Structural Members ........................................................................................................................................ 114
Editing Structural Members ................................................................................................................................................ 132
Creating New Storeys ............................................................................................................................................................. 134
View 3D Model........................................................................................................................................................................... 135
Other Building Modeller Functions ................................................................................................................................... 135
Saving and Loading Building Modeller Projects .......................................................................................................... 137
Creating SeismoStruct Projects .......................................................................................................................................... 137
Wizard............................................................................................................................................................................................... 138
Structural model and configuration................................................................................................................................. 139
Settings ......................................................................................................................................................................................... 140
Loading ........................................................................................................................................................................................ 140
Exporting and Importing SeismoStruct Projects as XML files ................................................................................. 141
Pre-Processor .......................................................................................................................142
Analysis Types ............................................................................................................................................................................... 142
Pre-Processor area ...................................................................................................................................................................... 143
Units Selector ................................................................................................................................................................................. 144
Editing ............................................................................................................................................................................................... 145
Editing functions ...................................................................................................................................................................... 145
Graphical Input/Generation ................................................................................................................................................ 147
Node/Element Groups ............................................................................................................................................................ 147
3D Plot options .......................................................................................................................................................................... 149
Rotating/moving the 3D model.......................................................................................................................................... 154
Project Settings ............................................................................................................................................................................. 154
General ......................................................................................................................................................................................... 156
Analysis ........................................................................................................................................................................................ 157
Elements ...................................................................................................................................................................................... 159
Constraints.................................................................................................................................................................................. 160
Adaptive Pushover ................................................................................................................................................................... 162
Eigenvalue .................................................................................................................................................................................. 164
6 SeismoStruct User Manual
Pre-Processor Post-Processor
• Materials • Analysis Logs
• Sections • Modal Quantities
• Element Classes • Eigenvalue Results
• Nodes • Target Displacement
• Element Connectivity • Step Output
• Constraints • Deformed Shape Viewer
• Restraints Processor • Convergence Problems
• Time-history Curves • Action Effects Diagrams
• Applied Loading • Global Response Parameters
• Loading Phases • Element Action Effects
• Target Displacement • Stress and Strain Output
• Code-based Checks • IDA Envelope
• Performance Criteria
• Analysis Output
The software is fully integrated with the Windows environment. Input data created in spreadsheet
programs, such as Microsoft Excel, may be pasted to the SeismoStruct input tables, for easier pre-
processing. Conversely, all information visible within the graphical interface of SeismoStruct can be
copied to external software applications (e.g. to word processing programs, such as Microsoft Word),
including input and output data, high quality graphs, the models' deformed and undeformed shapes
and much more.
Finally, with the Building Modeller and Wizard facility the user can create regular/irregular 2D
or 3D models and run all types of analyses on the fly. The whole process takes no more than a few
seconds.
Some of the modelling/analysis features of SeismoStruct are listed below:
Nine different types of analysis, such as dynamic and static time-history, conventional and
adaptive pushover, incremental dynamic analysis, eigenvalue, non-variable static loading,
response spectrum analysis and buckling analysis.
Twenty material models, such as nonlinear concrete models, high-strength nonlinear concrete
model, nonlinear steel models, SMA nonlinear model, etc.
A large library of 3D elements, such as nonlinear fibre beam-column element, nonlinear truss
element, nonlinear infill panel element, nonlinear masonry elements, nonlinear link elements,
Introduction 11
etc., that may be used with a wide variety of pre-defined steel, concrete and composite section
configurations.
Thirty one hysteretic models, such as linear/bilinear/trilinear kinematic hardening response
models, gap-hook models, soil-structure interaction model, Takeda model, Ramberg-Osgood
model, etc.
Code-based Checks for elements’ Chord Rotation and Shear Capacity and for masonry. Six
Codes are currently supported, Eurocode 8, ASCE 41-17 (American Code for Seismic
Evaluation and Retrofit of Existing Buildings), NTC-18 (Italian National Seismic Code), NTC-08
(Italian National Seismic Code), KANEPE (Greek Seismic Interventions Code) and TBDY
(Turkish Seismic Evaluation Building Code).
Several Performance Criteria that allow the user to identify the instants at which different
performance limit states (e.g. non-structural damage, structural damage, collapse) are
reached. The sequence of cracking, yielding, failure of members throughout the structure can
also be, in this manner readily obtained.
Two different solvers: Skyline solver (Cholesky decomposition, Cuthill-McKee nodes ordering
algorithm, Skyline storage format) and the Frontal solver for sparse systems, introduced by
Irons [1970] featuring the automatic ordering algorithm proposed by Izzuddin [1991].
The applied loads may consist of constant or variable forces, displacements and accelerations
at the nodes and at the elements. The variable loads can vary proportionally or independently
in the pseudo-time or time domain.
The spread of inelasticity along the member length and across the section depth is explicitly
modelled in SeismoStruct allowing for accurate estimation of damage accumulation.
Numerical stability and accuracy at very high strain levels enabling precise determination of
the collapse load of structures.
SeismoStruct possesses the ability to smartly subdivide the loading increment, whenever
convergence problems arise. The level of subdivision depends on the convergence difficulties
encountered. When convergence difficulties are overcome, the program automatically
increases the loading increment back to its original value.
General
SYSTEM REQUIREMENTS
To use SeismoStruct, we suggest:
A PC (or a “virtual machine”) with one of the following operating systems: Windows 10,
Windows 8, Windows 7 or Windows Vista (32-bit and 64-bit);
4 GB RAM;
Screen resolution on your computer set to 1366x768 or higher;
An Internet connection (better if a broadband connection) for the registration of the software.
3. After choosing the preferred language from the drop-down menu, click the OK button.
4. Click the Next button to proceed with the installation. The License Agreement appears on the
screen. Please, read it carefully and accept the terms by checking the box.
General 13
5. Click the Next button. On the next request to select the destination folder, click the Next button
again to install to the ‘default’ folder or click the Change button to install to a different one.
6. Click the Install button and wait until the software is installed.
7. At the end of the procedure, click Finish to exit the wizard.
Before using the software you must choose one of the following options:
1. Continue using the program in trial mode.
2. Obtain an academic license by providing a valid academic e-mail address.
3. Acquire a commercial license.
NOTE: If you choose option 2 or 3, then you have to register using the provided license.
Registration Form
IMPORTANT: Regarding the license keys please note that, as indicated in the message that appears
before the opening of the main window of the program, the licenses of version 2020 and older are not
valid in SeismoStruct 2021. Users are thus invited to request a new license.
Pre-Processor Area
NOTE: The main menu and toolbar are available in each program state (i.e. Pre-Processor, Processor
and Post-Processor). Only the items useful in the current program state (e.g. Pre-Processor) will be
selectable; the other ones will be greyed out. Furthermore, additional components will appear
depending on the module selected.
Main menu
The main menu is the command menu of the program. It consists of the following drop-down menus:
File
Edit
View
Define
Results
Tools
Run
Help
Main toolbar
The main toolbar provides quick access to frequently used items from the menu.
Main toolbar
16 SeismoStruct User Manual
Open Ctrl+O
Wizard
Building Modeller -
File
Save Ctrl+S
Save as… -
Export to XML File…
Import from XML File…
Show SPF file structure
Undo Ctrl+Z
Redo Ctrl+R
Add to Group
Organize Groups -
Sort By Name
Edit Sort By Number
Copy Selection Ctrl+C
Calculator -
Open SeismoBatch
Pre-Processor
Run Processor
Post-Processor
SeismoStruct Help F1
Rotate/move the 3D model -
SeismoStruct User Manual
Verification Examples
Help
Download Sample Files
Seismosoft Forum
Video Tutorials
Seismosoft Website -
18 SeismoStruct User Manual
6.15
4.10
2.65
4.25
3.55
5.00
5.00
4.00 6.00
6.15
1.48
2.65
3.55
9.70
Click on the Building Modeller Settings button and define the Analysis Type (For this tutorial: Static
Pushover analysis), the Frame Elements Modelling (Inelastic plastic-hinge force-based frame element
for columns/beams, Inelastic force-based frame element for walls and Inelastic displacement-based
frame elements for members with length smaller than 1m), the Slabs Modelling (choose to include
beam effective widths), the Structural Configuration, the Loading Combination Coefficients and the
Performance Criteria checks to be included in the analysis.
In order to facilitate the definition of the elements’ geometry and location, a CAD drawing can be
imported from the main menu (File > Import DWG...) or through the corresponding toolbar button .
Begin inserting the structural members from the main menu (Insert > Rectangular Column...) or
through the corresponding toolbar button for rectangular columns. Alternatively, select one of the
other available column sections, L-shaped ( ), T-shaped ( ), circular column ( ) or their jacketed
counterparts. The Properties Window of the column will appear on the right-hand side of the screen
and the user can define its geometry, the foundation level, the longitudinal and transverse
reinforcement, its material properties, the FRP wrapping and the Code-based settings for structural
members. In the material sets module the member’s concrete and reinforcement strength values are
determined. The material set should be defined for every structural member. By default there are two
material sets in the program, one for the existing members, called Default_Existing, which is used in the
current tutorial, and one for the new members added for rehabilitation, called Default_New. Users may
add new material sets or edit the existing ones, but they cannot remove the default material schemes.
For this tutorial select to modify the Default_Existing material set and assign the C20/25 concrete class
and the S500 steel class.
By clicking on the Advanced Member Properties button users may define the settings of the structural
member according to the selected Code.
Further, the 'insertion point' of the element can be chosen by clicking on the corner, middle or side
points of the section's plot on the Properties Window. You are allowed to change the sections
dimensions by clicking on them, whereas the rotation of the column on plan-view can be changed by
the 0o, 90o, 180o and 270o buttons or by assigning the proper angle on the corresponding of editbox of
the Properties Window. Although different foundation levels may be defined for the columns of the
24 SeismoStruct User Manual
first floor, for the purpose of the current tutorial a common foundation level of -1000mm is assigned to
all the columns.
The dimensions and the reinforcement of the members (columns, beams and walls) of the first and
second floor are shown in the following tables:
B10 500 250 o416 u414 o214 u414 o218 u414 8/10
B11 500 250 o218 u414 o214 u414 o214 u414 8/10
B12 500 250 o214 u414 o214 u414 o318 u414 8/10
B13 500 250 o218 u414 o214 u414 o314 u414 8/10
B14 500 250 o218 u416 o216 u416 o216 u416 8/10
B15 500 250 o416 u216 o416 u216 o416 u216 8/10
B10 500 250 o416 u216 o416 u216 o416 u216 8/10
After clicking on the Insert Wall button, the Wall’s Properties Window appears, where the dimensions,
the reinforcement pattern (longitudinal and transverse at the two edges and at the middle), the
pseudo-columns' length, the foundation level, the material set, the FRP wrapping and the advanced
code-based properties can be defined. Select the insertion line by clicking on any of the three lines on
the geometry view (the left is the chosen one in the current example), and insert the structural wall by
outlining its two edges on the Main Window.
Insert the beams from the main menu (Insert > Beam) or through the corresponding toolbar button ,
in a similar fashion to the walls. Again, it is possible to easily define the geometry (width and depth),
the reinforcement (longitudinal and transverse reinforcement at the start, middle and end sections),
the material set, the advanced properties and select the insertion line on the plan view by clicking on
the preferred axis (left, centre or right). Additional distributed load may also be defined, which will
serve to define any permanent load not associated to the self-weight of the structural system or the
live loads of the slabs (e.g. finishings, infills, etc).
In order to insert the slabs go to the main menu (Insert > Slab) or click the toolbar button, assign
the slab’s properties, which are the section’s height, the reinforcement, as well as the additional
permanent and live loads, and click on any closed area surrounded by structural elements (columns,
walls and beams). A "Type of Loaded Area" button is available, so that the live loads are automatically
assigned according to the loading category of the selected Code. It is noted that the self-weight of the
slabs is automatically calculated according to the slabs’ geometry, materials and specific weight. Once
the slab is defined, its support conditions, which determine the beams where the slab loads are to be
distributed, may be modified by just clicking on the corresponding boundaries on the Properties
Window. Further, the option of assigning inclined or elevated slabs, by defining the coordinates and
the elevation of just three points of the slab, becomes available.
Quick Start 29
After inserting all the elements you can change the properties of any section by clicking on it. In
particular, it is noted that, after defining the slabs, you can see the beams’ effective width on the beams
Properties Window; each beam’s effective width is automatically calculated, but it can also be changed
by the user. Further, inverted beams may also be defined, as shown in the figure below:
30 SeismoStruct User Manual
Now automatically create the 2nd floor based on the already created 1st one from the main menu (Tools
> Copy floor...) or through the button.
Delete the elements that do not exist in the 2nd floor. Users can delete members from the main menu
command (Tools > Delete...) or through the button, or by selecting a rectangular area on the Main
Window and pressing the delete button.
Quick Start 31
Moreover, an option to renumber the structural members is offered from the main menu (Tools >
Renumber Elements...) or through the corresponding toolbar button . By clicking on a member the
selected number is assigned to it, and the numbering of all other members is changed accordingly.
Cantilever slabs can also be considered by the Building Modeller. In order to do so, a Free Edge must be
added from the main menu (Insert > Slab Edges & Cantilevers) or through the corresponding toolbar
button . Once drawn, the Slab Edge is used to outline the shape of the slab. After defining the
cantilever's corner points, click the Apply button or alternatively click the Reset button, if you want to
redraw it. After the definition of the free edges that are needed to define a closed area, users can insert
a new slab.
32 SeismoStruct User Manual
When you create a building model, it is relatively common that one or more very short beams have
been created unintentionally, due to graphical reasons (e.g. by extending slightly a beam’s end beyond
a column edge). For this reason, a check from the main menu (Tools > Verify Connectivity) or through
the corresponding toolbar button for the existence of any beam with free span smaller than its
section height should be carried out. If such beams exist, the following message appears.
You may also view the 3D model of the current floor to check for its correct definition through the
toolbar button.
Quick Start 33
With the building model now fully defined, save the Building Modeller project as a Building Modeller
file (with the *.bmf extension, e.g. Tutorial_1.bmf) from the main menu (File >Save As...)/ (File >Save) or
through the corresponding toolbar button . It is noted that this file type is not a SeismoStruct
project file (*.spf), hence it can be opened again only from within the Building Modeller.
You are ready to create the new SeismoStruct project. This can be done from the main menu (File > Exit
& Create Project) or through the corresponding toolbar button . Depending on the analysis type, a
new window may appear for the definition of structure’s loading; in our case the nominal Base Shear
for the pushover analysis should be specified:
Automatically, the program distributes the lateral loads to the structural nodes according to their
concentrated masses.
34 SeismoStruct User Manual
Processor
In the Processor area you are allowed to start the analysis. Hence, click on the Run button.
38 SeismoStruct User Manual
Processor area
NOTE: You may choose between three graphical options: (i) see only essential information, (ii) real-
time plotting (in this case Base shear vs. Top displacement capacity curve) and (iii) real-time drawing
of the deformed shape. The former is the fastest option.
When the analysis has arrived to the end, click on the toolbar button or select Run > Post-
Processor from the main menu.
It is also possible to visualise the elements that reach a particular Code-based check or performance
criterion, which can be done by ticking the corresponding display option and selecting from the lists
below the checks or criteria to be displayed. Finally, the displacements values may also be displayed by
checking the relevant checkbox.
Quick Start 41
NOTE: The results are defined in the global system of coordinates and may be exported in an Excel
spreadsheet (or similar) as shown below.
42 SeismoStruct User Manual
Second, in order to obtain the total support forces (e.g. total base shear), (i) click on the Forces and
Moments at support tab, (ii) select, respectively, force and x-axis and total support forces/moments, (iii)
choose the results visualisation (graph or values) and finally (iv) click on the Refresh button.
Global Response Parameters Module (Forces and Moments at Supports – graph mode)
Third, in order to plot the capacity curve of your structure (i.e. total base shear vs. top displacement),
(i) click on the Hysteretic Curves tab, (ii) select, respectively, displacement and x-axis, (iii) select the
corresponding node from the drop-down menu (e.g. n2_C5up) for the bottom-axis, (iv) select the Total
Base Shear/Moment option for the left-axis, (v) choose the results visualisation (graph or values) and
finally (vi) click on the Refresh button.
44 SeismoStruct User Manual
In order to have the shear forces with positive values, (i) right-click on the 3D plot window, (ii) select
Post-Processor Settings and (iii) insert the value “-1” as Y-axis multiplier.
By double-clicking on any element you can see its diagrams in 3D or 2D as shown in the figures below:
Code-based Checks
The user may select either a specific Code-based Check or all the defined checks of the same type. Two
types of Code-based checks are available, chord rotations and shear capacity checks.
When the user clicks on one of the analysis steps, a list of all the checks for all the structural members
appears. The data shown include the demand, the capacity, and whether the particular check has been
reached in that particular location, while the results for each integration section and for both local
axes, (2) and (3) are provided.
In addition to the code-based checks, users may are capable of setting up performance criteria
identifying the instants during the analysis, at which different performance limit states (identified by
material strains, section curvature, element chord-rotation and shear values) are expected to be reached.
This can be done in the Performance Criteria Checks tab of the Global Response Parameters page of the
Post-Processor. By default the Building Modeller defines two types of criteria (i) a chord-rotation
capacity criterion called chord_rot and (ii) a shear capacity criterion called shear.
NOTE: The main difference between the Code-based Checks and the Performance Criteria is that the
latter are checks against the 'expected' values of the response quantities, whereas the former follow
the conservative assessment methodologies as defined by the corresponding Codes and Standards.
Hence, in Code-based Checks the expressions employed for the calculation of the threshold value,
when the different performance limit states are reached, employ conservative (e.g. characteristic or
nominal) material strengths, and are based on the safety and confidence factors, as specified in the
Codes. On the contrary, mean material values and no safety or confidence factors are used in the
Performance Criteria calculations.
The user may select the Performance Criterion Name or all the defined criteria of the same type. In
SeismoStruct, eight types of performance criteria may be defined (i) Concrete strain of RC or
composite sections, (ii) Reinforcement strain of RC or composite sections, (iii) Steel strain of steel or
composite sections, (iv) Section curvature, (v) Frame element chord rotation (i.e. whether a specific
Quick Start 49
value has been reached), (vi) Frame element shear force (i.e. whether a specific value has been
reached), (vii) Frame element chord rotation capacity (i.e. whether the capacity has been reached) and
(viii) Frame element shear capacity (i.e. whether the capacity been reached).
When the user clicks on one of the analysis steps, a list of all the structural members will appear, with
checks of the selected performance criterion in all the integration sections and in both local axes, (2)
and (3). The data shown include the demand, the capacity, and whether the particular criterion has
been reached in that particular location.
NOTE: Other performance criteria may be defined either from the Performance Criteria tab of the
Building Modeller Settings or from the Performance Criteria page of the Pre-Processor.
Processor
Click on the Run button.
Processor area
When the analysis has arrived to the end, click on the toolbar button or select Run > Post-
Processor from the main menu.
Post-Processor
In the Deformed shape viewer module you have the possibility of visualising the deformed shape of
the model at every step of the analysis. Double-click on the desired output identifier to update the
deformed shape view (see figure below).
54 SeismoStruct User Manual
After loading the curve, you may modify the time-history stages, where the time-step of the analysis
can be defined. In the Time-history stages section press the Edit button, and in the dialog box that
opens set (i) the time of the End of Stage (which, in this example, is selected 40 sec) and (ii) the
number of steps (-> 4000).
Time-history stage
NOTE: The program computes internally the time step dt. In this case is equal to 40/4000 = 0.01
NOTE: Unlike the tutorial 1, in this example we ask to visualise, in the real-time plotting, the total
relative displacement of the top node Control_Node with respect to the base node n0_C5low.
At this point you may click on the toolbar button or select Run > Processor from the main
menu in order to perform the dynamic time-history analysis.
58 SeismoStruct User Manual
Processor
Press the Run button.
Once the analysis has arrived to the end, click on the toolbar button to get the results. As
already seen for the Tutorial n.1, in the Post-Processor you will be able to see the deformed shape of
the structure at each step of dynamic analysis (Deformed Shape Viewer) as well as to extract the time-
history displacement response of the structure, and so on.
NOTE: In this Tutorial n.4 you will not use the Wizard or Building Modeller facility but you will rather
create the model entirely yourself, step by step.
Problem Description
Let us try to model a three dimensional, two-storey reinforced concrete building for which you are
asked to run a pushover analysis. Let us assume that the structure is regular, it has three bays and
consists of two parallel frames. The bay lengths are 4 meters, the storey heights are 3 meters and the
distance between the two frames is 4 meters, as you can see in the pictures below:
Once the type of analysis has been selected, you can start to create the model.
Pre-Processor – Materials
The Materials module is the first module you have to fill in. You have two options of inserting a new
material: (i) clicking on the Add Material Class button in order to select a predefined material class or
(ii) clicking on the Add General Material button if you are interested in defining all the material
parameters.
In the present tutorial three materials are going to be defined in order to fully characterize each
element’s section. Hence, after selecting the Add General Material option (button on the left of the
screen), you have to:
1. Assign the material’s name ( Concrete);
2. Select the material type from the drop-down menu ( con_ma);
3. Define the material’s properties ( default values -> Appendix C - Materials);
4. Define the Parameters needed for the Code-based Checks ( Existing_Material).
Concrete material
Now you have to repeat the same procedure in order to add the steel material:
1. Assign the material’s name ( Steel);
2. Select the material type from the drop-down menu ( stl_mp);
3. Define the material’s properties ( default values -> Appendix C - Materials);
4. Define the Parameters for Code-based Checks ( Existing_Material).
60 SeismoStruct User Manual
Note that from SeismoStruct v7.0 onwards, there is no longer a need for defining a third material for
unconfined concrete, since the user has the possibility to define it through the Sections module, by
introducing the transverse reinforcement.
At the end, the Materials module will appear as follows:
Materials module
Quick Start 61
Pre-processor – Sections
Once the materials have been defined, move to the Sections module and click on the Add button in
order to define the sections properties of structural elements.
Sections Module
In this example, two different sections will be defined, one for the columns (called Column) and one for
the beams (called Beam), by using the same section type (reinforced concrete rectangular section
(rcrs)). For each section you have to:
1. Assign the section name;
2. Select the section type from the drop-down menu;
3. Select the section materials from the drop-down menus;
4. Set the section dimensions;
5. Edit the reinforcement pattern;
6. Assign the FRP Wrapping
In the table below the section properties (dimensions and reinforcement) are summarized:
Section Properties Column values Beam values
Height 0.3 (m) 0.4
Width 0.3 (m) 0.3
Cover Thickness 0.025 (m) 0.025 (m)
Longitudinal Reinforcement 4 16 8 16
Transverse Reinforcement 10/10 10/10
FRP Strengthening No FRP Wrapping No FRP Wrapping
62 SeismoStruct User Manual
Users can select from Section Characteristics pattern if the confinement factor will be calculated
automatically from the transverse reinforcement, or will calculate it with more details.
NOTE 1: The shear capacity shown in the Sections module is calculated using the expression of EC8-
Part 3. It is noted that such value is only indicative, since it considers only the contribution of the
transverse reinforcement, but not other factors such as the axial force level or the displacement
ductility demand. The Lv ratio of the equation is calculated employing an assumed element length as
the minimum of 6*(MaxDim) and 12*(MinDim), where (MaxDim) and (MinDim) are the maximum and
minimum section dimension respectively.
NOTE 2: The EA, EI & GJ values shown in this module are merely indicative (i.e not used in the analysis)
and calculated using the elastic material properties of the main section material (i.e. concrete in R/C
sections). No discretisation of the section in monitoring points takes place in the Pre-Processor (as
happens instead during the analysis).
6. Define the element-specific damping ( no element specific damping is applied, which means
that the damping defined in the Project Settings will be employed)
Repeat the same procedure in order to create the class for the beam element.
In order to take into account vertical load acting on the beam elements, you may assign an additional
mass/length to the beam element class. For this tutorial let’s assume a value of 0.6 tonne/m.
NOTE 1: The additional mass/length will be converted to loads only by checking the 'Loads (ONLY in
the gravity direction) are derived from Masses, based on the g value ' or 'Loads are derived from Masses
in any translational direction, according to user-defined coefficients' option in the Project Settings panel
(Project Settings -> Gravity & Mass).
Quick Start 67
NOTE 2: The additional mass/length may be defined also by using the distributed mass element
(dmass).
Pre-processor – Nodes
At this point it is necessary to define the geometry of the structure. Hence, move to the Nodes module
in order to define the nodes.
NOTE: In this tutorial you are going to define just one structural node. The other nodes will be created
through the Incrementation function.
The first node you are going to define is a structural node. Click on the Add button. Then, in the new
node dialogue window (i) assign the node name ( N1), (ii) introduce the coordinates ( x=0, y=0,
z=0) and (iii) select the node type from the drop-down menu ( structural node).
Incrementation facility
Now, in order to increment the nodes in Z-direction, (i) select the nodes you previously defined, (ii)
click again on the Incrementation button, (iii) assign the node name increment ( 10), (iv) introduce
the increment ( 3) in Z-direction, (v) define the number of repetitions ( 2).
Incrementation in Z-direction
Repeat the steps above in order to define the remaining nodes. In the table below the coordinates of all
the structural nodes are summarized:
Node Name X Y Z Type
N1 0 0 0 structural
N2 4 0 0 structural
N3 8 0 0 structural
N4 12 0 0 structural
N11 0 0 3 structural
70 SeismoStruct User Manual
Structural nodes
Quick Start 71
NOTE: In this tutorial, you will use the Table Input instead of the Graphical Input mode in order to
generate the new elements.
72 SeismoStruct User Manual
Repeat the procedure described above in order to define all the other elements.
NOTE: As in the case of nodes, you may use the Incrementation facility in order to generate the new
elements.
At this point, the whole structure has been defined. Now, in the 3D Model window (on the right of the
screen) you can check your model by zooming, rotating, and moving the 3D plot.
3D Model window
74 SeismoStruct User Manual
Pre-processor – Constraints
Now you have to define the constraining conditions of the structure. Two rigid diaphragms need to be
created. Hence, go to the Constraints module and click on the Add button.
Constraints module
Quick Start 75
Repeat the same procedure in order to define the rigid diaphragm that models the second floor. At the
end, the Constraints module will appear as follows:
Constraints
76 SeismoStruct User Manual
NOTE: As in the case of elements, you may use the Incrementation facility in order to generate the new
rigid diaphragm.
Pre-processor – Restraints
The last step related to the “structural geometry” is the definition of the restraining conditions. In this
tutorial you have to fully restrain the base nodes of the structure. To do this, (i) move to the Restraints
module, (ii) select the nodes you wish to restrain (-> base nodes) and (iii) click on the Edit button.
Restraints module
Restraints
Repeat the same procedure in order to apply the other incremental loads.
REMEMBER! The magnitude of a load at any step is given by the product of its nominal value, defined
by the user, and the current load factor, which is updated in automatic or user-defined fashion.
Incremental Loads
From SeismoStruct v7.0 onwards users can apply distributed load on elements in the Applied Loads
module by click on the Add button for Element Loads.
Repeat the same procedure in order to apply the other element loads.
In the table below all the applied loads are summarized:
Element name Direction Type Value
B1 z force -4.2
B2 z force -4.2
B3 z force -4.2
B4 z force -4.2
B5 z force -4.2
B6 z force -4.2
B7 z force -4.2
B10 z force -4.2
B8 z force -2.1
B9 z force -2.1
Quick Start 81
Applied Loads
NOTE: It is recalled that, if it has been selected in the Gravity and Mass settings (Project Settings ->
Gravity & Mass) to transform masses to loads, the frame element distributed mass will be transformed
to distributed element loads.
82 SeismoStruct User Manual
NOTE: It is noted that a large variety of performance criteria may be defined, including criteria on
material strains (cracking and spalling of cover concrete, crushing of core concrete, or yielding and
fracture of steel), criteria on section curvatures and chord-rotations, and chord rotation and element
shear capacity checks.
Then, click on the toolbar button or select Run > Processor from the main menu.
Processor
In the Processor area you are allowed to start the analysis. Hence, click on the Run button.
Processor Area
Quick Start 87
NOTE: You may choose between three graphical options: (i) see only essential information, (ii) real-
time plotting (in this case Base shear vs. Top displacement) and (iii) real-time drawing of the
deformed shape. The former is the fastest option.
When the analysis has arrived to the end, click on the toolbar button or select Run > Post-
Processor from the main menu.
NOTE: The results are defined in the global system of coordinates and may be exported in an Excel
spreadsheet (or similar) as shown below.
Quick Start 89
Second, in order to obtain the total support forces (e.g. total base shear), (i) click on the Forces and
Moments at support tab, (ii) select, respectively, force and x-axis and total support forces/moments, (iii)
choose the results visualisation (graph or values) and finally (iv) click on the Refresh button.
90 SeismoStruct User Manual
Global Response Parameters Module (Forces and Moments at Supports – graph mode)
Third, in order to plot the capacity curve of your structure (i.e. total base shear vs. top displacement),
(i) click on the Hysteretic Curves tab, (ii) select, respectively, displacement and x-axis, (iii) select the
corresponding node from the drop-down menu (e.g. N23) for the bottom-axis, (iv) select the Total Base
Shear/Moment option for the left-axis, (v) choose the results visualisation (graph or values) and finally
(vi) click on the Refresh button.
In order to have the shear forces with positive values, (i) right-click on the 3D plot window, (ii) select
Post-Processor Settings and (iii) insert the value “-1” as Y-axis multiplier.
In order to avoid the need for users to carry out hand-calculations for the estimation of the capacity of
the structural members, SeismoStruct provides the option to automatically undertake chord-rotation
and shear capacity checks, according to the expressions defined in the supported Codes (Eurocode 8,
ASCE 41-17, NTC-18, NTC-08, KANEPE and TBDY) for the selected limit states. This can be done in the
Code-based Checks tab of the Global Response Parameters page of the Post-Processor.
Quick Start 93
Code-based Checks
The user may select either a specific Code-based Check or all the defined checks of the same type. Two
types of Code-based checks are available, chord rotation and shear capacity checks.
When the user clicks on one of the analysis steps, a list of all the checks for all the structural members
appears. The data shown include the demand, the capacity, and whether the particular check has been
reached in that particular location, while the results for each integration section and for both local
axes, (2) and (3) are provided.
In addition to the code-based checks, users are capable of setting up performance criteria identifying
the instants during the analysis, at which different performance limit states (identified by material
strains, section curvature, element chord-rotation and shear values) are expected to be reached. This
can be done in the Performance Criteria Checks tab of the Global Response Parameters page of the Post-
Processor. By default, the chord rotation and shear capacities criteria are not selected.
NOTE: The main difference between the Code-based Checks and the Performance Criteria is that the
latter are checks against the 'expected' values of the response quantities, whereas the former follow
the conservative assessment methodologies as defined by the corresponding Codes and Standards.
Hence, in Code-based Checks the expressions employed for the calculation of the threshold value,
when the different performance limit states are reached, employ conservative (e.g. characteristic or
nominal) material strengths, and are based on the safety and confidence factors, as specified in the
Codes. On the contrary, mean material values and no safety or confidence factors are used in the
Performance Criteria calculations.
94 SeismoStruct User Manual
Finally, in order to visualise the frame element forces (e.g. shear forces), (i) click on the Frame Forces
tab, (ii) select the force (e.g. V3), (iii) select the elements from the list, by ticking the corresponding
box, (iv) choose the results visualisation (graph or values) and finally (v) clicking on the Refresh button.
NOTE 1: Four modules will disappear (Loading Phases, Target Displacement, Code-based Checks and
Performance Criteria) with respect to the pushover analysis.
NOTE 2: The existing permanent loads, from Tutorial 4, are not taken into consideration in the
eigenvalue analysis, unless the option Define Mass from both Frame/Mass Elements and Loads is
selected in the Project Settings > Gravity & Mass module.
Once the type of analysis has been selected, move to the Element Classes module in order to define
the mass element types.
96 SeismoStruct User Manual
IMPORTANT: In the Material module the specific weight of each material has been already defined in
Tutorial 4 and the software will automatically compute, by default, the element masses from those
values (see Project Settings > Gravity & Mass).
3a. Click on
the button
Repeat the procedure described above in order to define all the other lumped mass elements. In the
table below all the lumped mass elements are summarized:
Element Name Element Class Nodes
Mass1 Lumped N11
Mass2 Lumped N14
Mass3 Lumped N15
Mass4 Lumped N18
Mass5 Lumped N21
Mass6 Lumped N24
Mass7 Lumped N25
Mass8 Lumped N28
Before running the analysis, you may choose between two different eigensolvers, the Lanczos
algorithm or the Jacobi algorithm with Ritz transformation, in order to determine the modes of
vibration of the structure (Tools > Project Settings…). In this tutorial the Lanczos algorithm has been
selected.
Eigenvalue settings
At this point you may click on the toolbar button or select Run > Processor from the main
menu in order to perform the Eigenvalue analysis.
Quick Start 99
Processor
Click on the Run button.
Processor area
When the analysis has arrived to the end, click on the toolbar button or select Run > Post-
Processor from the main menu.
In addition, you can also visualise the displacement values by checking the “Displacement Values
Display” box (see figure above).
Warning message
102 SeismoStruct User Manual
Once loaded the curve, you must define an analysis stage. So, in the Time-history stages section press
the Add button. In the new window, set (i) the time of the End of Stage (which, in this example,
coincides with the final time of the accelerogram, i.e. 20 sec) and (ii) the number of steps (-> 2000).
Time-history stage
NOTE: The program computes internally the time step dt. In this case it is equal to 20/2000 = 0.01
Repeat the same procedure in order to apply the other dynamic time-history loads to the base nodes.
In the table below all the applied loads are summarized:
Category Node name Direction Type Curve multiplier Curve
Dynamic Time- N1 x acceleration 9.81 TH1
history Load
Dynamic Time- N2 x acceleration 9.81 TH1
history Load
Dynamic Time- N3 x acceleration 9.81 TH1
history Load
Dynamic Time- N4 x acceleration 9.81 TH1
history Load
Dynamic Time- N5 x acceleration 9.81 TH1
history Load
Dynamic Time- N6 x acceleration 9.81 TH1
history Load
Dynamic Time- N7 x acceleration 9.81 TH1
history Load
Dynamic Time- N8 x acceleration 9.81 TH1
history Load
106 SeismoStruct User Manual
NOTE: Unlike the tutorial 1, in this example we ask to visualize, in the real-time plotting, the total
relative displacement of the top node N21 with respect to the base node N1.
At this point you may click on the toolbar button or select Run > Processor from the main
menu in order to perform the dynamic time-history analysis.
Processor
Press the Run button.
Once the analysis has arrived to the end, click on the toolbar button to get the results. As
already seen for the previous tutorials, in the Post-Processor you will be able to see the deformed
shape of the structure at each step of dynamic analysis (Deformed Shape Viewer) as well as to extract
the time-history displacement response of the structure, and so on.
BUILDING MODELLER
A special modeller facility has been developed and introduced in the program in order to facilitate the
creation of building models. Currently, only reinforced concrete buildings can be created; in
subsequent releases of the program steel and composite models will be also supported.
The Building Modeller is accessed from the main menu (File > Building Modeller...) or through the
corresponding toolbar button .
108 SeismoStruct User Manual
Advanced Settings
In the Advanced Settings dialog box, accessed by the corresponding button, the following information
can be defined:
Analysis Type: The type of analysis for which the model will be created. All nine SeismoStruct
analyses types are supported.
The definition of the control node is made within this module. Users may select directly the
floor of the control node, or alternatively choose the automatic definition, in which the control
node is defined at the centre of mass of the upper floor or at the floor lower to that (in the case
of having a top floor mass less than 10% of the lower floor’s).
Frame Elements Modelling: The element class to be used to model the structural members is
defined herein. Different frame element types may be employed for columns/beams and walls.
Further, it is possible to assign the inelastic displacement-based frame element type
(infrmDB) to short members, a choice that improves both the accuracy and the stability of the
analysis. Users can determine the maximum length of the short members, below which the
infrmDB element type is employed (1.0m by default). The inelastic plastic-hinge force-based
frame element infrmFBPH is selected for columns/beams and the inelastic force-based frame
element infrmFB for walls, a scheme that should work well for most practical applications. The
choice whether to include or not rigid ends in the beams, columns and walls modelling is also
done herein. It is noted that these rigid ends are included in the model, when the length of a
member’s rigid end is larger than the specified value. The last option of not accepting beams
shorter than a specific length is used to avoid the creation of very short beams, due to
graphical reasons, by mistake (e.g. by extending slightly a beam’s edge after the column at its
end).
110 SeismoStruct User Manual
NOTE: Even when no rigid ends are defined by the user, offsets may automatically be introduced to
ensure adequate alignment of all structural elements.
Slabs Modelling: The option whether to include the effective slab width in the beams
modelling is determined in this tab.
NOTE: The slab modelling is carried out with rigid diaphragms; hence, a rigid slab is implicitly
considered in the structural configuration, which is the case for the vast majority of R/C buildings. The
slab’s loads (self weight, additional gravity and live loads) are applied directly to the beams that
support the slab.
Loading Combination Coefficients: The loading combination coefficients for the Seismic
Combination (e.g. G+0.3·Q±E) of the slabs’ permanent, live and snow (in the case of ASCE 41-
17 and TBDY) loads are defined here. The loading of the slabs is defined for each slab
separately in the slabs' Properties Window.
Performance Criteria: Users are able to select which types of performance criteria to include
in their analysis. By default, the chord rotation and shear capacities criteria are not selected.
Code-based Checks: Users are able to select which types of code-based checks to include in
their analysis. By default, both the chord rotation and shear capacities checks are selected.
It is noted that the Building Modeller settings can be further changed through the corresponding
toolbar button .
The possibility of inserting a CAD drawing is offered from the main menu (File > Import DWG...) or
through the corresponding toolbar button . Once the drawing is inserted the user is asked to assign
drawing’s units and whether to move the DWG/DXF file to 0,0, i.e. to the origin of the coordinates
system. Selecting the check-box will move the bottom-left edge of the drawing to the (0,0) coordinates,
irrespective of its initial CAD coordinates. Note that the axes origin can be further moved to a different
point that might be more suitable with the Move Axes Center toolbar button, also accessible from
the Menu (View > Move Axes Center). The option of moving the imported CAD file is also available
through the Move DWG ( ) toolbar button or from the main menu (View > Move DWG). Further, from
the Menu (View > Show/Hide DWG) or through the toolbar button the option whether the CAD
drawing will be visible or not is defined.
Users may also move the building in plan view from the main menu (Tools > Move Building) or from the
corresponding toolbar button by either assigning the relative coordinares or by selecting the base
point and the second point graphically.
The option of rotating the building in plan view is also available from the main menu (Tools > Rotate
Building) or from the toolbar button. Users should specify the base point by its coordinates or
graphically and assign the rotation angle.
Material Sets
The Material Sets properties can be defined from the Menu (Tools > Define Material Sets), through the
corresponding toolbar button, or through the Define Material Sets button within the member’s
properties window. The required materials properties depend on the type of the members, i.e. existing
or new members. For existing materials the mean strength value and the mean strength value minus
one standard deviation are required, whereas for new materials the characteristic strength value and
the mean strength value should be assigned. By default, there are two material schemes, one for the
existing elements and one for the new ones. Users may modify the values of the default sets, but they
can also add new material sets to cover the needs of their model (e.g. when several different material
strengths are employed in the structural system).
NOTE 1: There is a limit to the number of the defined material schemes equal to 10. The default
material sets cannot be removed.
NOTE 2: The option of applying predefined material strengths, depending on the year of construction
of the building, is available when this is allowed from the selected Code.
Modelling Parameters
The member’s modelling parameters may be defined from the Modelling Parameters dialog box
accessed by the Properties Window. Herein, users may define the concrete and steel material types
and the frame element type that will be used to model the structural member in SeismoStruct, together
with other modelling options, such as the number of sections fibres and the assignment of
Moment/Force releases.
Materials and frame element types that are to be used within a SeismoStruct project come defined in
the Advanced Building Modelling tab of the Advanced Settings module. The choices made in the
Advanced Building Modelling tab are the “Default” options within the Modelling Parameters tab.
Fourteen material types are available within the Building Modeller of SeismoStruct, six types for
concrete and eight for steel. The complete list of materials is proposed hereafter:
Mander et al. nonlinear concrete model - con_ma
Trilinear concrete model - con_tl
Chang-Mander nonlinear concrete model – con_cm
Kappos and Konstantinidis nonlinear concrete model - con_hs
Engineered cementitious composites material – con_ecc
Kent-Scott-Park concrete model – con_ksp
Menegotto-Pinto steel model - stl_mp
Giuffre-Menegotto-Pinto steel model - stl_gmp
Bilinear steel model - stl_bl
Bilinear steel model with isotropic strain hardening- stl_bl2
Ramberg-Osgood steel model - stl_ro
Dodd-Restrepo steel model – stl_dr
Monti-Nuti steel model - stl_mn
Buckling Restrained Steel Brace model – stl_brb
For a comprehensive description of the material types, refer to Appendix C – Materials.
Different frame element types may be employed within the structural members. Users may select
between inelastic force-based frame elements (infrmFB), inelastic plastic-hinge force-based frame
elements (infrmFBPH), inelastic plastic-hinge displacement-based frame elements (infrmDBPH),
inelastic displacement-based frame elements (infrmDB) and elastic frame elements (elfrm). The
inelastic displacement-based frame element type (infrmDB) is suggested to be employed for short
members, a choice that improves both the accuracy and the stability of the analysis.
NOTE: Code based checks are not executed for the member of the elastic frame element type (elfrm).
Hence, this element type may be employed only for special modelling cases, when an elastic member
behaviours is expected.
Further, the number of section fibres used in equilibrium computations carried out at each of the
element's integration sections needs to be defined. User may assign the number of fibres of their
choice or they may select the automatic calculation, according to which 50 fibres are defined for a
member’s concrete area less than 0.1m2 and 200 fibres for a member’s concrete area more than 1m2,
whereas linear interpolation is executed for the in between values. Each longitudinal reinforcement
bar is defined with 1 additional fibre; added to the abovementioned concrete number of fibres.
Finally, users may also 'release' one or more of the element degrees of freedom (forces or moments).
118 SeismoStruct User Manual
FRP Wrapping
FRP wraps may be assigned to columns through the FRP Wrapping module. Users may select the FRP
sheet from a list of the most commonly used products found in the market, or alternatively introduce
user-defined values.
The number of applied layers may also be defined, as well as whether the dry or the laminate FRP
properties are to be used in the calculations. Finally, for the rectangular cross sections the radius of
rounding of the corners R may be specified, a critical parameter in the application of FRP wraps.
When users choose to specify user-defined values, the required information is the type of the FRP
sheet (Carbon, Aramid, Glass fibres, Basalt or Steel), its laminate or dry properties, the number of
direction(s) and the orientation (relatively to the longitudinal direction of the member) of the fibres, as
well as the number of layers and the radius of rounding corners R.
120 SeismoStruct User Manual
Finally, FRP systems may be proposed to Seismosoft through the “Propose FRP system to Seismosoft”
button, in order to be included in newer releases of the program. Herein, the user is asked to assign the
name of the FRP system, the link where information about the product may be found and the technical
properties of the FRP sheet.
Column Members
The columns can be inserted from the main menu (Insert >...) or through the corresponding toolbar
buttons. The column's Properties Window will appear where the properties below can be explicitly
defined:
(i) the dimensions (height, width and if it is full length or free length, assigning the length
difference in the last case)
(ii) the foundation level
(iii) the reinforcement
(iv) the material sets
(v) the FRP wrapping
(vi) the advanced member properties
(vii) the modelling parameters
The column members may be inserted in the project with a single mouse click.
Once the Insert a Column command is selected, an informative message appears providing brief
information of how to insert a column.
Wall Members
The walls can be inserted from the main menu (Insert >...) or through the corresponding toolbar
button. The wall's Properties Window will appear where its properties are explicitly defined in the
similar way to the columns. The walls may be inserted in the project by defining their edges; only two
mouse clicks are needed.
Currently, the following types are available in Building Modeller:
Wall
Compound Wall
Once the Insert a Wall command is selected, an informative message appears, providing brief
information of how to insert a wall.
For a comprehensive discussion about the insertion of walls in the Building Modeller refer to Appendix
E – Building Modeller Members.
Quick Start 123
If the Insert Compound Wall toolbar button is selected, an informative window will appear
proposing the best way to insert compound wall sections. According to recent research (Beyer K.,
Dazio A., and Priestley M.J.N. [2008]), the best way to subdivide non-planar wall systems, e.g. U-shaped
or Z-shaped walls, into planar subsections is by splitting the corner area between the flange and the
walls. In this way the inner corner bar is attributed to both the web and the flange section, while the
outer bar is not assigned to any section, the total reinforcement area is therefore modelled correctly.
NOTE: Horizontal links are automatically assigned by the program in order to connect the defined
vertical elements.
Beam Members
The beams can be inserted from the main menu (Insert >…) or through the corresponding toolbar
buttons. Several additional parameters, in addition to those provided for columns, need to be specified
for the correct definition of a beam , i.e. whether it is an inclined beam (in this case the height of the
two ends should be specified), the additional permanent load and the reinforcement in three
integration sections of the beam (in the middle and two edges). Beams may be inserted in the project
by defining their edges with two mouse clicks. After assigning the beams and the slabs, the choice of
not including the effective width and customizing its value, as well as if the beam members will be
inversed beams, may be made.
124 SeismoStruct User Manual
For a comprehensive discussion about the insertion of beams in the Building Modeller refer to
Appendix E – Building Modeller .
Quick Start 125
Slab
The insertion of slabs can be done through the Menu (Insert > Slab) or by clicking the toolbar
button. Prior to adding a slab, an informative message appears providing brief information of how to
insert a slab.
A slab can be defined with a single mouse click on any closed area surrounded by structural members
(columns, walls and beams).
In the slab’s Properties Window users can define (i) the section’s height, (ii) the reinforcement and its
rotation to the X & Y axes, and (iii) its self weight and the additional permanent, live and snow loads;
the latter is required only by ASCE 41-17 and TBDY. The sel-weight of the slabs may be automatically
calculated and included in the structural model or a user-defined value may be used. The slab's live
loads are automatically assigned by the program after the user selects the appropriate type of loaded
area. It is noted that the self-weight of the slabs is automatically calculated and included in the
structural model.
126 SeismoStruct User Manual
Slab insertion
After defining a slab, users may modify its support conditions, thus adjusting at which beams the slab
loads are to be distributed.
Further the inclination of the slab may be modified, by specifying the slab elevation at three points that
can be graphically selected. The neighboring beams’ elevation and column heights are automatically
adjusted, whereas the columns are subdivided in shorter members by the program, if this is required,
i.e. in the cases where two or more beams are supported by the same column at different levels, thus
creating short columns.
Slab Inclination
128 SeismoStruct User Manual
NOTE 1: The slab reinforcement is applied at the effective width of the beams at the perimeter of the
slab. Obviously, when users select not to include the effective width in the modelling, such
reinforcement settings become redundant.
NOTE 2: The slab modelling is carried out with rigid diaphragms; hence, a rigid slab is implicitly
considered in the structural configuration, which is the case for the vast majority of RC buildings. The
slab’s loads (self weight, additional gravity and live loads multiplied by the corresponding coefficients
in the SeismoStruct Building Modeller Settings module) are transformed to masses, based on the g
value, and applied directly to the beams that support the slab.
Slab by perimeter
Slabs of any geometry can be defined in the Building Modeller by selecting the Insert > Insert Slab by
perimeter from the Menu (or through the respective toolbar button ). An informative message
appears providing brief information of how to insert a Slab by perimeter.
After defining the Slab’s perimeter by identifying its corners, the “Apply & Insert Slab” button should
be clicked. The slab is automatically assigned.
NOTE 1: Slabs are modelled in SeismoStruct as rigid diaphragms that connect the beams, columns and
walls in their perimeter and as additional loads applied to the beams. Obviously, in the case of
cantilevered slabs no rigid diaphragm is created and a slab is only considered as additional mass on
the supporting beam; the additional mass account for the slabs' permanent and live loads.
NOTE 2: When the assigned perimeter does not define a closed area, the first point is automatically
connected with the last one in order to insert the new slab.
Free Edge
Cantilever slabs can also be defined in the Building Modeller. In order to do so, a Free Edge must be
added from the Menu (Insert > Free edge) or through the respective toolbar button . An informative
message appears providing brief information of how to insert a Free Edge.
After defining the Free Edge's corner points, the “Apply” button should be clicked. Once drawn, the
Free Edge is used to outline the shape of the slab.
130 SeismoStruct User Manual
NOTE: Slabs are modelled in SeismoStruct as rigid diaphragms that connect the beams, columns and
walls in their perimeter and as additional loads applied to the beams. Obviously, in the case of
cantilevered slabs no rigid diaphragm is created and a slab is only considered as additional mass on
the supporting beam; the additional mass account for the slabs' permanent and live loads.
Stairs
The insertion of stairs can be done through the Menu (Insert > Stairs) or by clicking the toolbar
button. An informative message appears providing brief information of how to insert Stairs.
Stairs may be easily defined by specifying their centreline. Landings may be applied through the “Add
Landings” button after the insertion of the stairs member in the project. The two ends of the landings
need to be specified graphically on the centerline. The defined landings may be removed through the
“Remove All Landings” button.
On the Properties Window users can further define the stairs’ width, the riser height, the stairs
minimum depth, the elevation difference relatively to the base and the top floor level, as well as the
self-weight and the additional permanent, live and snow loads; the latter is required only by ASCE 41-
17 and TBDY. The self-weight of the stairs may be automatically calculated according to the stairs’
geometry, materials and specific weight or a user-defined value may be used.
NOTE: Slabs are modelled in SeismoStruct with elastic elements of the specified width and depth.
132 SeismoStruct User Manual
The option of multi-editing structural members is available from the main menu (Tools > View/Modify
Member Properties) or through the corresponding toolbar button . Users may select multiple
members of the same section type and modify their properties at once.
The properties of one member may be applied to others from the main menu (Tools > Copy Member
Properties) or through the corresponding toolbar button . A window with a list of the properties
that will be copied appears after the selection of the member. Users should just click on a member in
order to change its properties. It is noted that the additional rebars cannot be copied.
Quick Start 133
Moreover, an option to renumber the structural members is offered from the main menu (Tools >
Renumber elements) or through the corresponding toolbar button . By clicking on a member the
selected number is assigned to it, and the numbering of all other members is changed accordingly.
After creating a building model, it is relatively common that one or more very short beams have been
created unintentionally, due to graphical reasons (e.g. by extending slightly a beam’s end beyond a
column edge). For this reason, a check from the main menu (Tools > Verify Connectivity) or through the
corresponding toolbar button for the existence of any beam with free span smaller than its section
height should be carried out. If such beams exist, the following message appears.
Verify connectivity
134 SeismoStruct User Manual
Copy floor
It is noted that users may use the layout of an existing floor as background, in order to easily introduce
new members on another storey.
View 3D Model
The possibility of viewing the 3D model of the current floor is offered through the main menu (View >
Storey 3D Model...) or through the toolbar button.
Zoom tools
Showing or hiding the CAD drawing as a background image can be done from the main menu
(View > Show/Hide DWG...) or through the corresponding toolbar button , after it has been
loaded with the button .
Snap tools offer the possibility of snapping to the CAD drawing, the member and/or the grid.
The grid (step, min and max values) and snap properties (step), as well as whether the grid
will be visualised or not may be defined from the Snap and Grid Properties dialog box
accessed by the menu (View > Snap & Grid Properties) or through the toolbar button.
136 SeismoStruct User Manual
Further, an Ortho facility is provided; Ortho is short for orthogonal, and allows for the
introduction of either vertical or horizontal - but not inclined - line (beams or walls) members.
Again, all these facilities can be accessed from both the Menu (View >...) and through the
corresponding toolbar buttons.
The axes origin of the CAD drawing at the background may be moved from the main menu
(View >Move Axes Center) or through the corresponding toolbar button .
The building in plan view may also be moved from the main menu (Tools > Move Building) or
through the toolbar button.
The option of rotating the building in plan view is available from the main menu (Tools >
Rotate Building) or from the toolbar button.
The possibility of undoing and redoing the last operations is offered from the main menu (Edit
>Undo)/ (Edit >Redo) or through the corresponding toolbar buttons .
The selected plan view can be printed or previewed from the main menu (File >Print... & File
>Print Preview...) or through the corresponding toolbar buttons &
Quick Start 137
Print preview
NOTE: SeismoBuild projects (with the *.bpf extension) may be also imported from within the Building
Modeller, from the main menu (File >Open) or through the corresponding toolbar button .
NOTE: When creating a SeismoStruct project file from the Building Modeller, the structural mass is
modelled by the material's specific weight, and the sections' additional mass parameters. The former
accounts for the mass of the columns, the walls and the beams, while the latter accounts for the mass
that corresponds to the slabs' self weight, additional permanent loads and live loads. These defined
masses are transformed to gravity loads, through the relevant setting in the Project Settings panel
(Project Settings -> Gravity & Mass), i.e. 'Loads (ONLY in the gravity direction) are derived from
Masses, based on the g value'.
Finally, an option for exiting the Building Modeller without creating the SeismoStruct project file is
offered from the main menu (File >Exit) or through the corresponding toolbar button .
WIZARD
In order to facilitate the creation of frame/building models, a Wizard facility has been developed and
introduced in the program. The Wizard dialog box is accessed from the main menu (File > Wizard...) or
through the corresponding toolbar button .
Quick Start 139
IMPORTANT: New users are strongly advised to use this expeditious model creation facility to get up
and running in the minimum amount of time and to gain a quick grasp on the structure and workings
of SeismoStruct's project files.
Settings
Having defined the structural geometry, the user should now specify if the building is a reinforced
concrete or steel structure. The Wizard generates structures employing the inelastic force-based
plastic-hinge (infrmFBPH) elements type.
NOTE: If the user intends to adopt the other types of inelastic frame elements (infrmFB, infrmDBPH or
infrmDB) rather than infrmFBPH, after the model's generation he/she may manually modify the
element type in the Element Classes dialog box.
Each frame element generated through the Wizard facility is defined by 'structural' nodes at beam
column joints. The names of these nodes are automatically created by following the n111 naming
convention: all nodes have a name of the format: "n"+i+j+k, where i is the storey number (starting from
the bottom/foundation), j is the column number (starting from the left) and k is the frame number
(starting from the front). For instance, n123 would refer to the node on the left column of the model
(i=1), in the second frame (j=2) and at the third storey (k=3, third level of nodes). Users should refer to
the Nodes paragraph for further details on the nodes definition.
The orientation of the frame elements created using the Wizard facility is automatically defined by a
rotation angle (by default equal to 0). Users should refer to the discussion on Global and Local Axes
Systems for further details on the element orientation.
Loading
Finally, one of the eight Analysis Types available in SeismoStruct has to be selected, depending on
which the following loads and restraining conditions are imposed on the structure:
Eigenvalue analysis. Self-weight of the structure is considered. No loading is applied.
Static analysis with non-variable loads. Permanent gravity loads are applied.
Static pushover analysis. In addition to permanent gravity actions, Incremental Loads,
consisting of horizontal forces at each storey level, are also applied to the structure in the x-
direction. The user has the possibility of choosing between two alternative load distributions
(triangular or rectangular/uniform vector shapes) and of defining the nominal base-shear
value (usually a value around the expected base shear capacity of the structure is used, though
any given value is fine). Refer to Pre-Processor > Applied Loads > Loading Phases for further
details on pushover analysis loading characteristics.
Adaptive static pushover analysis. In addition to permanent gravity actions, Incremental
Loads, consisting of horizontal displacements at each storey level, are also applied to the
structure in the x-direction. Since the load distribution is automatically adapted by the
program, the user needs only to specify the nominal displacement load to be used as reference
value during the pushover procedure. Refer to Pre-Processor > Applied Loads > Adaptive
pushover parameters for further details on adaptive pushover analysis loading characteristics.
Static time-history analysis. In addition to permanent gravity actions, Static Time-history Loads
are applied to the top left hand side node of the building, in the x-direction. The user is asked
to define the time-history curve (a pre-defined standard curve is in any case already provided)
and corresponding curve multiplier (scaling factor).
Dynamic time-history analysis. In addition to permanent gravity actions, Dynamic Time-history
Loads are applied at the foundation nodes of the building, in the x-direction. The user is asked
to define the time-history curve (usually an accelerogram) and corresponding curve multiplier
(scaling factor). A number of exemplificative time-history curves (consisting of natural and
artificial accelerograms) are pre-installed with the program and can be loaded into the
program through the Select File command.
Incremental dynamic analysis. In addition to permanent gravity actions, Dynamic Time-history
Loads are applied at the foundation nodes of the building, in the x-direction. The user is first
asked to define the Incremental Scaling Factors (see IDA Parameters) and then needs to enter
the time-history curve (usually an accelerogram) and corresponding curve multiplier (scaling
Quick Start 141
NOTE 1: When generating building models, the Wizard facility makes use of commonly encountered
cross-sections dimensions and detailing, together with standard material properties. Evidently, after
the completion of the model, the user may manually modify these input quantities so as to better
represent the characteristics of the actual structure that he/she intends to analyse.
NOTE 2: The maximum building size that can be generated with the wizard is 8 bays x 8 storeys x 9
frames. Users who wish to create larger structures, however, can readily do so by employing the
Incrementation facilities for nodes, elements, constraints and loads.
NOTE 3: To define structural members that are subdivided in more than 4 elements, the model can be
wizard-created with 1, 2 or 4 elements per member and then the Element Subdivision facility can be
employed to further discretise the structural mesh.
NOTE 4: The Wizard facility automatically activates the calculation of the Target Displacement in the
case of pushover analysis. For further details users may refer to the Target Displacement paragraph.
NOTE 5: The Wizard facility automatically generates Code-based Checks. For details on their definition
users may refer to the Code-based Checks paragraph.
NOTE 6: The Wizard facility automatically generates Performance Criteria checks. For details on their
definition users may refer to the Performance Criteria paragraph.
IMPORTANT: Before starting with a new SeismoStruct project, usually it is better to select first an
analysis type.
ANALYSIS TYPES
Currently, nine analysis types are available in the program:
Eigenvalue analysis
Static analysis (non-variable load)
Static pushover analysis
Static adaptive pushover analysis
Static time-history analysis
Dynamic time-history analysis
Incremental Dynamic Analysis (IDA)
Response Spectrum Analysis (RSA)
Buckling Analysis
These can be easily selected from the drop-down menu at the top left corner on the Pre-Processor
window (see picture below):
Different analysis types present equally diverse modelling requirements (see paragraphs below).
Consequently, whereas the frame (elastic and inelastic) and link elements can be used for every
analysis type, mass elements (lmass and dmass) are not needed in static analyses (with the exception
Pre-Processor 143
of static adaptive pushover) and can be used only in dynamic, eigenvalue and adaptive pushover
analysis. Moreover, damping elements (dashpt) are only needed in dynamic analysis. Whenever the
analysis type is changed, the program automatically attempts to apply the required modifications to
the existing model. For example, if in an already-built dynamic analysis project, the analysis type is
changed to static pushover, SeismoStruct will automatically remove the mass and damping elements.
Warning message
In addition, the different analysis types accept equally diverse types of loading (refer to the Applied
Loads paragraph for details (Pre-Processor > Loading > Applied Loads)).
For a comprehensive description of the analysis types, refer to Appendix B - Analysis Types.
PRE-PROCESSOR AREA
SeismoStruct projects are created in its Pre-Processor area, which features a series of modules that
are used in defining the structural model and its loading. These modules can be split into a general-type
of category (Materials, Sections, Element Classes, Nodes, Element Connectivity, Constraints,
Restraints, , Analysis Output) which apply to all types of analysis (that can be selected through a
drop-down menu), and into analysis-specific modules, which appear only in some types of analysis (e.g.
the Code-based Checks and the Performance Criteria modules appear to all types of analysis apart
from the Eigenvalue analysis, whereas the Adaptive Parameters module is available only if the user
chooses to run Static Adaptive Pushover Analysis).
In each aforementioned module it is possible to hide the data entry table through the corresponding
button (see below) in order to view the 3D rendering of the structural model in 'full-screen' modality.
Editing Buttons
Hide/Show table
Pre-Processor Modules
144 SeismoStruct User Manual
IMPORTANT: All input information required to run an analysis (e.g. structural model, load pattern,
output settings, etc.) is saved within a text-based SeismoStruct Project File, distinguishable by its *.spf
extension; double-clicking on these files will open SeismoStruct in the Pre-processor area directly.
UNITS SELECTOR
Both SI as well as English units systems can be used in SeismoStruct, with different possible
"combinations" being available for each of these two, since users are given the possibility of choosing
between the use of two diverse units to define Length and Force quantities; as the units of these two
base quantities are changed by the users, the program automatically adjusts the units of the remaining
derived entities (Mass, Stress, Acceleration, etc.). Customisation of the Units system is carried out in
the Units Selector dialog box, accessible from the main menu (Tools > Units Selector) or through the
corresponding toolbar button .
Below, please find a summary of the units systems that can be used in SeismoStruct. Note that
rotations are always given in radians.
SI Units
Length Force Mass Stress Acceleration Specific Weight
mm N ton MPa (9807) mm/sec2 N/mm3
mm kN kton GPa (9807) mm/sec2 kN/mm3
m N kg Pa (9.81) m/s2 N/m3
m kN ton kPa (9.81) m/s2 kN/m3
English Units
Length Force Mass Stress Acceleration Specific Weight
in lb lb*sec2/in psi (386.1) in/sec2 lb/in3
in kip kip*sec2/in ksi (386.1) in/sec2 kip/in3
ft lb lb*sec2/ft psf (32.17) ft/s2 lb/ft3
ft kip kip*sec2/ft ksf (32.17) ft/s2 kip/ft3
Further, two different rebar typologies may be employed, European and American. It is noted that any
combination of units (SI or English) and rebar types (European or American) may be used, for example
it is possible to use SI units with American rebars, as it is e.g. customary in Latin American countries.
Pre-Processor 145
EDITING
A common set of editing rules and options, which users are strongly advised to consult before
embarking on the task of creating a model, apply to all pre-processor modules and are described
below.
Editing functions
The majority of SeismoStruct modules feature a spreadsheet where all input parameters are kept and
displayed. The data contained in these module tables can be manipulated with the following tools:
NOTE: The identifiers (names) of module entries (materials, sections, nodes, loads, etc.) may be up to
32 characters long and should not contain spaces, #, & and punctuation marks (i.e. "." and ",").
changes to be applied. Again, multiple selection and editing facility can be employed to modify any
given input parameter in a multiple set of nodes, elements, restraints or assigned loads.
NOTE: In the Nodes, Element Connectivity, Restraints and Applied Loads modules users may select
more than one item using the Ctrl and Shift keys and change particular properties of them at the same
time. For example, the user may assign the same X coordinate in several nodes, or the same rotation
angle in several frame elements with just one move.
NOTE: Entry sorting is a program-wide feature, meaning that the way in which model components (e.g.
nodes, sections, elements, etc.) are sorted in their respective modules, reflects the way these entries
appear on all dialogue boxes in the program. For instance, if the user chooses to employ alphabetical
sorting of the nodes, then these will appear in alphabetical order in all drop-down menus where nodes
are listed, which may, in a given case, ease and speed up their individuation and selection.
Copying 3D plot
Users can also copy, to an external Windows application (e.g. Microsoft Word, Microsoft PowerPoint),
the 3D plot of the structural model being created. This is accomplished through the program menu
(Edit > Copy 3D Plot), through the respective toolbar button , through the plot popup menu
(available with the right-click mouse button) or through a keyboard shortcut (Ctrl+Alt+C).
Pre-Processor 147
Graphical Input/Generation
In addition to its menu-based model editing facility (and to the Wizard and Building Modeller facility),
structural models can also be generated in a completely graphical manner (Point & Click) through the
Graphical Input facility, available for Nodes, Element Connectivity, Constraints and Loads, as
described in the Structural Geometry paragraph.
Within this context, users are also advised to take advantage of the presence of Cut Planes visualisation
facility (see 3D Plot options paragraph), to ease the view and graphical generation of complex 3D
models and of the possibility of shrinking/expanding frame elements visualisation, again to facilitate
point & click of nodes.
Node/Element Groups
One other power-user facility of SeismoStruct consists on the possibility for the creation of node or
element groups. Typically, these nodes/elements feature common characteristics (e.g. they belong to
the top storey of a building, they define the deck of a bridge, etc.) and grouping them together serves
the purpose of facilitating their individuation and selection in many Pre- and Post-Processing
148 SeismoStruct User Manual
operations. The Groups dialog box is accessed from the main menu (Edit > Organise Groups…) or
through the corresponding toolbar button .
Users can add, edit and delete node and element groups using the Organise Groups facility, where a list
of all nodes and elements used in the current structural model are displayed.
In addition, users can also use a selection of nodes and elements, made within the Nodes and Element
Connectivity modules respectively, and use the popup menu to add them to a new group. The latter is
probably the most effective way of creating a new group, since users can in this way take advantage of
the different sorting options to make the selection of nodes/elements of interest significantly faster.
NOTE: The Groups facility is particular useful for selecting nodes and elements to be post-processed,
thus reducing the size of output files and speeding up post-processing operations.
3D Plot options
The settings of the 3D Plot of the structural model being created can be adjusted to best meet the
user's likings and requirements.
Display Layout
Within this pop-up menu, accessible through the toolbar button , users can (i) select a pre-defined
layout, such as Standard Layout (default), Transparent elements and Line elements (the latter is
particularly useful to visualise internal forces results), (ii) save their personal Display Layouts or (iii)
change the 3D Plot Options.
150 SeismoStruct User Manual
Display Layout
3D Plot Options…
The full range of plotting adjustment parameters, on the other hand, can be found in the 3D Plot
Options dialog box, accessible from the main menu (Tools > 3D Plot Options…) or through the
corresponding toolbar button .
Within the 3D Plot Options menu, there are a number of submenus from which users can not only
select which model components (nodes, frame and mass/damping elements, links, etc.) to show in the
plot but also change a myriad of settings such as the colour/transparency of elements, the plot axes
and background panels, the colour/transparency of load symbols, the colour of text descriptors, and so
on.
Pre-Processor 151
By default, the 3D Plot is automatically updated, implying that for every input change (e.g. addition of a
node or an element), the model plot is refreshed in real-time. This behaviour may be undesirable in
cases where the structural model is very large (several hundreds of nodes and elements) and/or the
user is using a laptop running on batteries with a slowed-down CPU (so as to increase the duration of
battery). In such situations the program takes some seconds to update the view, hence it might prove
to be more convenient for users to disable this feature (uncheck the Automatic 3D Plot Update option
in the 3D Plot Options General submenu) and thus opt for manual updating instead, carried out with
the Redraw 3D Plot command, found in the Tools and popup menus.
152 SeismoStruct User Manual
Model Expansion
Using this feature, accessible through the toolbar button , the 3D model may be expanded in each
global direction (i.e. X, Y and Z) by moving the corresponding cursor.
Model Expansion
Pre-Processor 153
Cut Planes
In addition to the previous features, also the Cut Planes option can be activated through the toolbar
button .
NOTE: By default the Display All option is selected from the drop-down menu.
Cut Planes
Additional operations
Users can also quickly zoom, rotate, and move the 3D/2D plot of the structural model, by using either
the mouse (highly recommended) or keyboard shortcuts. Further, it is also possible to point&click
nodes and elements, so as to quickly select their corresponding list entry. If, instead, the user chooses
to double-click a given node/element, then the corresponding editing dialog box opens.
Finally, by right-clicking on a given element, users can visualise the "summary" of the element
properties in a specific dialog box ( Element Properties from the drop-down menu).
NOTE 1: When users define non-structural nodes with very large coordinates, and then activate
visualisation of such nodes, the model will inevitably be zoomed-out to a very small viewing size. To
avoid such a scenario, users should (i) bring the non-structural nodes closer to the structure, (ii)
disable visualisation of the latter or (iii) zoom-in manually every time the 3D plot is refreshed.
NOTE 2: Activating visualisation of local axes may result in a quite congested 3D model representation,
especially when link elements are present, rendering difficult the interpretation/check of local axes'
orientation. In such cases, users may simply disable visualisation of some elements (e.g. frame
elements) in order to more readily check some others (e.g. links).
154 SeismoStruct User Manual
Element Properties
NOTE: If wheel zooming is excessive, then either use the keyboard or adjust your mouse wheel
scrolling settings (Windows Control Panel).
PROJECT SETTINGS
For each SeismoStruct project it is possible to customise both the usability of the program as well as
the performance characteristics of analytical proceedings, so as to better suit the needs of any given
structural model and/or the preferences of a particular user. This program/project tweaking facility is
Pre-Processor 155
available from the Project Settings panel, which can be accessed through Tools > Project Settings… or
through the corresponding toolbar button .
NOTE: Users are advised to always reset the Project Settings to its Program Defaults after the
installation of a new version, since there may be cases where these have not been correctly installed.
The Project Settings panel is subdivided in a number of tab windows, which provide access to different
type of settings, as described below:
General
Analysis
Elements
Constraints
Adaptive Pushover
Eigenvalue
Constitutive Models
Element Subdivision
Response Spectrum Analysis
Cracked/Uncracked Stiffness
Buckling
Convergence Criteria
Global Iterative Strategy
Element Iterative Strategy
Gravity & Mass
Integration Scheme
Damping
Common to all tab windows are the Program Defaults and Set As Default options found at the bottom of
the Project Settings panel. The Set As Default option is employed whenever the user wishes to define
new personalised default settings, which will then be used in all new projects subsequently created.
The Program Defaults, on the other hand, can be used to reload, at any time, the original program
defaults, as defined at installation time. Note, however, that the Program Defaults option does not
change the default program settings; it simply loads the installation settings in the current project.
Hence, if the user has previously personalised the default settings of the program (using the Set As
Default option) and then wishes to revert the program default settings back to the original installation
defaults, he/she should first load the Program Defaults and then choose the Set As Default option.
NOTE: For the majority of applications, there is no need for the Project Settings default values to be
modified, since these have been chosen so as to fit the requirements of standard type of analysis and
models, leading to optimised solutions in terms of performance efficiency and results accuracy.
General
The General settings provide the possibility of customising the usability of the program to the user's
likings and preferences.
Binary Output
When activated, the Binary Output option will lead to the creation of a binary file (*.srf) containing the
output of the entire analysis.
Text Output
When activated, the Text Output option will lead to the creation, at the end of every analysis, of a text
file (*.out) containing the output of the entire analysis (as given in the Step Output module). This
feature may result useful for users who wish to systematically post-process the results using their own
custom-made post-processing facility. For occasional access to text output, users are instead advised to
use the facilities made available in the Step Output module.
NOTE: At least one type of output, binary or text, should always be selected.
NOTE: The warning messages presented before the beginning of the analysis are automatically closed
after 2 minutes, if there is no input by the user.
Save Settings
The Save Settings option is used when the user wishes to always make the current project settings the
default settings for every new project that is subsequently created. With this checkbox selected, any
change in Project Settings will become a default, without the need for the Set as Default option to be
used.
NOTE: Normally, this option is disabled so that the default settings are only changed if explicitly
requested by the user (using the Set as Default option).
Pre-Processor 157
Autosave every...
So as to protect users against accidental deletion of project files, SeismoStruct automatically creates a
backup of the latter at user-specified time intervals (the default is 20 min). The backup files feature a
*.bak extension. This facility can be disabled by setting a time interval equal to zero.
Analysis
In the Analysis tab window some options related to the analysis can be defined. In particular, it is
possible to select the solver type, whether to perform eigenvalue analysis at every step in nonlinear
dynamic and pushover analysis and to account (or not) for geometric nonlinearities.
Solver
Users are able to select whether the initial loading, i.e. structural static loads, will be applied in one or
more steps. The default option is to apply it in one single step.
Further, the option of executing eigenvalue analysis at every step in nonlinear dynamic and pushover
analysis is available. Users may select to run an eigenvalue analysis at the end of the nonlinear analysis
or to perform eigenvalue analysis multiple times during the nonlinear analysis by specifying after how
many steps the eigenvalue analysis will be performed.
Users may currently choose between two different solvers:
The Skyline Method (Cholesky decomposition, Cuthill-McKee nodes ordering algorithm,
Skyline storage format);
The Frontal Method for sparse systems, introduced by Irons [1970] and featuring the
automatic ordering algorithm proposed by Izzuddin [1991].
158 SeismoStruct User Manual
Users may select between these two option, or let the program select the most appropriate solver,
depending on the characteristics of the structural model. It is noted that generally the Frontal solver is
considerably faster, especially in larger models. In contrast the Skyline method is usually more stable
and is capable of accommodating zero diagonal stiffness items. When the automatic option is selected,
which is the default option, the program performs a stability and size check prior to the analysis. If the
model is not very small (i.e. smaller than 25 nodes), and if it can run with the Frontal solver without
stability problems, this method is employed, otherwise the Skyline solver is chosen.
NOTE: Users are obviously advised to refer to the existing literature [e.g. Cook et al. 1989; Zienkiewicz
and Taylor 1991; Bathe 1996; Felippa 2004] for further details on these and other direct solvers.
Herein it is simply noted that the implemented Skyline solver, slower for very large models with
respect to its Frontal counterpart, tends to be more numerically stable and is thus the default option,
which users should change with care.
Geometric Nonlinearities
Unchecking this option will disable the geometric nonlinearity formulation described in Appendix A,
rendering the analysis linear, from a displacement/rotation viewpoint, which may be particularly
useful for users wishing to compare analysis results with hand calculations, for verification purposes.
By default this option is active for frame elements and deactivated for masonry elements.
It is also possible to run the analyses considering the linear elastic properties of materials. In order to
do this, user need to check the option 'Run with Linear Elastic Properties'.
NOTE: When users decide to run an analysis considering the linear elastic properties of materials (see
the option described above), they should keep in mind that, if the elements are modelled using RC
sections and 'infrm' elements, the infrm elements will account for the reinforcement; on the contrary,
if 'elfrm' elements are employed, their properties are calculated using the concrete modulus of
elasticity and the section dimensions, thus neglecting the effect of the reinforcement.
Elements
Herein some settings related to the analysis of frame elements can be defined.
NOTE: Stress Recovery option is only of use when distributed loads are defined through the definition
of material specific weight or of sectional/element additional mass, but not through the introduction
of dmass elements.
Carry out Performance Criteria Checks only at the End Integration Sections
By activating this option users may select to carry out the defined Performance Criteria checks only at
the end integration sections of the inelastic force-based element type (infrmFB), which are the
locations on the member where checks are typically carried out. In this way, only the useful results are
160 SeismoStruct User Manual
exported, without wasting time in processing the whole output for all the integration sections, and
without confusing the user with redundant output.
Do not consider the axial force contribution in the shear capacity of beams
By activating this option the ability to carry out shear checks ignoring the actual axial force applied on
the beam member is provided. This feature is particularly important to the shear capacity checks of
beams, when the interaction between fibre modelled RC beams and the rigid diaphragm adopted to
simulate the concrete slab (a very common configuration in RC buildings) may cause the development
of unintended fictitious axial forces in them.
Constraints
Constraints are typically implemented in structural analysis programs through the use of (i)
Geometrical Transformations, (ii) Penalty Functions, or (iii) Lagrange Multipliers. In
geometrically nonlinear analysis (large displacement/rotations), however, the first of these three
Pre-Processor 161
tends to lead to difficulties in numerical convergence, for which reason only the latter two are
commonly employed, and have thus been implemented in SeismoStruct.
NOTE: Users are advised to refer to the existing literature [e.g. Cook et al., 1989; Felippa, 2004] for
further information on this topic.
Herein it is simply noted that whilst Penalty Functions have the advantage of introducing no new
variables (and hence the stiffness matrix does not increase and remains positive definite), they may
significantly increase the bandwidth of the structural equations [Cook et al., 1989].
In addition, Penalty Functions have the disadvantage that penalty numbers must be chosen in an
allowable range (large enough to be effective but not so large as to induce numerical difficulties), and
this is not necessarily straightforward [Cook et al., 1989], and may potentially lead to erroneous
results.
However, the use of the conceptually superior Lagrange Multipliers may slow analyses considerably,
and, as such, the Penalty Functions are suggested as default in SeismoStruct.
In those cases where the employment of Lagrange Multipliers leads to numerical difficulties and
users opt for the utilisation of Penalty Functions, then the corresponding penalty coefficients, for
diaphragm (typically smaller) and rigid links (typically larger) need to be defined; the Penalty Factors
are then computed as the product of these penalty coefficients and the highest value found in the
stiffness matrix.
It is noted that, contrary to what could perhaps be one's intuition, the use of large values of penalty
coefficients is not always required. Indeed, in models where very stiff structural elements already
exist, penalty coefficients may need not to be extremely large, since their product by such large values
found in the structural stiffness matrix will already lead to a large penalty factor, as shown in the study
by Pinho et al. [2008a].
NOTE: Felippa [2004] suggests that the optimum penalty functions value should be the average of the
maximum stiffness and the processors precision (1e20, in the case of SeismoStruct).
Adaptive Pushover
In addition to the parameters defined in the Adaptive Parameters module, some advanced settings
can be selected in this window. These settings are: (i) the Type of Updating, (ii) the Update
Frequency and (iii) the Modal Combination method. They are described in detail hereafter.
Type of Updating
This adaptive option defines how the load distribution profile is updated at each analysis step. Four
alternatives are available:
Total Updating. The load vector for the current step is obtained through a full substitution of
the existing balanced loads (load vector at previous step) by a newly derived load vector,
computed as the product between the current total load factor, the current modal scaling
vector and the initial user-defined nominal load vector. This updating option is not
recommended, since it features limited theoretical support.
Incremental Updating. The load vector for the current step is obtained by adding to the load
vector of the previous step (existing balanced loads), a newly derived load vector increment,
computed as the product between the current load factor increment, the current modal scaling
vector and the initial user-defined nominal load vector. Incremental Updating usually is
conceptually sounder than total updating, for which reason it is the default option.
Hybrid Updating. With this third load vector updating option, the possibility of combining the
two methods described above, is provided. In this manner, the load vector for the current step
is obtained through partial substitution of the existing balanced load vector by a newly
derived load vector and by the partial addition of a newly derived load vector increment. The
percentage ratios that may lead to an optimum solution, in terms of accuracy and numerical
stability, obviously vary according to the model characteristics, the type loading it is subjected
to (displacements or forces), and the response spectra used in the determination of the modal
scaling vector (if one is being used).
Pre-Processor 163
Fully Incremental Updating. The load vector for the current step is obtained by adding to the
load vector of the previous step (existing balanced loads), a newly derived load vector
increment that reflects the changes in the current modal properties of the structure.
Update Frequency
This parameter defines how and when the modal scaling vector is updated during the analysis. Any
integer larger than zero can be used. The default is 1, which means that the load distribution is
updated at every analysis step, with the exception of steps where the analysis increment has been
reduced due to convergence difficulties (automatic step adjustment). In those cases where a very large
number of analysis steps have been defined by the user (i.e. the load is being applied in very small
increments), it might be advantageous to use a frequency value that is larger than 1 (i.e. the modal
scaling vector does not come updated at every step) so as to reduce the duration of the analysis
without loss of accuracy.
Eigenvalue
Whenever eigenvalue or adaptive pushover analyses need to be run, users may choose between two
different eigensolvers, the Lanczos algorithm presented by Hughes [1987] or the Jacobi algorithm
with Ritz transformation, in order to determine the modes of vibration of a structure. When the
automatic option is selected the most suitable eigensolver will be used depending on the number of
the degrees of freedom of the building. Each algorithm is described in detail hereafter.
Lanczos algorithm
The parameters listed below are used to control the way in which this eigensolver works:
Number of eigenvalues. The maximum number of eigenvalue solutions required by the user.
The default value is 10, which normally guarantees that, at least for standard structural
configurations, all modes of interest are adequately captured. Users might wish to increase
this parameter when analysing 3D irregular buildings and bridges, where modes of interest
might be found beyond the 10th eigensolution.
Maximum number of steps. The maximum number of steps required for convergence to be
reached. The default value is 50, sufficiently large to ensure that, for the vast majority of
structural configurations, solutions will always be obtained.
NOTE 1: Since the Lanczos algorithm implemented in SeismoStruct may struggle to converge with
small models featuring a limited number of degrees of freedom (i.e. 1 to 3), users are advised to
instead employ the Jacobi-Ritz option for such cases.
NOTE 2: When running an eigenvalue analysis, user may be presented with a message stating: "could
not re-orthogonalise all Lanczos vectors", meaning that the Lanczos algorithm could not calculate all or
some of the vibration modes of the structure. This behaviour may be observed in either (i) models
with assemblage errors (e.g. unconnected nodes/elements) or (ii) complex structural models that
feature links/hinges etc. If users have checked carefully their model and found no modelling errors,
then they may perhaps try to "simplify" it, by removing its more complex features until the attainment
of the eigenvalue solutions. This will enable a better understanding of what might be causing the
analysis problems, and thus assist users in deciding on how to proceed. This message typically appears
when too many modes are sought, e.g. when 30 modes are asked in a 24 DOF model, or when the
eigensolver cannot simply find so many modes (even if DOFs > modes).
NOTE: Users should make sure that the total number of Ritz vectors in the different directions does not
exceed the corresponding number of degrees-of-freedom (or of structurally meaningful modes),
otherwise unrealistic mode shapes and values will be generated
Pre-Processor 165
Constitutive Models
Herein, material models and response curves that will be displayed, respectively, in Materials module
and Element Classes module can be activated.
166 SeismoStruct User Manual
Element Subdivision
It is possible for users to subdivide existing elements defined in the Element Connectivity module into
2, 4, 5 and 6 smaller components. In that case, it is common for elements at the edge of the member,
where material inelasticity usually develops, to be smaller in length so as to more accurately model the
eventual formation of plastic hinges. The length of such edge elements can be customised in this menu.
If the 4-element subdivision has been selected, the default is for end elements to feature a length that is
15% that of the structural member, thus leading to a member subdivision, in terms of its length, of the
type 15%-35%-35%-15%. For the case of the 5- and 6-element subdivision facility, it becomes
necessary to establish the length of the new edge components (default is 10% of the initial length of
the element) and that of the "second" components (default is 20% of the initial length of the element).
Pre-Processor 167
Cracked/Uncracked Stiffness
Users may take into account the effect of cracking during the linear analyses, i.e. Eigenvalue and
Response Spectrum analyses, by selecting to use sections with cracked stiffness. The cracked stiffness
may be defined as a percentage of the corresponding uncracked stiffness, or, in the case of unelastic
frame elements only, from the section’s My/θy (bending moment at yield/chord rotation capacity at
yield) ratio. In the latter case, users should select the employed Code for the calculation of the chord
rotation capacity at yield.
Buckling
Whenever buckling analysis need to be run the eigensolver of the Jacobi algorithm with Ritz
transformation is employed, in order to determine the modes of vibration of a structure.
The user may specify:
Number of Ritz vectors (i.e. modes) to be generated in each direction (X, Y and Z). This
number cannot exceed the number of dof.
Maximum number of steps. The default value of 50 may, in general, remain unchanged.
NOTE: Users should make sure that the total number of Ritz vectors in the different directions does not
exceed the corresponding number of degrees-of-freedom (or of structurally meaningful modes),
otherwise unrealistic mode shapes and values will be generated
Convergence Criteria
Four different schemes are available in SeismoStruct for checking the convergence of a solution at the
end of each iteration:
Displacement/Rotation based
Force/Moment based
Displacement/Rotation AND Force/Moment based
Displacement/Rotation OR Force/Moment based
170 SeismoStruct User Manual
NOTE: Users are alerted to the fact that there is no such thing as a set of convergence criteria
parameters that will work for every single type of analysis. The default values in SeismoStruct will
usually work well for the vast majority of applications, but might need to be tweaked and modified for
particularly demanding projects, where strong response irregularities (e.g. large stiffness
differentials, buckling of some structural members, drastic change in loading patterns and intensity,
etc.) occur. As an example, note that a tighter convergence control may lead to higher numerical
stability, by preventing a structure from following a less stable and incorrect response path, but, if too
tight, may also render the possibility of achieving convergence almost impossible.
Displacement/Rotation based
Verification, at each individual degree-of-freedom of the structure, that the current iterative
displacement/rotation is less or equal than a user-specified tolerance, provides the user with direct
control over the degree of precision or, inversely, approximation, adopted in the solution of the
problem. In addition, and for the large majority of analyses, such local precision check is also sufficient
to guarantee the overall accuracy of the solution obtained. Therefore, this convergence check criterion
is the default option in SeismoStruct, with a displacement tolerance of 0.1 mm and a rotation tolerance
of 1e-4 rad, which lead to precise and stable solutions in the majority of cases.
Force/Moment based
There are occasions where the use of a displacement/rotation convergence check criterion is not
sufficient to guarantee a numerically stable and/or accurate solution, due to the fact that
displacement/rotation equilibrium does not guarantee, in such special cases, force/moment balance.
This is the typical behaviour, for instance, of simple structural systems (e.g. vertical cantilever), where
displacement/rotation convergence is obtained in a few iterations, such is the simplicity of the system
and its deformed shape, which however may not be sufficient for the internal forces of the elements to
be adequately balanced. Particularly, when an RC wall section is used, the stress-strain distribution
across the section may assume very complex patterns, by virtue of its large width, thus requiring a
Pre-Processor 171
General
Users may select if the convergence difficulties that might arise during the analysis will be visible in
the Post-Processor. The default option is to show the convergence difficulties.
Elements
If the Automatic Adaptation of the Convergence Norms is selected, in particular steps of the analysis,
where convergence is difficult to achieve, the program may smartly increase the defined convergence
norms, in order to enable convergence and to allow the program to move to the next steps. In order
not to allow for infinite increase in the value of the convergence norms, a limit is set by the Largest
Acceptable Increase of Norms combo box. The default option is to allow for the automatic adaptation of
the convergence norm.
NOTE 1: Convergence difficulties in force-based elements are often caused by the employment of a
large number of integration sections (e.g. default of 5) together with element discretisation (typically
in beams, where the reinforcement details change). In such cases, users should decrease the number
of integration sections to 3.
NOTE 2: As discussed in Appendix A, FB formulations can take due account of loads acting along the
member, thus avoiding the need for distributed loads to be transformed into equivalent point
forces/moments at the end nodes of the element, and for then lengthy stress-recovery to be carried
out.
35, leading to the adoption of a hybrid solution procedure between the classic NR and mNR
approaches (see also discussion in Incremental Iterative Algorithm).
Divergence iteration
This parameter defines the iteration after which divergence and iteration prediction checks are
performed (see divergence and iteration prediction for further details). On all subsequent step
iterations, if the solution is found to be diverging or if the predicted number of required iterations for
convergence is exceeded, the iterations within the current increment are interrupted, the load
increment (or time-step) is reduced and the analysis is restarted from the last point of equilibrium
(end of previous increment or analysis step).
Whilst these two checks are usually very useful in avoiding the computation of useless equilibrium
iterations in cases where lack of convergence becomes apparent at an early stage within a given
loading increment, it is also very difficult, if not impossible, to recommend an ideal value which will
work for all types of analysis. Indeed, if the divergence iteration is too low it may not allow highly
nonlinear problems to ever converge into a solution, whilst if it is too high it may allow the solution to
progress into a numerically spurious mode from which convergence can never be reached (typical of
models where elements with very high stiffness values are used to model rigid links). A value around
75% of the maximum number of iterations within an increment usually provides a good starting point.
The default in SeismoStruct is 32.
Maximum Tolerance
As discussed in Numerical instability, the possibility of the solution becoming numerically unstable is
checked at every iteration, right from the start of any given loading increment, by comparing the
Euclidean norm of out-of-balance loads (go to Appendix A for details on this norm) with a pre-defined
maximum tolerance (default is set to 1e20), several orders of magnitude larger than the applied load
vector. If the out-of-balance norm exceeds this tolerance, then the solution is assumed as numerically
unstable, iterations within the current increment are interrupted, the load increment (or time-step) is
reduced and the analysis is restarted from the last point of equilibrium (end of previous increment or
analysis step).
non-converged solution is very far from convergence, a large step decrease multiplier is used (default
= 0.125, i.e. the current analysis increment will be subdivided into 8 equal increments before the
analysis is restarted). If, on the other hand, the non-converged solution was very close to convergence,
then a small step decrease multiplier is employed (default = 0.5, i.e. the current analysis increment will
be subsequently applied in two steps). For intermediate cases, an average step decrease multiplier is
utilised instead (default = 0.25, i.e. the current load increment will be split into four equal loads).
Also as described in automatic stepping, once convergence is reached, the load increment or time-step
can be gradually increased, up to a size equal to its initial user-specified value. This is carried out
through the use of step increasing factors. When the analysis converges in an efficient manner (details
in Appendix A), a small step increase multiplier is used (default = 1.0, i.e. the current analysis
increment will remain unchanged in subsequent steps). If, on the other hand, the converged solution
was obtained in a highly inefficient way (details in Appendix A), then a large step increase multiplier is
employed (default = 2.0, i.e. the current load increment will be doubled). For intermediate cases, an
average step increase multiplier is utilised instead (default = 1.5, i.e. an increase of 50% will be applied
to the current analysis step).
NOTE: Users are alerted to the fact that there is no such thing as a set of incremental/iterative
parameters that will work for every single type of analysis. The default values in SeismoStruct will
usually work well for the vast majority of applications, but might need to be tweaked and modified for
particularly demanding projects, where strong response irregularities (e.g. large stiffness
differentials, buckling of some structural members, drastic change in loading patterns and intensity,
etc.) occur. As an example, note that a smaller load increment may lead to higher numerical stability,
by preventing a structure from following a less stable and incorrect response path, but, if too small,
may also render the possibility of achieving convergence almost impossible. Users facing difficulties
are advised to consult the Technical Support Forum, where additional guidance and advice is
provided.
176 SeismoStruct User Manual
Mass Settings
Three options are offered for defining mass in dynamic analysis, IDA and eigenvalue analysis: i) From
the Frame Elements, based on the specific weight of their materials and their section's additional mass,
as well as the Mass Elements (lmass and dmass), ii) From Loads, point and distributed (the mass is
applied in the gravity direction ONLY, and its value is based on the g value), and iii) From both options
(i) and (ii) above, i.e. from both Frame/Mass Elements and Loads. The first option is set by default.
Further, when running dynamic analyses, it may sometimes come handy to have the possibility of
constraining the dynamic degrees-of-freedom to only a few directions of interest, in order to speed up
the analyses or avoid the development of spurious response modes in those directions where the
structural mesh was intentionally not adequately devised or refined. This can be done here, by
unchecking those dofs that are not of interest (by default, all dofs are activated, i.e. checked). It is also
noted that these settings take precedence over the 'mass directions' defined in the lumped/distributed
mass elements, that is, if a given distributed mass element should define mass only in the x direction,
178 SeismoStruct User Manual
for instance, but all dofs were to be selected in the Global Mass Directions settings, then even if such
element mass contribution to the global Mass matrix of the structure would indeed be considered only
in the x direction, the dynamic analysis will nonetheless consider all dofs as active.
NOTE: Analyses of large models featuring distributed mass/loading are inevitably longer than those
where lumped masses, and corresponding point loads, are employed to model, in a more simplified
fashion, the mass/weight of the structure. If users are not interested in obtaining information on the
local stress state of structural elements (e.g. beam moment distribution), but are rather focused only
on estimating the overall response of the structure (e.g. roof displacement and base shear), then the
employment of a faster lumped mass/force modelling approach may prove to be a better option, with
respect to its distributed counterpart.
Gravity Settings
In SeismoStruct loads may be defined in two ways: (i) explicitly in the Applied Loads module, and (ii)
indirectly from the transformation of the masses of the structural model to loads.
There are three available options for defining Loads from masses: i) Loads are not derived from
masses. ii) Loads are derived from masses, based on the g value, but ONLY in the gravity direction,
which is the default option, and iii) Loads are derived from masses in any translational direction,
according to user-defined coefficients.
NOTE 1: Loads defined in the Applied Loads module are always applied to the structural model,
irrespective of the employed option for the masses-to-loads transformations.
NOTE 2: The mass-derived loads are internally transformed into equivalent nodal forces/moments,
with the exception of elastic and inelastic frame elements, in which mass-derived loads are distributed
along the element.
In addition, the user may also define the value of acceleration of gravity ‘g’ (which is to be multiplied
by the masses in order to obtain the permanent loads) and also the direction in which the latter is to be
considered. Clearly, for the vast majority of standard applications, the default values (g=9.81 m/s 2,
considered in the -z direction) need not to be modified.
NOTE 3: Stress-recovery (Project Settings > Elements > Carry out Stress Recovery) may be employed to
retrieve correct internal forces when distributed loads are defined (through the definition of material
specific weight or of sectional/element additional mass, but not through the introduction of dmass
elements).
Pre-Processor 179
Integration Scheme
In nonlinear dynamic analysis, a numerical direct integration scheme must be employed in order to
solve the system of equations of motion [e.g. Clough and Penzien, 1993; Chopra, 1995]. In
SeismoStruct, such integration can be carried out by means of two different implicit integration
algorithms that the user may choose (i) the Newmark integration scheme [Newmark, 1959] or (ii)
the Hilber-Hughes-Taylor integration algorithm [Hilber et al., 1977].
NOTE: For further discussion and clarification on issues of step-by-step solution procedures, explicit
vs. implicit methods, stability conditions, numerical damping, and so on, users are strongly advised to
refer to available literature, such as the work by Clough and Penzien [1993], Cook et al. [1988] and
Hughes [1987], to name but a few.
Damping
In nonlinear dynamic analysis, hysteretic damping, which usually is responsible for the dissipation of
the majority of energy introduced by the earthquake action, is already implicitly included within the
nonlinear fibre model formulation of the inelastic frame elements or within the nonlinear force-
displacement response curve formulation used to characterise the response of link elements. There is,
however, a relatively small quantity of non-hysteretic type of damping that is also mobilised during
dynamic response of structures, through phenomena such friction between structural and non-
structural members, friction in opened concrete cracks, energy radiation through foundation, etc, that
might not have been modelled in the analysis. Traditionally, such modest energy dissipation sources
have been considered through the use of Rayleigh damping [e.g. Clough and Penzien, 1993; Chopra,
1995] with equivalent viscous damping values () varying from 1% to 8%, depending on structural
type, materials used, non-structural elements, period and magnitude of vibration, mode of vibration
being considered, etc [e.g. Wakabayashi, 1986].
Some disagreement exists amongst the scientific/engineering community with regards to the use of
equivalent viscous damping to represent energy dissipation sources that are not explicitly included in
the model. Indeed, some authors [e.g. Wilson, 2001] strongly suggest for such equivalent modelling to
be avoided altogether, whilst others [Priestley and Grant, 2005; Hall, 2006] advice its employment but
not by means of Rayleigh damping, which is proportional to both mass and stiffness, but rather
through the use of stiffness-proportional damping only; as discussed by Pegon [1996], Wilson [2001],
Abbasi et al. [2004] and Hall [2006], amongst others, if a given structure is "insensitive" to rigid body
motion, mass-proportional damping will generate spurious (i.e. unrealistic) energy dissipation. The
stiffness-proportional damping modelling approach may then be further subdivided in initial stiffness-
182 SeismoStruct User Manual
proportional damping and tangent stiffness-proportional damping, the latter having been shown by
Priestley and Grant [2005] as the possibly soundest option for common structures.
Nonetheless, even if one would be able to include all sources of energy dissipation within a given finite
elements model (and this is definitely always the best option, i.e. to explicitly model infills, dampers,
SSI, etc), the introduction of even a very small quantity of equivalent viscous damping might turn out
to be very beneficial in terms of the numerical stability of highly inelastic dynamic analyses, given that
the viscous damping matrix will have a "stabilising" effect in the system of equations. As such, its use is
generally recommended, albeit with small values.
In the Damping dialog box, the user may therefore choose:
not to use any viscous damping;
to employ stiffness-proportional damping;
to introduce mass-proportional damping;
to utilise Rayleigh damping.
Stiffness-proportional damping
For stiffness-proportional damping, the user is asked to enter the value of the stiffness matrix
multiplier (K) that he/she intends to use.
Typically, though not exclusively, such value is computed using the following equation:
𝑇𝜉
𝛼𝐾 =
𝜋
The user is also asked to declare if the damping is proportional to (i) the initial stiffness or (ii) the
tangent stiffness.
Pre-Processor 183
NOTE 1: The value of the tangent stiffness-proportional damping matrix is updated at every load
increment, not at every iteration, since the latter would give rise to higher numerical instability and
longer run times.
NOTE 2: Should numerical difficulties arise with the use of tangent stiffness-proportional damping, the
user is then advised to employ initial stiffness-proportional damping instead, using however a reduced
equivalent viscous damping coefficient, so as to avoid the introduction of exaggeratedly high viscous
damping effects. Whilst a 2-3% viscous damping might be a reasonable assumption when analysing a
reinforced structure using tangent stiffness-proportional damping, a much lower value of 0.5-1%
damping should be employed if use is made of its initial stiffness-proportional damping counterpart.
Mass-proportional damping
For mass-proportional damping, the user is asked to enter the value of the mass matrix multiplier
(M) that he/she intends to use.
Typically, though not exclusively, such value is computed using the following equation:
4𝜋𝜉
𝛼𝑀 =
𝑇
Rayleigh damping
For Rayleigh damping, the user is asked to enter the period (T) and damping () values of the first
and last modes of interest (herein named as modes 1 and 2).
The mass-proportional (M) and stiffness-proportional (K) matrices multiplying coefficients are then
computed by the program, using the expressions given below, which ensure that true Rayleigh
damping is obtained (if arbitrarily defined coefficients would be used, this would imply that matricial
rather than Rayleigh damping would be employed):
𝜉1 𝑇1 − 𝜉2 𝑇2 𝑇1 𝑇2 𝜉2 𝑇1 − 𝜉1 𝑇2
𝛼𝑀 = 4𝜋 𝑎𝑛𝑑 𝛼𝐾 =
𝑇12 − 𝑇22 𝜋 𝑇12 − 𝑇22
NOTE 1: A relatively large variety of different types of matricial damping exists and is used in different
FE codes. These variations may present advantages with respect to traditional Rayleigh damping; e.g.
reducing the level of damping that is introduced in higher modes and so on. However, we believe that
such level of refinement and versatility is not necessarily required for the majority of analysis, for
which reason only the above three viscous damping modalities are featured in the program.
184 SeismoStruct User Manual
NOTE 2: There is significant scatter in the different proposals regarding the actual values of equivalent
viscous damping to employ when running dynamic analysis of structures, and the user is advised to
investigate this matter thoroughly, in order to arrive at the values that might prove to be more
adequate to his/her analyses. Herein, we note simply that the value will depend on the material type
(typically higher values are used in concrete, with respect to steel, for instance), structural
configuration (e.g. an infilled multi-storey frame may justify higher values with respect to a SDOF
bridge bent), deformation level (at low deformation levels it might be justified to employ equivalent
viscous damping values that are higher than those used in analyses where buildings are pushed deep
into their inelastic range, since in the latter case contribution of non-structural elements is likely to be
of lower significance, for instance), modelling strategy (e.g. in fibre modelling cracking is explicitly
account for and, as such, it does not need to be somehow represented by means of equivalent viscous
damping, as is done instead in plastic hinge modelling using bilinear moment-curvature
relationships).
NOTE 3: Damping forces in models featuring elements of very high stiffness (e.g. bridges with stiff
abutments, buildings with stiff walls, etc) may become unrealistic - overall damping in a bridge model
can introduce significant damping forces, due e.g. to very high stiffness of abutments.
MATERIALS
Materials that are to be available within a SeismoStruct project come defined in the Materials module,
where (i) the name (used to identify the material within the project), (ii) the type (listed below), (iii)
the mechanical properties (i.e. strength, modulus of elasticity, strain-hardening, etc.) and (iv) the
parameters needed for the Code-based Checks (eg. existing or new material) of each particular
material can be defined.
Materials module
Pre-Processor 185
IMPORTANT: Only the material types that have been previously activated in the Constitutive Model tab
window (Tools > Project Settings > Constitutive Model) will appear in the Materials module.
As anticipated in Tutorial N.1, two options are available for inserting a new material:
1. Add Material Class;
2. Add General Material.
Currently, twenty material types are available in SeismoStruct. By default, all the material types may
be selected without any changes in the Project Settings panel. The complete list of materials is
proposed hereafter:
Bilinear steel model - stl_bl
Menegotto-Pinto steel model - stl_mp
Bilinear steel model with isotropic strain hardening- stl_bl2
Giuffre-Menegotto-Pinto Model with Isotropic Hardening – stl_gmp
Ramberg-Osgood steel model - stl_ro
Dodd-Restrepo steel model – stl_dr
Monti-Nuti steel model - stl_mn
Buckling Restrained steel brace model – stl_brb
Mander et al. nonlinear concrete model - con_ma
Trilinear concrete model - con_tl
Chang-Mander nonlinear concrete model – con_cm
Kappos and Konstantinidis nonlinear concrete model - con_hs
Engineered cementitious composites material– con_ecc
Kent-Scott-Park concrete model – con_ksp
Trilinear masonry model - mas_tl
Parabolic masonry model - mas_par
Superelastic shape-memory alloys model - se_sma
Trilinear FRP model - frp_tl
186 SeismoStruct User Manual
NOTE: In SeismoStruct, the Poisson coefficient is assumed as equal to 0.2 for concrete and 0.3 for steel.
SECTIONS
Cross-sections that are to be available within a SeismoStruct project come defined in the Sections
module, where (i) the name (used to identify the section within the project), (ii) the type (listed
below), (iii) materials (as defined in the Materials module), (iv) dimensions (length, width, etc.) and (v)
reinforcement (if supported) can be explicitly defined.
Sections module
SeismoStruct allows also selecting predefined steel sections by clicking on the Add Steel Profile
button. A database of the most common steel sections (e.g. HEA, HEB, IPE, etc.) is available, as well as
W and HSS sections which have been introduced with the release of v7.0 of SeismoStruct.
Pre-Processor 187
From SeismoStruct v7.0 onwards, it is possible to introduce double steel sections by checking the
corresponding checkbox at the New Predefined Section dialog box:
Currently, seventy two section types are available in SeismoStruct. These range from simple single-
material solid sections to more complex reinforced concrete and composite sections.
Rectangular solid section - rss
188 SeismoStruct User Manual
By making use of these section types, the user is able to create up an unlimited number of different
cross-sections, which will then be used to define the different element classes of a structural model.
For a comprehensive description of the section types, refer to Appendix D - Sections.
ELEMENT CLASSES
Elements that are to be available within a SeismoStruct project come defined in the Element Classes
module. Element types are used to define element classes exactly in the same manner that material
types were used to define materials or section types were employed to define sections. Hence, just as
190 SeismoStruct User Manual
for the case of materials and sections, in a SeismoStruct project there may exist any given number of
different element classes belonging to the same element type (e.g. to model two different columns the
user needs to define two different element classes, both appertaining to the same element type - frame
elements). The element classes defined in this module are then employed in the Element Connectivity
module to create the actual elements that form-up the structural model being built.
Currently, seventeen element types, divided in three categories (Beam-column element types, Link
element types and Mass and Damping element types), are available in SeismoStruct.
Inelastic frame elements - infrmDB, infrmFB
Inelastic plastic-hinge frame element – infrmFBPH, infrmDBPH
Elastic frame element - elfrm
Inelastic infill panel element - infill
Inelastic truss element – truss
Inelastic masonry frame element – masonry
Rack element - rack
Link element – link
Shallow footingsn macro-element – ssilink1
Pile Foundation macro-element – ssilink2
Elastomeric Bearing Element (Bouc Wen) – bearing1
Friction Pendulum Bearing/System – bearing2
Mass elements - lmass & dmass
Damping element - dashpt
By making use of these element types, the user is able to create an unlimited number of different
elements classes that are not only able to accurately represent intact/repaired structural members
(columns, beams, walls, beam-column joints, etc.) and non-structural components (infill panels, energy
dissipating devices, inertia masses, etc.) but also allow the modelling of different boundary conditions,
such as flexible foundations, seismic isolation, structural gapping/pounding and so on.
NOTE 1: Some element types (e.g. mass and damping elements) cannot be used in certain analysis
types (e.g. static analysis) and thus may not always be available in the Element Classes module.
Pre-Processor 191
NOTE 2: Users may find interesting information/suggestions about the modelling of structural and
non-structural components in the NEHRP Seismic Design Technical Brief No. 4 (refer to the
Bibliography).
For a comprehensive description of the element types, refer to Appendix E - Element Classes.
STRUCTURAL GEOMETRY
Defining the geometry of the structure being modelled is a four-step procedure. Firstly, all structural
and non-structural nodes are defined, after which element connectivity can be stipulated. The process is
then concluded with the assignment of structural restraints, which fully characterize the structure's
boundary conditions. In addition to this, “optional” Constraints can be defined.
So, the structural geometry is defined through the following modules, which will be described below:
Nodes
Element Connectivity
Constraints
Restraints
NOTE: An upper bound value of 50000 is set as the maximum number of nodes or elements that can be
defined in a SeismoStruct model.
192 SeismoStruct User Manual
Nodes
Two types of nodes are available in SeismoStruct: structural and non-structural.
Structural nodes
Are all those nodes to which an element, of whichever type, is attached to. In fact, in SeismoStruct it is
not possible to run an analysis of any type if a node that has been defined as "structural" does not
feature at least one element connected to it. Put in other words, structural nodes are all those to which
degrees-of-freedom are assigned and then included in the assemblage of stiffness matrix and
load/displacement vectors.
Non-structural nodes
Are nodes that are not to be considered in the solution of the structure but are instead usually needed
to define the orientation of local axes of certain types of elements (as described in element
connectivity). No elements of any type can be attached to this type of nodes and whilst it is obvious
that structural nodes can also be used as a reference point in the definition of these local axes, it
usually results much more simple and clear to reserve this role to their non-structural counterparts.
The user is referred to the global and local axes systems chapter for a deeper discussion on this
subject. By default, non-structural nodes do not result visible on the 3D plot of the model, a condition
that can be easily modified through a change in the display settings.
NOTE: When users define non-structural nodes with very large coordinates and then activate
visualisation of such nodes, the model will inevitably be zoomed-out to a very small viewing size. To
avoid such a scenario, users should (i) bring the non-structural nodes closer to the structure, (ii)
disable visualisation of the latter or (iii) zoom-in manually every time the 3D plot is refreshed.
Nodes module
As in all other modules, the user is capable of adding new nodes (also through the Graphical Input
button) and removing/editing existing selected ones.
Pre-Processor 193
Adding/Editing nodes
NOTE: An editing feature that might come very useful to users is the ability to change a co-ordinate
type of a large number of nodes through a single operation, by making a multiple selection and
opening the Edit dialog box. This can be very handy, for example, when one needs to change the y-
coordinates of all nodes of a frame that is to be moved into a different position in space.
194 SeismoStruct User Manual
Nodes can be sorted according to their names or their x-, y- or z- coordinates. If the user clicks once on
the header of the corresponding column, ascending sorting is adopted, whilst if a second click is
employed, the nodes become sorted in descending fashion (see Editing functions for further details on
data sorting).
The Nodes module features also an Incrementation facility with which the user can create new nodes
through "repetition" of existing ones. This is done by:
1. Selecting a set of nodes that will serve as the base for the incrementation;
2. Clicking the Incrementation button;
3. Specifying the increment in the name and coordinates of the node(s) and finally deciding on
the number of "Repetitions" to be carried out.
Element Connectivity
The different elements of the structure are defined in the Element Connectivity module, where their
name, element class, corresponding nodes, rigid offsets, force/moment releases and eventually
activation time/L.F. are identified.
It is noted that the possibility of defining an activation (and deactivation) time/L.F. is provided within
each element. The default values are -1e20 for activation (in order to cater for cyclic pushover
analysis) and 1e20 for deactivation; this means that the element is activated at the beginning of any
analysis and it will not be deactivated.
Pre-Processor 195
As in all other modules, the user is capable of adding new elements (also through the Graphical Input
button) and removing or editing existing selected elements (see Editing functions).
NOTE: Users can also change in a single operation, for instance, the non-structural node used in a large
number of elements, again by taking advantage of the multiple selection and editing features.
In order to add a new element in the Table Input, the user has to follow the steps listed below:
1. Click the Add button;
2. Assign a name;
3. Select the Element Class from the drop-down menu;
4. Select the corresponding nodes using the respective drop-down menus (or graphically);
5. Define the Element Orientation by Rotation Angle or by Additional nodes;
6. Select the Activation and Deactivation time/L.F.
2
4 Node’s selection
3 (Graphical Input)
NOTE 1: The number of element nodes, which need to be selected, depends on the Element Class.
NOTE 2: Users may use the 'activation time' feature to exclude gravity loads from retrofitting elements
(i.e. by activating retrofitting elements only after the first analysis step, which involves the application
of gravity loads).
Pre-Processor 197
Otherwise, in order to graphically add a new element in the Graphical Input mode, the user has to:
1. Click the Graphical Input button;
2. Select the Element Class from the drop-down menu;
3. Double-click in the ‘graphical space’ to define all the element nodes.
NOTE: The name of the new element is the concatenation of the element prefix and suffix.
In addition, however, Incrementation and Subdivision facilities are equally available. As in the case of
nodes, element incrementation enables the automatic generation of new elements through "repetition"
of existing ones. It functions in very much the same manner as the automatic generation of nodes, with
the difference that instead of nodal coordinates, it is the names of element nodes that are incremented.
This facility obviously requires that element names respect the number (e.g. 100) or word+number
(e.g. elm20) formats.
Element subdivision, on the other hand, serves the purpose of providing the user with a tool for easy
and fast subdivision of existing frame elements, so as to refine the mesh in localised areas (for instance
to increase the accuracy of the analysis in zones of high inelasticity that have been detected only after
running a first analysis with a coarser mesh). The creation of the new internal nodes, the generation of
the new smaller elements and the updating of element connectivity is all carried out automatically by
the program. Users can subdivide existing elements into 2, 4, 5 and 6 smaller components, the length of
which is computed as a percentage of the original element's size, as defined in Project Settings >
Element Subdivision.
198 SeismoStruct User Manual
NOTE: Whilst a too course finite element mesh may lead to the impossibility of accurately reproducing
certain response shapes/mechanisms, an exaggeratedly mesh refinement may lead to unnecessary
long analyses and, in some instances, to less stable solutions. Hence, users are advised to make well
balanced and judged decisions on the level of mesh refinement that they decide to introduce, ideally
carrying out sensitivity studies in order to define the point of optimum balance between accuracy,
numerical stability and analysis' run times.
In what follows, an overview of connectivity requirements for each of the element types available in
SeismoStruct is given.
Elastic and Inelastic frame elements - infrmFB, infrmDB, infrmFBPH, infrmDBPH & elfrm
Two nodes need to be defined for these element types, representing the end-nodes of the element, thus
defining its length, position in space and direction (local axis 1). A rotation angle or a third node is
required so as to define the orientation of the element's cross section (local axes 2 and 3), as described
in Global and local axes system.
Pre-Processor 199
Edit Element
In addition, for each frame element it is possible to specify Rigid offsets lengths (in global coordinates)
by assigning a value for dX, dY and dZ to Nodes 1 and 2, respectively. Furthermore, users may also
'release' one or more of the element degrees of freedom (forces or moments) from the joints.
NOTE: Moment/force releases are always specified in the element local coordinate system.
NOTE: The internal struts 1, 2 and 5 of the panel will then be those connecting its first and third nodes,
whilst internal struts 3, 4 and 6 will be made to connect the second and fourth panel corners.
Node 4 Node 3
Node 1 Node 2
Edit Element
In addition, for each wall element it is possible to specify Rigid offsets lengths (in global coordinates) by
assigning a value for dX, dY and dZ to Nodes 1 and 2, respectively.
202 SeismoStruct User Manual
Edit Element
NOTE 1: Instead of the definition of a third and a fourth node, users may simply employ the keyword
'default', which implies that local axis-1 is along the X global axis and local axis-3 is along the Z global
axis.
NOTE 2: Users are advised to make use of a non-structural node in the definition of the third and
fourth element nodes.
204 SeismoStruct User Manual
Lumped masses
In building frames subjected to horizontal excitation, it is customary to assign one lumped element at
each beam-column connection, although one element per storey will provide sufficient accuracy for the
majority of applications (where vertical excitation and axial beam deformation are negligible).
When analysing bridges, on the other hand, it is common to concentrate deck inertia mass at pier-deck
intersection nodes, unless a more rigorous approach is required [e.g. Casarotti and Pinho, 2006].
Distributed Mass
Constraints
The different constraining conditions of the structure are defined in the Constraints module, where
the constraint type, the associated master node, the restrained DOFs and the slave nodes are identified.
Three different nodal constraint types are available in SeismoStruct:
Rigid Link
Rigid Diaphragm
Equal DOF
As in all other modules, the user is capable of adding new conditions (also through the Graphical Input
button) and removing or editing existing ones (see Editing functions).
206 SeismoStruct User Manual
Constraints module
In order to add a new constraint in the Table Input, the user has to follow the steps listed below:
1. Click the Add button;
2. Select the constraint type from the drop-down menu;
3. Select the restrained DOFs from the drop-down menu(s);
4. Select the master node from the drop-down menu;
5. Select the slave node(s) by checking the corresponding boxes.
Otherwise, in order to graphically add a new constraint in the Graphical Input mode, the user has to:
1. Click the Graphical Input button;
2. Select the constraint type from the drop-down menu;
3. Select the restrained DOFs from the drop-down menu(s)
4. Double-click to define the master node;
5. Double-click to define the slave node(s);
6. Finally click the Finalise Constraint button to complete the process.
Pre-Processor 207
NOTE 1: The application of displacement loads to nodes constrained to displace together may lead to
convergence problems (because the applied displacements may be in contrast with the enforced
constraint). Amongst many other modelling scenarios, this is particularly relevant when carrying out
displacement-based Adaptive Pushover on a 3D model with displacement loads distributed
throughout the floor (in such cases either the diaphragm should be eliminated or the displacement
loads applied only on the sides of the floor).
NOTE 2: When only two nodes are concerned, from a Finite Elements programming point of view,
master and slave nodes are identical; both are "simply" two nodes connected between them. Do refer
to the literature for further discussions on this topic [e.g. Cook et al., 1989; Felippa, 2004].
Rigid Link
Constrain certain degrees-of-freedom of slave nodes to a master node, by means of a rigid link. In other
words, the rotations of the slave node are equal to the rotations of the master node, whilst the
translations of the former are computed assuming a rigid lever-arm connection with the latter. Both
master and slave nodes need to be defined for this constraint type, and the degrees-of-freedom to be
slaved to the master node (restraining conditions) have to be assigned.
208 SeismoStruct User Manual
Rigid Diaphragm
Constrain certain degrees-of-freedom of slave nodes to a master node, by the use of rigid planes (i.e. all
constrained nodes will rotate/displace in a given plane maintaining their relative position unvaried, as
if they were all connected by rigid lever-arms). As for the previous constraint type, both master and
slave nodes need to be defined, with the master node typically corresponding to the baricentre of the
diaphragm. Moreover the restraining conditions, in terms of rigid plane connections (X-Y, X-Z and Y-Z
plane), need also to be assigned.
NOTE 1: In general, the diaphragm master node location should correspond to the centre of mass of
each floor (it is noted that the location of slab master nodes in Wizard-created 3D models is merely
demonstrative and not necessarily correct).
NOTE 2: Constraining all the nodes of a given floor level to a rigid diaphragm may lead to an artificial
stiffening/strengthening of the beams, since the latter become prevented from deforming axially (it is
recalled that unrestrained nonlinear fibre elements subjected to flexure will deform axially, since the
neutral axis is not at the section's baricentre). Users are therefore advised to use great care in the
employment of Rigid Diaphragm constraints, carefully selecting the floor nodes that are to be
constrained.
Equal DOF
Constrain certain degrees-of-freedom of slave nodes to a master node. Contrary to the Rigid Link
constraint, here all constrained dofs (rotations and translations) of master and slave nodes feature the
exact same value (i.e. no rigid lever-arm connection exists between them). Both master and slave
nodes need to be defined for this constraint type, and the degrees-of-freedom to be slaved to the
master node (restraining conditions) have to be assigned.
NOTE: In previous releases of SeismoStruct, link elements featuring a lin_sym response curve were
typically employed to model pinned joints (zero stiffness) and/or Constraints. However, users may
now use the Equal DOF facility of this Constrain module to achieve the same objective; e.g. a pin/hinge
may be modelled by introducing an 'Equal DOF' constrain defined for translation degrees-of-freedom
only.
210 SeismoStruct User Manual
Restraints
The boundary conditions of a model are defined in the Restraints module, where all structural nodes
are listed and available for selection and restraining against deformation in any of the six degrees-of-
freedom.
Restraints module
When carrying out 2D analysis, it might be useful to restrain all out-of-plane degrees-of-freedom, so as
to minimise running time. Hence, and as an example, for a model defined and responding in the x-z
plane (2D models created with the Wizard feature are defined in this plane), all nodes should possess
y+rx+rz restraining conditions. Note that for this common type of situations (y=0, and y+rx+rz
restrained for all the nodes) the y+rx+rz restraints are not shown on the 3D plot, for reasons of clarity.
The modelling of foundation flexibility can be accomplished through the use of link elements, the first
structural node of which is restrained in all directions (x+y+z+rx+ry+rz), whilst the second is
connected to the structure. Any of the currently available response curves can then be employed to
model the elastic or inelastic response of the soil in each of the six degrees-of-freedom.
NOTE: In order to model yield penetration at the base, when present, it suffices to increase the length
of the corresponding column element by the adequate amount. Refer to the available literature for
indications on how to compute such yield penetration length [e.g. Paulay and Priestley, 1992; Priestley
et al., 1996].
LOADING
Once the structural geometry has been defined, the users have the possibility of defining the loading
applied to the structure through the Applied Loads module. Then, a number of additional settings,
which vary according to the type of analysis being carried, must be specified in the following modules:
Loading Phases
Time-history Curves
Adaptive Parameters
IDA Parameters
RSA Parameters
NOTE: Obviously none of these modules will appear when the Eigenvalue analysis is selected.
Nodal Loads
In SeismoStruct there are four nodal load categories that can be selected. These can be applied to any
structural model, either in isolated fashion or in a combined manner, depending on the type of analysis
being carried out. Further, it is noteworthy that the term "load", as employed in SeismoStruct, refers to
any sort of action that can be applied to a structure, and may thus consist of forces, displacements
and/or accelerations.
As in all other modules, the user is capable of adding new loads and removing/editing existing ones. In
addition, a load incrementation facility is also available, so as to enable easier generation of new nodal
actions. It functions in very much the same manner as the automatic generation of nodes does; the user
defines node name and load value increments, and these are then employed to automatically generate
212 SeismoStruct User Manual
new nodal actions through "repetition" of a selected set of already prescribed loads. This facility
requires that node names respect the number (e.g. 100) or word+number (e.g. nod20) formats.
Load Incrementation
When running an analysis, permanent loads are considered prior to any other type of load, and can be
used on all analysis types, with the exception of Eigenvalue analysis, where the permanent loads are
only used to derive masses, if a relevant option has been chosen in the Project Settings > Gravity &
Mass module.
NOTE 1: Gravity loads should be applied downwards, for which reason they always feature a negative
value.
Pre-Processor 213
NOTE 2: If it has been selected from the Project Settings -> Gravity & Mass menu that loads are derived
from masses (in the gravity direction based on the g value, or in any translational direction, according
to user-defined coefficients) and the model already features the presence of masses (defined in the
materials, sections or element classes modules), then the program will automatically compute and
apply distributed permanent loads.
Incremental Loads
Static TH Load
Dynamic TH Loads
These loads can be used in dynamic time history analysis, to reproduce the response of a structure
subjected to an earthquake, or in incremental dynamic analysis, to evaluate the horizontal structural
capacity of a structure.
NOTE 1: The application of displacement loads to nodes constrained to displace together (e.g. through
a rigid link or similar) may lead to convergence problems (because the applied displacements may be
in contrast with the enforced constraint).
NOTE 2: With force-based frame element formulations it is possible to explicitly model loads acting
along the member, and hence avoid the need for distributed loads to be transformed into equivalent
point forces/moments at the end nodes of the element (and then for lengthy stress-recovery to be
employed to retrieve accurate member action-effects). However, such feature could not yet be
implemented in SeismoStruct.
NOTE 3: Strength and stiffness of infill elements are introduced after the application of the initial
loads, so that the former do not resist to gravity loads (which are normally absorbed by the
surrounding frame, erected first). If users wish their infills to resist gravity loads, then they should
define the latter as non-initial loads.
NOTE 4: When assessing the horizontal capacity of non-symmetric structures, users should take care
to consider the application of the incremental loads in both directions (i.e. run two pushover analyses)
in order to identify the capacity of the structure in both its "weak" and "strong" directions.
NOTE 5: Users who wish to apply loads (including accelerograms) with an angle of incidence different
from 90 degrees, can do so by defining such loads in terms of multiple-direction components (x, y, z).
NOTE 6: Explosions may produce three distinct types of loading: (i) air shock wave, which can be
considered as an impulsive load, dynamic action or a quasi-static wave depending on its
characteristics, (ii) dynamic pressure applied to the structure due to gas expansion and (iii) ground
shock wave, which has three types of waves with different velocities and frequencies, namely,
compression waves, shear waves and surface waves [Chege and Matalanga, 2000]. Therefore,
Permanent, Static time-history and Dynamic time-history loads should be employed when modelling
this type of action.
216 SeismoStruct User Manual
As in all other modules, the user is capable of adding new loads and removing/editing existing ones. In
addition, a load incrementation facility is also available, so as to enable easier generation of new
element actions. The user defines element name and load value increments, and these are then
employed to automatically generate new element loads through "repetition" of a selected set of
already prescribed loads. This facility requires that element names respect the number (e.g. 100) or
word+number (e.g. B20) formats.
Load Incrementation
Pre-Processor 217
NOTE: Gravity loads should be applied downwards, for which reason they always feature a negative
value.
Loading Phases
In pushover analysis, the applied loading usually consists of permanent gravity loads in the vertical (z)
direction and incremental loads in one or both transversal (x & y) directions. As discussed in Appendix
B > Static pushover analysis, the magnitude of increment loads Pi at any given analysis step i is given by
the product of its nominal value P0, defined by the user in the Applied Loads, and the load factor at
that step:
𝑃𝑖 = 𝜆𝑖 𝑃0
The manner in which the load factor is incremented throughout the analysis or, in other words, the
loading strategy adopted in the pushover analysis, is fully defined in the Loading Phases module,
where an unlimited number of loading/solution stages can be defined by applying different
combinations of the three distinct pushover control types available in SeismoStruct, indicated below.
It is noteworthy that the incremental loading P may consist of forces or displacements, thus enabling
for both force- and displacement-based pushover to be carried out. Clearly, for most cases, application
of forces will be preferred to the employment of displacement incremental loads, since constraining
the deformation of a structure to a predefined shape may conceal its true response characteristics (e.g.
soft-storey), unless the more advanced adaptive pushover analysis type is employed. For this reason,
the most common loading strategy in non-adaptive pushover analysis is force-based pushover with
response control, described below:
Load control phase
Response control phase
Automatic response control phase
218 SeismoStruct User Manual
NOTE 1: Users may take advantage of the Add Scheme button to apply typical loading phases schemes
that will work for the majority of cases. Note, however, that no loading phases should be already
defined, in order for this facility to be available.
NOTE 2: It is highlighted again that an unlimited number of loading/solution strategies can be defined,
by applying different combination of the three distinct load phase types available. For instance, the
user may wish to: (a) apply the pushover loads in two or more load control phases, using a different
incremental step for each of those (e.g. larger step in the pre-yield stage, smaller step in the inelastic
range), (b) employ several phases to push a 3D model, first in one direction, then in the other, then
back in the first one, and so on, (c) carry out cyclic pushover analysis, pushing and pulling the
structure in successive cycles (the Static time-history analysis modality is however better tailored for
such cases).
NOTE 3: Even in those cases where no permanent loading is present, it might result handy to apply a
nil load vector somewhere in the structure, so that the initial permanent loads step is carried out and
hence the pushover curve is "forced" to start from the origin, which renders it slightly "more elegant".
The load factor , therefore, varies between 0 and the target load multiplier value, with an initial step
increment 0 that is equal to the ratio between the target load multiplier and the number of
increments. The value of 0 is changed only when the solution at a particular step fails to converge, in
which case the load factor increment is reduced until convergence is reached, after which it tries to
return to its initial value (refer to automatic step adjustment for further details). The phase finishes
when the target loading is reached or when structural or numerical collapse occurs.
Pre-Processor 219
If the user defined the incremental loads as forces, then a force-controlled pushover is carried out, with
the load factor being used to scale directly the applied force vector, until the point of peak capacity. If
the user wishes also to capture the post-peak softening behaviour of the structure, then a response or
automatic response phase needs to be added to the load control one (the program will automatically
switch from one phase to the other). This type of loading/solution strategy is employed when the user
needs to control directly the manner in which the force vector is incremented and applied to the
structure.
If, on the other hand, the user defined the loads as displacements, then a displacement-controlled
pushover is considered instead, with a displacement load vector incrementally applied to the
structure. This loading/response strategy is employed when the user wishes to have direct control
over the deformed shape of the structure at each stage of the analysis. Its application, however, is
usually not recommended, since constraining the deformation of a structure to a predefined shape may
conceal its true response characteristics (e.g. soft-storey), unless the more advanced adaptive
pushover analysis type is employed.
NOTE 1: When one force-based load control phase (+ one response control phase) is employed, the
distribution of force-displacement curve points usually results uneven, with higher density in the pre-
peak part, where to relatively large force increments correspond to small displacement steps, and
lower point concentration in the post-peak range, where to very small force variations may
correspond large deformation jumps. To solve or mitigate such problem a response control phase
should be used.
NOTE 2: When the applied incremental loads are displacements, the program will automatically adjust
the value of the first increment so that the latter added to the gravity loads-induced displacement
equals the initially envisaged target displacement value at the end of the first increment. In other
words, if the user wanted, for instance, to impose a 200 mm floor displacement applied in 100
increments, and if the gravity loads would cause a horizontal displacement of 0.04mm, then the
displacement load increments would be 1.96, 2.0, 2.0, ..., 2.0. This adjustment will, however, occur only
in those cases where the gravity loads-induced displacement is lower than the envisaged first
horizontal loads increment; if this condition that does hold (e.g. disp_gravt=2.07, in the example
above), then the displacement increments will all be identical and equal to (200-2.07)/100=1.9793,
clearly a much less "elegant" figure.
The load factor , therefore, is not directly controlled by the user but is instead automatically
calculated by the program so that the applied load vector Pi = iP0 at a particular increment i
corresponds to the attainment of the target displacement at the controlled node at that increment.
When the solution at a particular step fails to converge, the initial displacement increment is reduced
until convergence is reached, after which it tries to return to its initial value (refer to automatic step
adjustment for further details). The phase finishes when the target displacement is reached or when
structural or numerical collapse occurs.
With this loading strategy, it is possible to (i) capture irregular response features (e.g. soft-storey), (ii)
capture the softening post-peak branch of the response and (iii) obtain an even distribution of force-
displacement curve points. For these reasons, this type of loading/solution phase usually constitutes
the best option for carrying out non-adaptive pushover analysis.
NOTE 1: Response control can be employed in conjunction with displacement incremental loads.
NOTE 2: Response Control does not allow the modelling of snap-back and snap-through response types
[e.g. Crisfield, 1991], observed in structures subjected to levels of deformation large enough to cause a
shift in their mechanism of deformation and response. For such extreme cases, the employment of
Automatic Response Control is required.
NOTE 3: The program will automatically adjust the value of the first increment so that the latter added
to the gravity loads-induced displacement equals the initially envisaged target displacement value at
the end of the first increment. In other words, if the user wanted, for instance, to impose a 200 mm top
floor displacement applied in 100 increments, and if the gravity loads would cause a horizontal
displacement of 0.04mm, then the displacement load increments would be 1.96, 2.0, 2.0, ..., 2.0. This
adjustment will, however, occur only in those cases where the gravity loads-induced displacement is
lower than the envisaged first horizontal loads increment; if this condition that does hold (e.g.
disp_gravt=2.07, in the example above), then the displacement increments will all be identical and
equal to (200-2.07)/100=1.9793 (clearly a much less "elegant" figure).
Pre-Processor 221
The program uses the "target degree-of-freedom" as the first control entity for the analysis, changing it
whenever another nodal degree-of-freedom with a higher rate of nominal tangential translational
response (i.e. larger displacement variation between two consecutive steps) is found. In this manner, it
results not only possible for highly geometrically nonlinear snap-back and snap-through responses
[e.g. Crisfield, 1991] to be accurately predicted, but also to obtain analyses' solution in the minimum
amount of time, rendering this type of loading/solution phase the preferred option for obtaining
expeditious and accurate estimations of the force and displacement capacity of structures.
NOTE 1: When carrying out automatic response control pushover analysis on non-symmetric models,
it may happen that the program starts applying the load in the 'negative' direction, effectively pulling
the structure backwards, rather than pushing it forwards. This occurs when the non-symmetric
structure being analysed proves to be more flexible/deformable in 'pulling’ rather than ‘pushing’, a
feature that the automatic response algorithm cannot overlook. If users do wish to force the structure
to deform in a different direction, then they should start the pushover analysis with load or response
control phases, to initiate the deformation in the desired direction, after which they might change to
automatic response control, since the already displaced degrees-of-freedom will be inevitably selected
as the control ones.
NOTE 2: The automatic reduction and increase of the loading step may, on occasions, cause the force-
displacement curve points to result very uneven, for which reason the pushover response curve may
not always be visually ’adequate’.
222 SeismoStruct User Manual
Time-history curves
In both static and dynamic time-history analyses, in addition to permanent loads, structures are
subjected to transient loads, which may consist of forces/displacements varying in the pseudo-time
domain (static time-history loads) or of accelerations/forces that vary in the real time domain
(dynamic time-history loads). Whilst the type, direction, magnitude and application nodes of these
loads comes defined in the Applied Loads module, their loading pattern, that is, the way in which the
loads vary in time (or pseudo-time), is given by the time-history curves, defined in the Time-history
Curves module. The latter comprises two interrelated sections:
Load curves
Time-history stages
NOTE: Time-history curves provide only the time pattern of the transient loads. Their full absolute
magnitude is obtained through the product of time-history ordinates with the Curve Multiplier,
defined in the Applied Loads module. This effectively means that time-history curves can be
introduced in any given system of units, for as long as a coherent curve multiplier is used (e.g. if an
accelerogram is defined in [g] and the system of units adopted by the user requires acceleration values
to be defined in mm/sec2, then the corresponding curve multiplier should be 9810).
Load Curves
In the Load Curves section, the time-history curve is defined either through direct input of the values
of time and load pairs (Create function) or by reading a text file where the load curve is defined (Load
function).
IMPORTANT: The text file of the load curve must be in MS-DOS Windows format (i.e. save the file as
ANSI (encoding) using the Notepad).
Pre-Processor 223
Usually, static time-history analysis is employed to model simple cyclic tests on specimens, in which
case the loading curve is fairly simple and users tend to define it directly within SeismoStruct with the
Create option. In the case of dynamic analysis, on the other hand, the applied curve commonly, though
not exclusively (e.g. impact/blast analysis), consists of an accelerogram, with data points found in a
text file, which is then loaded into the program with the Load option. Nonetheless, any of the two time-
history definition options (Create and Load) can be used for both analysis types.
The Analysis Start Time is the time at which the analysis starts, and is always considered as equal to
zero, for which reason all time-history curves must feature time entries larger than 0.0. Further, when
time-history curves are to be applied to the structure at different time instants (e.g. asynchronous
seismic input, two earthquakes hitting the same structure in succession, etc.), the Delay parameter
Pre-Processor 225
should be used to define the time at which a particular time-history, being loaded from a text file, starts
being applied to the structure. In other words, there is no need for the user to manually change the
time-history data points to introduce a time delay, since the program does it automatically.
Whenever there is some uncertainty with regards to the file loading parameters (time column,
acceleration column, first line, last line) to be specified, the user can make use of the View Text File
facility which permits inspection of the file. After the time-history is loaded, the aforementioned input
parameters can still be modified (e.g. if after loading a 5000 lines accelerogram file it is realised that
only the first 1000 data points are of interest).
NOTE 1: A maximum number of 260,000 data points may be defined for each curve.
NOTE 2: After loading a time-history curve from a given text file, the latter can be disposed of, since the
time-history curve points are saved within the project file itself.
NOTE 3: In order to help users getting started, a set of eight accelerograms, normalised to [g], is
provided in the program's installation folder, to where the user is automatically directed whenever
he/she presses the Select File button. Users are also referred to online strong-motion databases for
access to additional accelerograms.
Time-history Stages
In the Time-history Stages section, the user has the possibility of defining up to 20 analysis stages,
each of which can be subdivided into a different number of analysis steps, explicitly defined by the
user. The program then calculates internally the time-step to be used within a given time-history stage,
this being equal to the difference between the end-times of two consecutive time-history stages
divided by the number of steps assigned. For the first stage, the difference between its end-time and
the Analysis Start Time (0.0 secs) is used.
In the majority of common applications, a single analysis stage is employed. However, there are cases
where a user may wish to employ different time-steps at different stages of the analysis (e.g. a free
vibration stage is introduced between two successive earthquakes being applied to a given structure
or a yield (easy convergence, large time-step can be used) and collapse (difficult convergence, small
time-step must be employed) static time-history curves are applied to a model), in which case the
possibility of defining more than one analysis stage becomes useful.
for conventional pushover is described. The latter should be considered as applicable to the adaptive
pushover cases, noting however the following differences:
In adaptive pushover, it is required that the inertia mass of the structures is modelled so that
eigenvalue analysis, employed in the updating of the loading vector, may be carried out.
Further, and for the case of force-based adaptive pushover only, it is necessary for the mass to
be adequately distributed throughout the nodes where the incremental loads are to be
applied, so that the incremental forces (obtained through the product of mass and
acceleration) may be calculated. (for displacement-based pushover this is not necessary, given
that the displacement profiles are obtained directly from the eigenvalue analyses)
Although it is permitted to use different nominal values for the loads at different nodes, as in
conventional pushover, it is strongly advisable that these incremental loads have equal
nominal values (constant load profile) so that the load applied at every node is fully
determined by the modal characteristics of the structure and spectral shape used.
The Adaptive Load Control and Adaptive Response Control loading/solution procedures are
used in substitution of the load control and response control phases. Their input and
functionality are identical, noting however that only one adaptive phase (load or response
control) can be applied in adaptive pushover, contrary to conventional pushover analysis
where more than one load or response control phases may be simultaneously employed. If
users wish to switch from Adaptive Load Control to Adaptive Response Control, or vice-versa,
they must first delete whichever of these two phases has already been defined so that the
alternative option is made available on the Add New Phase dialog box.
Being an advanced static analysis method, adaptive pushover requires the definition of a number of
additional parameters, as included in the Adaptive Parameters module. These parameters are:
Type of Scaling
The normalised modal scaling vector, used to determine the shape of the load vector (or load
increment vector) at each step, can be obtained using three distinct types of approaches:
1. Force-based Scaling. Scaling vector reflects the modal force distribution at that step.
2. Displacement-based Scaling. Scaling vector reflects the modal displacement distribution at
that step.
3. Interstorey Drift-based Scaling: scaling vector reflects the modal interstorey drift
distribution at that step.
NOTE: The latter cannot be employed in 3D adaptive pushover analyses and requires the nominal
lateral displacements to be entered in sequence (the 1st floor load being defined first, followed by the
displacement nominal load at level 2, and so on).
Pre-Processor 227
MPFs degrees-of-freedom
The user has the possibility of specifying the degrees-of-freedom to be considered in the calculation of
the participation factors of the modes (which are then employed in the computation of the modal
scaling vector).
For 3D adaptive pushover analysis, it might be convenient for more than one translation degree-of-
freedom to be employed (e.g. X & Y) or, instead, for rotation degrees-of-freedom to be used [e.g.
Meireles et al., 2006].
In the more common case of 2D analysis, only one translation degree-of-freedom will be chosen,
usually X.
Spectral Amplification
As previously mentioned, the effect that spectral amplification might have on the combination of the
different modal load vector solutions may or may not be taken into account through the choice of one
of the three options available within this module:
No Spectral Amplification. The scaling of the load vector distribution profile depends on the
modal characteristics of the structure alone, at each particular step.
Given Accelerogram. The user introduces an accelerogram time-history and defines the
desired level of viscous damping used by the program to automatically compute an
acceleration (when force-based scaling is used) or displacement (when displacement or drift-
based scaling is employed) response spectrum (assumed constant throughout the analysis).
Note that by default, the resulting response spectrum, as opposed to the accelerogram, is
shown to the user. The latter, however, can be visualised through the Accelerogram button.
User Defined Spectrum. The pairs of period and response acceleration/displacement values
can be directly introduced in an input table by the user. This option is usually employed to
introduce code-defined spectra and it is noted that, as in all other SeismoStruct modules, the
list of values may be pasted from any other Windows application, as an alternative to direct
typing.
NOTE: When running Displacement-based Adaptive Pushover, it is highly recommended, for reasons of
accuracy, for Spectral Amplification to be employed. If, for some reason, a user does not have ways to
estimate/represent the expected/design input motion at the site in question, then he/she should
select Single-Mode analysis in here, so as to run DAP-1st mode (for buildings only).
Spectral Amplification
IMPORTANT: By clicking on the Advanced Settings button, the user can define additional parameters to
those presented above.
Pre-Processor 229
IDA parameters
In Incremental Dynamic Analysis (IDA), structures are subjected to a succession of transient loads,
which usually consist of acceleration time-histories of increasing intensity, as described in Appendix B -
> Incremental dynamic analysis. Therefore, users who are interested in using this type of analysis, are
strongly advised to first consult the Time-history Curves section, where the loading application
procedure for dynamic time-history analysis is described. The latter is fully applicable to IDA cases,
noting however that a number of additional parameters, included in the IDA Parameters module,
need to be defined. These parameters are:
Scaling factors
Each time-history run of an IDA is carried out for a given input motion intensity, defined by the
product of the Scaling Factors with the accelerogram introduced by the user. Usually, the input motion
is incrementally scaled from a low elastic response value up to a large value, corresponding to the
attainment of a pre-defined post-yield target limit state.
Fixed and/or variable scaling patterns can be used, either in isolation or in combination. With fixed
patterns (Start-End-Step), the user defines the start scaling factor, corresponding to the first time-
history run, the end scaling factor, corresponding to the last time-history analysis to be carried out,
and a scaling factor step which is used to define the evenly spaced intermediate time-history levels.
With a variable scaling pattern (Distinct Scaling Factors), on the other hand, non-evenly spaced
sequences of scaling factors can be used, with the user being required to explicitly define all scaling
factors to be considered during the incremental dynamic analysis (unless used in combination with a
fixed scaling pattern, in which case only odd non-sequential factors may need to be specified).
NOTE: Usually, the behaviour of structures within their elastic response range can be represented
through the use of 2-3 pairs of shear-displacement points, fairly well spaced. In the post-yield region,
on the other hand, a finer representation of the dynamic pushover curve may be required. In such
cases, users might find useful to employ a combination of both fixed and variable scaling patterns,
whereby 2-3 distinct scaling factors are used for the elastic region and then start-end-step range of
values is employed for the post-yield response phase.
RSA parameters
Response-spectrum analysis (RSA) is a linear elastic static - (pseudo)dynamic - statistical analysis
method which provides the peak values of response quantities, such as forces and deformations, of a
structure under seismic excitation, as described in Appendix B -> Response Spectrum Analysis.
In RSA users are asked to provide as input the response spectrum and the seismic loading
combination(s) for which the RSA will output the results. This spectrum is employed for both the two
horizontal (EX, EY) and the vertical (EZ) seismic directions.
230 SeismoStruct User Manual
Loading combinations
In the loading combination module different response spectrum factors between horizontal and
vertical directions may be defined. The modal combination rule (ABSSUM, SRSS, CQC) should be
specified, as well as which modes are to be combined, in terms of accumulation of effective modal
mass. User may define a minimum cumulative mass percentage and the program selects the
appropriate number of modes that mobilise the largest amount of modal mass, until the target
cumulative percentage is reached for every seismic direction.
For each loading case (G, Q, and ±E), users are asked to define the factors for the static gravity or live
loading (fG+Q) and the factors of the seismic loading (f E). Seismic loading directions may be combined
linearly (E = ±EX±EY±EZ) with different factors per direction (f EX, fEY, fEZ) or by the SRSS rule (E =
± EX 2 +EY 2 + EZ 2 ). It is noted that the gravity loads have an explicitly defined algebraic sign, while for
the seismic loadings both signs for every direction are taken into account. Consequently, the results of
RSA loading combinations in terms of any response quantity are presented as envelopes.
NOTE: Code-defined ready-to-use loading combinations can be defined with the Add Standard
Combinations button. The combinations consist of the gravity+live loads, plus 100% of the prescribed
seismic forces in one direction and 30% of the prescribed forces in the perpendicular directions, one
combination for every seismic direction. Further, a combination of the gravity+live loads plus 100% of
the seismic forces is also provided.
Pre-Processor 231
Spectral Data
The response spectrum may be defined directly by the user or may be calculated from a given
accelerogram.
Given Accelerogram. The user introduces an acceleration time-history and defines the
desired level of viscous damping to automatically create the spectrum. The resulting response
spectrum, as opposed to the accelerogram, is shown to the user. The latter, however, can be
visualised through the Accelerogram button.
User Defined Spectrum. The pairs of period and response acceleration values can be directly
introduced by the user in an input table. This option is usually employed to introduce code-
defined spectra and it is noted that, as in all other SeismoStruct modules, the list of values may
be pasted from any other Windows application, as an alternative to direct typing.
TARGET DISPLACEMENT
In the case of pushover analysis (conventional or adaptive) users may select the automatic calculation
of the target displacement. If the Calculation Target Displacement check-box is selected an Eigenvalue
analysis will run prior to the pushover analysis. The parameters below need to be defined in order to
calculate the Target Displacement:
1. Code employed; the available options depending on the edition are: Eurocode 8-Part 3 with
the majority of National Annexes available, ASCE 41-17 (American Code for Seismic
Evaluation and Retrofit of Existing Buildings), NTC-18 (Italian National Seismic Code, NTC-08
(Italian National Seismic Code), KANEPE (Greek Seismic Interventions Code) and TBDY
(Turkish Seismic Evaluation Building Code). Additional information about the employed Codes
may be found in Appendix H – Codes;
2. Control Node and Control Direction; these are automatically assigned if the Building Modeller
or the Wizard facility is used;
3. The Limit States (or the Performance Levels in the case of ASCE 41-17 and TBDY and the
Performance Objectives in the case of KANEPE), for which the Target Displacement is to be
calculated;
232 SeismoStruct User Manual
4. The elastic response spectrum which can be derived from the code used in the specific project
(Code-Based Spectra option) or it can be defined by the user (User–Defined Spectrum option).
In the case of Code-Based Spectra, users should assign the basic parameters needed for the
generation of the spectral shape (i.e. peak ground acceleration, damping, spectrum type,
ground type and important class In the case of User Defined Spectra, users can select from a
list of 29 spectra defined by various National Codes across the world (Code-Based Spectrum
option), they may upload an accelerogram based on which the elastic response spectrum will
be calculated (Spectrum from loaded accelerogram option) or they may upload an elastic
spectrum from a file (Load Spectrum from file option).
CODE-BASED CHECKS
Herein, the code-based checks to be carried out for the structural members may be selected. Different
tabs for Frame Elements and Masonry Elements are available. In order to introduce a code-based
check, users need to:
1. Define the Code employed, six options are currently available: Eurocode 8-Part 3 with the
majority of National Annexes, ASCE 41-17 (American Code for Seismic Evaluation and Retrofit
of Existing Buildings), NTC-18 (Italian National Seismic Code), NTC-08 (Italian National
Seismic Code), KANEPE (Greek Seismic Interventions Code) and TBDY (Turkish Seismic
Evaluation Building Code); additional information about the employed Codes may be found in
Appendix H – Codes;
2. Define the values of the Safety Factors and the equations employed in the calculations, when
more than one expressions are proposed;
3. Select the Knowledge Level that corresponds to the available data on structural configuration;
4. Define the Advanced Member Properties, i.e. all the parameters that characterise the member
to be checked, classification (primary or secondary), type and length of lapping, detailing for
earthquake resistance etc.;
5. Click the ‘Add’ button;
6. Introduce the check name;
7. Select the code-based check type (i.e. element chord rotation capacity or element shear
capacity for frame elements and masonry shear capacity, compressive force, bending moment
or drift for masonry elements) from the drop-down menu;
8. Define the Limit States or the Performance Levels to be used to check the elements;
9. Define the elements to which the check applies to;
10. Define the Strength Degradation of the element, when a given code-based check has been
reached. The user can specify the residual strength as a percentage of the capacity, or select to
remove the element completely, or to keep it without strength degradation.
11. Define the type of action upon the attainment of each check: (i) stop the analysis and introduce
a notification in the analysis log, (ii) pause the analysis and introduce a notification in the
234 SeismoStruct User Manual
analysis log, (iii) leave the analysis undisturbed and introduce a notification in the analysis log,
(iv) ignore the occurrence, that is, render the check inactive;
12. Assign a colour to enable graphical visualisation in the Deformed Shape Viewer module of
the Post-Processor;
13. Select the damage visual effects, in order to enable the graphical visualisation of damage in the
Deformed Shape Viewer module.
NOTE: The available Codes depend on the edition of the SeismoStruct. Users should select the edition
with the required Codes.
The values of the safety factors and the Code expressions employed may be specified through the
dialog box that opens from the corresponding button. It is noted the default values of the safety factors
are those defined in Codes.
Pre-Processor 235
PERFORMANCE CRITERIA
Within the context of performance-based engineering, it is paramount that analysts and engineers are
capable of identifying the instants at which different performance limit states (e.g. non-structural
damage, structural damage, collapse) are reached. This can be efficiently carried out in SeismoStruct
through the definition of Performance Criteria, whereby the attainment of a given threshold value of
material strain, section curvature, element chord-rotation and/or element shear, element
force/moment, element deformation, element drift, etc. during the analysis of a structure is
automatically monitored by the program. Different areas for Frame Elements and Non Frame Elements
performance criteria definition are available.
IMPORTANT: Introduction of Performance Criteria checks during the analysis does induce a slight
increase in its running time, for obvious reasons.
3. Set the value at which the performance criterion is reached, in the case of criteria with user-
defined limit;
4. Select the equation for the calculation of the limit value, in the case of criteria with
automatically-defined limits; additional information about the equations used herein may be
found in Appendix H – Codes;
5. Define the elements to which the criterion applies to (if a strain criterion has been selected,
users have to select a material from the drop-down menu before defining the elements);
6. Define the Strength Degradation of the element, when a given performance criterion has been
achieved. The user can specify the residual strength as a percentage of the capacity, or select
to remove the element completely, or to keep it without strength degradation.
7. Define the type of action upon the attainment of each criterion: (i) stop the analysis and
introduce a notification in the analysis log, (ii) pause the analysis and introduce a notification
in the analysis log, (iii) leave the analysis undisturbed and introduce a notification in the
analysis log, (iv) ignore the occurrence, that is, render the criterion inactive;
8. Assign a colour to enable graphical visualisation in the Deformed Shape Viewer module of
the Post-Processor;
9. Select the damage visual effects, in order to enable the graphical visualisation of damage in the
Deformed Shape Viewer.
NOTE: Users should be careful when defining strength degradation, since such choices may lead to
numerical instabilities.
Pre-Processor 239
Criterion Type
The type of criteria to be used does clearly depend on the objectives of the user. However, within the
context of a fibre-based modelling approach, such as that implemented in SeismoStruct, material
strains do usually constitute the best parameter for identification of the performance state of a given
structure. The available criteria on material strains are:
Cracking of structural elements. It can be detected by checking for (positive) concrete
strains larger than the ratio between the tension strength and the initial stiffness of the
concrete material. [typical value: +0.0001];
Spalling of cover concrete. It can be recognised by checking for (negative) cover concrete
strains larger than the ultimate crushing strain of unconfined concrete material. [typical value:
-0.002];
Crushing of core concrete. It can be verified by selecting the “Check the Core Only” check-box
and checking for (negative) core concrete strains larger than the ultimate crushing strain of
confined concrete material. [typical value: -0.006];
Yielding of steel. It can be identified by checking for (positive) steel strains larger than the
ratio between yield strength and modulus of elasticity of the steel material. [typical value: +
0.0025];
Fracture of steel. It can be established by checking for (positive) steel strains larger than the
fracture strain. [typical value: +0.060].
Alternatively, or in addition, section curvatures and/or chord-rotations can readily be employed in the
verification of a myriad of performance limit states, in which case users should refer to available
literature for guidance on curvature/rotation values to be employed [e.g. Priestley, 2003]. Further, it is
also feasible to monitor the shear values of frame elements, with the definition of one or more shear
threshold values.
Finally, chord rotation yielding, chord rotation capacity and element shear capacity checks for
frame elements can be introduced, whereby the program automatically calculates the capacity of the
elements during the analysis, according to the selected equation of the available Codes (Eurocodes,
ASCE 41-17, NTC-18, NTC-08, KANEPE and TBDY), and checks it against the corresponding demand.
Elements’ Force/moment, displacement and Drift checks for non frame elements can be introduced,
whereby the program automatically calculates the capacity of the elements during the analysis,
according to the selected equation of the available Codes (Eurocodes, ASCE 41-17 and NTC-18), and
checks it against the corresponding demand or user-defined values.
NOTE 1: In the Performance Criteria where only positive values are allowed, the checks are carried out
against the absolute value of the response quantity for the demand. Whereas, in the Performance
Criteria where both positive and negative values are defined, the check is carried out against the
signed value of the response quantity, and different values for the positive and negative values are
allowed. In the latter case, if users introduce a positive criterion value, the program will automatically
consider a "larger than" performance check. Conversely, if a negative criterion value is defined, the
program will automatically activate a "smaller than" performance check.
NOTE 2: Strain and curvature performance checks are carried out at the Integration Sections of the
selected elements.
NOTE 3: Performance Criteria can only be set to control the response of inelastic frame elements. The
latter, however, may always be defined with an elastic material, which effectively means that
performance criteria can also be applied to members whose response is elastic.
240 SeismoStruct User Manual
NOTE 4: Mean material values without safety or confidence factors are used in the automatic
calculation of the elements’ capacity, i.e. in the case of Performance Criteria with automatically-
defined limit.
MODEL STATISTICS
The function 'Model Statistics', available from the program menu (View > Model Statistics) or by
clicking on , allows users to view a summary of the model input data.
ANALYSIS OUTPUT
Being a fibre analysis program, SeismoStruct computes and outputs a very large number of response
parameters (e.g. strains, stresses, curvatures, internal member forces, nodal displacements, etc.). This
may give rise to two main inconveniencies: (i) user difficulty in post-processing the results and
assessing the different levels of performance of the structure and (ii) very large result files (up to
50Mb or more, especially when dynamic analysis is run on large models).
In the majority of cases, users will make use of only a fraction of the wealth of results that can be
obtained from SeismoStruct, since it is common for the response of a limited selected number of nodes
and/or elements to provide sufficient information on the performance and response of the structure
being analysed. Therefore, in the Analysis Output module, users are given the possibility to trim down
their analysis output to the necessary minimum, thus reducing both hard-drive consumption as well as
post-processing time and effort.
Pre-Processor 241
Frequency of Output
If a frequency value equal to zero is adopted, then output is provided at all analysis steps where
equilibrium has been reached, including those corresponding to step reduction levels. If a frequency
value equal to unity is used instead, then step reduction level output is omitted. This is the default
behaviour, since users are usually interested in obtaining results that are in correspondence with the
initial number of increments/steps that have been defined in pre-processing. However, if the latter is
not the case (e.g. the analysis loading has been split into a very large number of increments just to ease
convergence), then a frequency value n larger than unity can be employed, with output being provided
at every n equilibrated steps.
NOTE: If not all nodes have been selected for output, the deformed shapes of the structural model
cannot be plotted in the Post-Processor.
NOTE: This option should be used with care since choosing to output curvature and stress/strain
peaks for all elements of a large structure may result in the creation of extremely large (hundreds of
Mb) output files.
NOTE: In the Output module, there is also the possibility for the user to customise the real-time
displacement plotting that is shown during the analysis of a structure, by choosing (i) the node and (ii)
degree-of-freedom to be considered. For better visualisation, users are advised to keep the program
defaults, which employ the absolute top displacement plotted against base shear for static analysis,
and the total drift (difference between top and bottom displacements) plotted against time value for
dynamic analysis.
Processor
Having completed the pre-processing phase, the user is then ready to run the analysis. This is carried
out in the Processor area of SeismoStruct, which is accessible through the corresponding toolbar
button or by selecting Run > Processor from the main menu.
Processor area
NOTE: Simultaneous analysis of multiple models (up to hundreds, the only limit being the computer's
physical memory), each of which subjected to similar or diverse loading (e.g. accelerogram), can be
accomplished through their definition within the same project file (*.spf). In this manner, significant
computing timesaving can being achieved, especially when a large number of simple models (e.g.
single DOF cantilevers) are to be analysed, due to the savings in the output of results to the *.srf files.
Further, automatic processing of these results can also be obtained through an opportune
employment of IDA (with a single load factor).
Depending on the size of the structure, the selected frame elements type, the applied loads and the
processing capacity of the computer being used, the analysis may last some seconds (static analysis),
several minutes (time-history analysis) or even hours (time-history analysis of large complex 3D
models).
As the analysis is running, a progress bar provides the user with a percentage indication of how far has
the former advanced to. Users can in this manner quickly assess the waiting time required for the
analysis to be completed, and hence quickly plan their subsequent work schedule.
The analysis can also be paused, enabling users to (i) momentarily free computing resources so as to
carry out an urgent priority task or (ii) check the results obtained up to that point, which may be useful
to decide the worthiness of progressing with a lengthy analysis. If the user presses the Run button
again, the analysis can be continued.
Processor 245
Progress bar
The Analysis Log is also shown to the user, in real-time, providing expedient information on the
progress of the analysis, loading control and convergence conditions (for each global load increment).
This log is saved on a text file (*.log) that features the same name as the project file and which indicates
the date and time of when the analysis was run (the sort of non-technical information that comes very
handy on occasions). In addition, if the user has specified code-based checks or performance criteria to
246 SeismoStruct User Manual
be checked during the analysis, then the corresponding real-time log is also shown during the analysis
and saved to the same *.log file.
At the bottom of the window, the convergence norms at the end of a given (global) load increment are
shown.
Convergence norms
NOTE: As in the case of the Analysis Log described above, this information does not refer to local load
increment/iterations of force-based elements mentioned in Project Settings > Elements.
Finally, the user has also the option of graphically observing the real-time plotting of a capacity (static
pushover) or displacement time-history (time-history analysis) curve of any given node and respective
degree-of-freedom, pre-selected in the Output module.
Real-time plotting
Alternatively, the user may also choose to visualise the real-time plotting of the deformed shape of the
structure (see Deformed Shape Viewer settings).
Processor 247
Both of these options, however, might slow down the analysis and increase its running time when used
in relatively slow computers, for which reason the user has also the possibility of simply disabling any
real-time plotting, choosing to follow only the analysis logs.
Furthermore, displaying of the latter can also be disabled (pressing the Less button) so as to attain
even faster performance (on modern fast computers, however, the difference should be completely
negligible).
NOTE 1: Upon start of the analysis, users may be presented with a warning message regarding 'Zero
diagonal terms encountered in a give node'. This means that such node is unrestrained in the degrees-
of-freedom indicated (i.e. the node is not connected to an element or constraint capable of providing
any restrain/stiffness in such dofs), a condition that, if unintended, implies the presence of an error in
the assemblage of model. If, instead, such unrestrained nodal dofs have been intentionally introduced,
the user may proceed with the analysis, knowing however that numerical convergence difficulties may
arise more easily in such cases.
NOTE 2: When running an eigenvalue analysis using Lanczos algorithm, user may be presented with a
message stating: "could not re-orthogonalise all Lanczos vectors", meaning that the Lanczos algorithm,
currently the eigenvalue solver in SeismoStruct, could not calculate all or some of the vibration modes
of the structure. This behaviour may be observed in either (i) models with assemblage errors (e.g.
unconnected nodes/elements) or (ii) complex structural models that feature links/hinges etc. If users
have checked carefully their model and found no modelling errors, then they may perhaps try to
"simplify" it, by removing its more complex features until the attainment of the eigenvalue solutions.
This will enable a better understanding of what might be causing the analysis problems, and thus
assist users in deciding on how to proceed. This message typically appears when too many modes are
sought, e.g. when 30 modes are asked in a 24 DOF model, or when the eigensolver cannot simply find
so many modes (even if DOFs > modes).
NOTE 3: Whenever the real-time deformed shape of the structure is difficult to interpret (because
displacements are either too large or too small), users can right-click on the plotting window and
adjust its respective Deformed Shape Multipliers. The 3D Plot options are also available for further
fine-tuning (e.g. on some cases, it may prove handy to fix the graph axis, rather than having them
automatically updated by the program). Please refer to the Deformed shape viewer section for further
hints and info on real-time visualisation of a model’s deformed shape.
NOTE 4: The current version of SeismoStruct is not capable of taking advantage of multi-processor
computing hardware; hence, speed of a single analysis may be increased only by increasing the CPU
speed (together with the speeds of the CPU Cache, the Front Side Bus, the RAM modules, the Video
RAM, the Hard-Disk (rotation and access)). Having more than one CPU, however, will reduce running
times of multiple contemporary analyses, since in such cases "parallel processing" can take place.
NOTE 5: There is a size limitation of the output file in SeismoStruct, the maximum results size that can
be opened from the Post-processor is 4GB in 64-bit Windows systems and 3GB in 32-bit Windows
systems. In analyses with larger output *.srf files, SeismoStruct is only able to read the results up to
that point.
NOTE 6: Up until now, the development of SeismoStruct has focused primarily on the achievement of
ease-of-use and high technical capabilities, with an obvious sacrifice in terms of speed of analysis,
something that we hope to address in the future. In the meantime, however, please make sure that
your model does not feature an unnecessarily excessive number of elements, section fibres, load
increments or iterations, all of which, together with too-stringent convergence criteria, contribute to
slow analyses.
Processor 249
NOTE 7: When using the less numerically stable Frontal solver, it may happen that analysis stops, at
different time-steps. On such occasions, users are advised to change to the default Skyline solver.
Post-Processor
The results of the analysis are saved in a SeismoStruct Results File, distinguishable by its *.srf
extension, with the same name as the input project file. Double-clicking on this type of files will open
SeismoStruct's Pre-Processor. The Post-Processor can then be accessed through the corresponding
toolbar button or by selecting Run > Post-Processor from the main menu.
Similarly to its Pre-Processor counterpart, the Post-Processor area features a series of modules
where results from different type of analysis can be viewed in table or graphical format, and then
copied into any other Windows application (e.g. tabled results can be copied into a spreadsheet like
Microsoft Excel, whilst results plots can be copied into a word-processing application, like Microsoft
Word). It is noted that a special facility of visualising the maximum, minimum and absolute maximum
values in all the plots of the Post-Processor is available.
The available modules are listed below and will be described in the following paragraphs:
Analysis Logs
Modal/Mass Quantities
Target Displacement
Step Output
Deformed Shape Viewer
ConvergenceProblems
Action Effects Diagrams
Code-based Checks
Global Response Parameters
Element Action Effects
Performance Criteria Checks
Stress and Strain Output
IDA Envelope Curve
Post-Processor 251
Post-Processor Modules
Post-Processor Modules
There are some general operations that apply to all the Post-Processor modules. For example, the way
in which model components (e.g. nodes, sections, elements, etc.) are sorted in their respective pre-
processor modules reflects the way these entries appear on all dialogue boxes in the post-processor.
For instance, if the user chooses to employ alphabetical sorting of the nodes, then these will appear in
alphabetical order in all drop-down menus where nodes are listed, which may, in a given case, ease
and speed up their individuation and selection. An option to sort by name the nodes and elements in
the lists of the post-processor is currently available on the right click popup menu.
In addition, when using drop-down lists with many entries, users can start typing an item's identifier
so as to reach it quicker.
POST-PROCESSOR SETTINGS
Often, the possibility of applying a multiplying factor or coefficient to the results comes as very handy.
For instance, if the analysis has been carried out using Nmm as the units for moment quantities, users
might wish to multiply the corresponding results by 1e-6, so as to obtain moments expressed in kNm
instead. Alternatively, and as another example, users might also wish to multiply concrete stress values
with a factor of -1, so that compression stresses and strains comes plotted in the x-y positive quadrant,
as usually presented. Therefore, users are given the possibility to apply multipliers to all quantities
being post-processed.
This facility can be accessed through the program menu (Tools > Post-Processor Settings), or through
the right-click pop-up menu, or through the corresponding toolbar button .
252 SeismoStruct User Manual
Post-Processor Settings
In addition, the Post-Processing Settings provide users also with the possibility of transposing the
Output Tables. This might come very hand in cases where, for instance, a model features several
thousands of nodes/elements, which in turn leads to default output tables with an equally very large
number of columns, that one may not be able to then copy to spreadsheet applications (e.g. Microsoft
Excel) that feature a relatively stringent limit on the number of columns (max = 16384). By
transposing the tables, the nodes/elements are then listed in rows, thus overcoming the limitation
described above (in general, the aforementioned spreadsheet applications cater for tables with might
have up to 1048576 rows).
Finally, from the Post-Processor Settings the user may change the damping ratio and the minimum
effective modal mass of the modes that will be taken into consideration in Response Spectrum
Analysis. These two settings, which have initially been defined in the Pre-Processor Settings, can also be
changed from within the Post-Processor, in order to adapt the loading combinations to specific needs
of the users.
NOTE: The Post-Processor apply to all its modules. Hence, users should have in mind that if, for
instance, they apply a -1 coefficient to the values of total base shear of the structure (plotted as a y-
quantity in the hysteretic plots module) then the values of material stresses (plotted as y-quantity in
the stress and strain module) will also be modified by this -1 multiplier.
PLOT OPTIONS
All graphs displayed in the Post-Processor modules can be tweaked and customised using the Plot
Options facility, available from the main menu (Tools > Plot Options…), toolbar button or right-click
popup menu. The user can then change the characteristics of the lines (colour, thickness, style, etc.),
the background (colour, gradient), the axes (colour, font size and style of labels etc.) and the titles of
the plot. Through the Save Plot Settings... and the Load Plot Settings..., available on the right click
popup menu, the plot settings may be saved and retrieved, respectively, to be applied to other plots.
Post-Processor 253
NOTE: Before copying results plots into other Windows applications, users might wish to remove the
plot's background gradient, which looks good on screen but comes out quite badly on printed
documents. This can be done easily in the Panel tab of the Plot Options dialog box.
In addition, zooming-in and -out can be done by dragging the mouse on the graph area (a top-left to
bottom-right selection zooms in, whereas a bottom-right to top-left selection zooms out).
highest the size of the resulting file. The smallest possible frequency value is 1, effectively meaning that
all deformed shapes that have been output will be used in the creation of the movie.
If, on the other hand, a user wishes to create a movie illustrating a given vibration mode of a particular
structure, then he/she must define the number of mode cycles to be created (i.e. how many times will
the modal animation be repeated) and the number of images/frames to be used per cycle. Evidently,
the highest the number of interim frames, the smoothest the animation, but also the largest the movie
file becomes.
Before creating the animation, users are advised to customise the 3D Plot to their needs and likings,
since these settings will reflect the look and feel of the movie. In particular, it is noted that during
movie creation, the axes of the plot are not automatically updated, thus implying that, before initiating
the creation process, users should set the axes to their largest needed values. The latter can be done
either by viewing an output shape where deformations are at their highest, or by manually tweaking
the axes characteristics (using the 3D Plot options).
Once the animation has been created, users can verify its adequacy through the AVI Viewer
incorporated in SeismoStruct, accessible from the program main menu (File > Show AVI file…) or
through the respective toolbar button .
Post-Processor 255
Animations created in SeismoStruct (i.e. AVI movies) can also be opened by other Windows
applications such as Windows Media Player or, perhaps more importantly, Microsoft PowerPoint,
where they can be used in multimedia presentations.
ANALYSIS LOGS
As discussed in the Processor area, during any given analysis, a log of its numerical progress and of
the performance response of the model is created and saved within the project’s log file (*.log). The
contents of such file can be visualised in the Analysis Logs module and, if required, copied and pasted
into any other Windows application.
It is also noted that, since the date and time of the last analysis are saved within the log file, users can
refer to this module when such type of information is required.
MODAL/MASS QUANTITIES
IMPORTANT: This module is visible only when Eigenvalue or Adaptive Pushover analyses have been
carried out. It is also shown with a different name 'Eigenvalue Results', in the case of Pushover analysis
when the Target displacement is calculated.
The Modal/Mass Quantities module provides a summary of (i) the main eigenvalue results (i.e. the
natural period/frequency of vibration of each mode, the modal participation factors and the effective
modal masses), and (ii) the nodal masses. These results can be easily copied to a text editor, through
the right-click popup menu.
256 SeismoStruct User Manual
Regarding the nodal masses, SeismoStruct provides a table in which are summarized the masses of the
nodes for each degree of freedom (also for rotation). For a particular node, the rotational mass is
computed as the rotational mass defined by the user for that node, plus the translational mass at that
node times the square of the distance to the centre of gravity of the model.
The modal participation factors, obtained as the ratio between the modal excitation factor
(Ln=nT*M) and the generalised mass (Mn=nT*M*n), provide a measure as to how strongly a given
mode n participates in the dynamic response of a structure. However, since mode shapes n can be
normalised in different ways, the absolute magnitude of the modal participation factor has in effect no
meaning, and only its relative magnitude with respect to the other participating modes is of
significance. [Priestley et al., 1996]
For the above reason, and particularly for the case of buildings subjected to earthquake ground-
motion, it is customary for engineers/analysts to use the effective modal mass (m eff,n=Ln2/Mn) as a
measure of the relative importance that each of the structure's modes has on its dynamic response.
Indeed, since meff,n can be interpreted as the part of the total mass M of the structure that is excited by
a given mode n, modes with high values of effective modal mass are likely to contribute significantly to
response.
Post-Processor 257
NOTE 1: Users are advised to refer to the available literature [e.g. Clough and Penzien, 1993; Chopra,
1995] for further information on modal analysis and respective parameters.
NOTE 3: MPFs for rotations are calculated considering a transformation matrix defined as follows
(where x0, y0, z0 are the coordinates of the centre of mass), so that the modal excitation factor becomes
Ln= nT*M*Ti, from which the effective modal mass (as for the translational DOFs).
TARGET DISPLACEMENT
In the Target Displacement module the capacity curves before and after linearisation are shown,
together with the calculated target displacements for the selected limit states. Data about linearisation
and the target displacement calculation are also provided herein. The linearisation procedure is always
carried out according to the methodology proposed by the selected Code. Users may refer to Appendix
H – for more information about the calculation of the target displacement.
STEP OUTPUT
This post-processing module applies to all analysis types and provides, in text file-type of output, all
the analytical results (nodal displacements/rotations, support and element forces/moments, element
strains and stresses) obtained by SeismoStruct at any given analysis step. The entire step output, or
selected parts of it, can be copied to text editors for further manipulation, using the corresponding
menu commands, keyboard shortcuts, toolbar buttons or right-click popup menu.
Step Output
Rather than copying and pasting the contents of this module, users may also choose to simply use the
Export to Text File facility, which gives also the possibility of choosing the start and end output steps of
interest, together with a step increment. This useful facility is available from the toolbar button .
Finally, and as noted in Project Settings > General, users may also activate the option of creating, at the
end of every analysis, a text file (*.out) containing the output of the entire analysis (as given in this
module). This feature may result useful for users, who wish to systematically, rather than occasionally,
post-process the results using their own custom-made post-processing facility.
NOTE 1: Step output corresponding to Permanent loads applied at the start of pushover and time-
history analysis, refers always to the step where equilibrium has been reached, which usually
corresponds to the one single increment/iteration required to balance this type of loads. However,
there are occasions (very large permanent loads), where more than one increments/iterations are
required to reach structural equilibrium. Users who wish to visualise the interim steps carried out to
arrive at the final equilibrated solution of such large initial permanent loads, should run a non-
variable static analysis, where such output is given.
NOTE 2: Step output for elastic frame elements (elfrm) is provided always after the output of their
inelastic counterparts (infrm, infrmPH), even if the former alphabetically precedes the latter.
Post-Processor 259
Deformed model
In this module it is also possible to visualise the elements that reach a particular performance
criterion. This can be done by choosing the Performance Criteria option and selecting if the plastic
hinges/ damage locations will be shown, and whether these elements will be distinguished through
colours and/or damaged textures. In addition, also the displacements values may be displayed by
checking the associated box.
260 SeismoStruct User Manual
Finally, the elements that have exceeded their capacity at a particular code-based check may be
visualised by choosing the Code-based Checks option and selecting if the plastic hinges/ damage
locations will be shown, and whether these elements will be distinguished through colours and/or
damaged textures.
Post-Processor 261
The deformed shape plot can be tweaked and customised using the 3D Plot options and then copied to
any Windows application by means of the Copy 3D Plot facility. In addition, and whenever the real-time
deformed shape of the structure is difficult to interpret (because displacements are either too large or
too small), users can make use of the Deformed Shape Multiplier, available from the right-click popup
menu or through the main menu (Tools > Deformed Shape Settings…) or through the corresponding
toolbar button , to better adapt the plot.
Finally, and in the case of dynamic analysis, it is also useful to check the Fix selected node option, so
that only the relative displacements of the structure, which are those of interest to engineers, are
plotted. The ‘selected node’ should obviously be a node at the base of the structure in order for this
option work; if the Wizard facility has been used, the default selected node is N1 (see below).
Moreover, the absolute rigid-body deformation of the structure's foundation nodes (resulting from the
double-integration of the acceleration time-history), is usually unrealistically large, since no base-line
correction, or other types of filtering, is applied during the integration process, as would be required to
obtain sensible results.
IMPORTANT: Users are strongly advised to always make use of this option when post-processing
dynamic analysis results.
262 SeismoStruct User Manual
NOTE: In order for deformed shape plots to be available, nodal response parameters must have been
output for all structural nodes (see Output module), otherwise the Post-Processor will not have
sufficient information to compute this type of plots.
CONVERGENCE PROBLEMS
Whenever convergence problems arise, users may be informed about the elements that cause the
diverging solutions. The elements or the locations of the structure, where the convergence problems
are caused, are marked in the 3D view format, whereas information about the type of divergence
(value of convergence norms and their limits, divergence message and the corresponding elements or
nodes) are displayed on the top-left corner of the screen.
Post-Processor 263
Convergence Problems
NOTE: Users should activate in Project Settings > Convergence Criteria the option of showing
convergence difficulties in Post-Processor in order to be able to view the Convergence Problems tab in
the Post-Processor.
Users may customize the diagrams, through the 'infrm' or 'elfrm' tab in the 3D Plot Options menu (i.e.
main line and secondary line colours, number of sec. lines and number of values).
3D-Plot Options
CODE-BASED CHECKS
Here, it is possible for the user to perform the Code-based Checks Per Step. Different tabs for Frame
Code-based Checks and masonry Code-based Checks per step are available. First of all, he/she has to
select the code-based check name from the drop-down menu. Then, it is necessary to select the step of
the analysis (e.g. a particular limit state). Regarding the view options, the results can be displayed for
all the elements or only for those elements that have reached the criterion selected.
In addition, the user may extract the Code-based checks history of the structural members. Different
tabs for Frame Code-based Checks Hostory and Masonry Code-based Checks History are available.
Users have to select the code-based check name from the drop-down menu, then, they should select
the element and click the Refresh button. The results can be displayed in the form of a chart or a table.
Finally, maximum values can be displayed in the selected chart.
NOTE: The supports reactions should evidently be equal to the internal forces of the base elements
that are connected to the foundation nodes. In other words, one would expect the values obtained in
Forces and Moments at Supports to be identical to those given in the Element Action Effects for the
elements connected to the foundations. However, some factors may actually lead to differences in
these two response parameters: i) member action effects are given in the local reference system of
each element, whilst reactions at supports are provided in the global coordinates system. Hence, in
those cases where large displacements/rotations are incurred by the structure, differences in element
shears and support horizontal reactions may be observed; ii) in dynamic analyses featuring tangent
stiffness proportional equivalent viscous damping, and in some cases only (typically, cantilevers with
low/zero axial load), it may happen that differences between elements internal actions and support
reactions are observed, due to spurious numerical responses (associated to the fact that the tangent
stiffness proportional damping behaves hysteretically and thus may develop damping even for
velocities equal to zero); iii) the presence of offsets.
Structural displacements
The user can obtain the displacement results of any given number of nodes, relative to one of the six
available global degrees-of-freedom. Note that in dynamic analysis it is advisable for relative (with
respect to a support), rather than absolute nodal displacements to be plotted. Indeed, due to the
unrealistically large rigid body deformation of the foundation nodes (resulting from the
uncorrected/unfiltered double-integration of the acceleration time-history), absolute displacements
provide little information on the actual structural response characteristics, for which reason they are
usually not considered when post-processing dynamic analysis.
NOTE: Evidently, the total moment support reaction does not include overturning effects, consisting
simply of the sum of moments at the structure's supports.
Hysteretic Curves
The user is able to specify a translational/rotational global degree-of-freedom to be plotted against the
corresponding total base-shear/base-moment or load factor (pushover analysis). In static analysis,
such a plot represents the structure's capacity curve, whilst in time-history analysis this usually
reflects the hysteretic response of the model. The possibility for relative displacement output is also
available, as this is useful for the case of dynamic analysis post-processing.
In addition, the user may extract the Performance Criteria Checks History of the structural members.
Different tabs for Frame, Link, Infill, Masonry and Truss Performance Criteria Checks History are
available. Users have to select the performance criterion name from the drop-down menu, then, they
should select the element and click the Refresh button. The results can be displayed in the form of a
chart or a table. Finally, maximum values can be displayed in the selected chart.
NOTE 1: Rotational degrees-of-freedom defined with regards to a particular axis, refer always to the
rotation around, not along, that same axis. Hence, this is the convention that should be applied in the
interpretation of all rotation/moment results obtained in this module.
NOTE 2: Element chord-rotations output in this module correspond to structural member chord-
rotations only if one frame element has been employed to represent a given per column or beam, that
is, only if there is a one-to-one correspondence between the model and the structure (or some of its
elements). Such approach is possible when infrmFB are used, thus allowing the direct employment of
element chord rotations in seismic code verifications (see e.g. Eurocode 8, NTC-08, KANEPE, FEMA-
356, ATC-40, etc). When the structural member has had to be discretised in two or more frame
elements, then users need to post-process nodal displacements/rotation in order to estimate the
members chord-rotations [e.g. Mpampatsikos et al. 2008].
NOTE 3: Under large displacements, shear forces at base elements might well be different from the
corresponding reaction forces at the supports to which such base elements are connected to, since the
former are defined in the (heavily rotated) local axis system of the element whilst the latter are
defined with respect to the fixed global reference system.
NOTE 4: In principle, the internal forces developed by frame elements during dynamic analysis should
not exceed their static capacity, derived through a pushover analysis or hand-calculations. However,
some factors may actually lead to differences: i) if cyclic strain hardening of the rebars takes place,
then this may lead to higher "dynamic flexural capacities", in particularly for what concerns the
comparison with hand-calculations (where strain hardening is normally not accounted for). ii) if
equivalent viscous damping is introduced, then the structure/elements may deform less, hence
elongate less, developing higher axial load, and thus, again, higher "dynamic flexural capacity". iii) if
the elements feature distributed mass, then their bending moment diagram developed during
dynamic analysis will differ from its static analysis counterpart, and hence the shear forces cannot
really be compared (however, moments still can).
NOTE 5: SeismoStruct does not automatically output dissipated energy values. However, users should
be able to readily obtain such quantities through the product/integral of the force-displacement
response.
NOTE 6: Since in the modeling of infill panel in SeismoStruct two internal struts are used in each
direction, in order to get the total strut infill panel force users need to add the values in two struts.
Post-Processor 273
NOTE: Elastic frame elements are always listed after their inelastic counterparts, even if the former
alphabetically precedes the latter.
NOTE: Elastic frame elements are always listed after their inelastic counterparts, even if the former
alphabetically precedes the latter.
274 SeismoStruct User Manual
IDA ENVELOPE
This module is visible when Incremental Dynamic Analysis has been carried out, providing the plot of
peak values of base shear versus maximum values of relative displacement (drift) at the node chosen
by the user (IDA parameters), as obtained in each of the dynamic runs. It is possible to plot (i) the
maximum relative displacement versus the peak base shear value found in a time-window around the
maximum drift (Corresponding Base Shear), (ii) the maximum relative displacement versus the
maximum base shear value recorded throughout the entire time-history (Maximum Base Shear), or
(iii) the maximum base shear versus the peak relative displacement value found in a time-window
around the maximum shear (Corresponding Drift). The time-window is specified by the user at the IDA
parameters module of the pre-processor.
In addition, it is equally possible for users to obtain in this module the envelopes of a number of
additional response quantities, such as displacements, velocities, accelerations, reactions, member
deformations and member internal forces.
NOTE: SPF Creator has been designed as an independent application and can also be opened from the
Windows Start menu without the need to open SeismoStruct.
With the SPF Creator facility users are able to easily and quickly create several new SeismoStruct input
files, by adapting an existing one. It is noted that no programming or scripting knowledge is required
for these operations, since the program takes care of everything and automatically creates the new
files.
Upon opening the program, the SPF Creator Main Window will appear. With the Open SPF & Select
Parameters button, users may load their base SPF file, which will be used as the template to create all
the new SeismoStruct input files.
NOTE: SeismoStruct input files are binary files, i.e. non-text files, where all the data structures are
stored as a sequence of bytes. A detailed description of the structure of the file format (*.spf) can be
found by clicking the Show SPF File Structure button.
The structure of the loaded input file is displayed as a tree-view at the left of the screen, starting from
the Main Title and the general Project Data, to the Materials, Sections and Element Classes, through to
the Output Settings. By selecting each branch of the tree-view all the data of a particular record, which
includes properties of the structural model, are displayed at the right of the screen. These properties
can then read and modified to create the new SPF files.
Users may select the properties, for which multiple values are to be introduced, by right-clicking on
each value and selecting the Add Entry to Table command, as shown in picture below. All the selected
properties are added to a new table on the Change & Create SPF file tab.
Adding properties of the SPF file to the Change & Create SPF file table
In the Change & Create SPF file tab the table entries can then be modified either directly on the table
(by clicking on each table cell), or by copying and pasting to spreadsheet applications, such as MS
Excel. The number of files to be created are determined by the No. of Files to be Created parameter.
After selecting the values of the selected properties, users are able to create the new files from the
Create Files button. The files are created automatically in the folder, where the original file exists.
Direct change of the properties on the Change & Create SPF file table
282 SeismoStruct User Manual
Copying and Pasting data to the Change & Create SPF file table by the right-click commands
SEISMOBATCH
A special batch facility called SeismoBatch has been developed and introduced in SeismoStruct in
order to facilitate the automatic execution of numerous analyses in sequence. SeismoBatch is accessed
from the main menu (Tools > Open SeismoBatch...) or through the corresponding toolbar button .
NOTE 1: SeismoBatch has been designed as an independent application and can also be opened from
the Windows Start menu without the need to open SeismoStruct.
The batch facility is organised in three modules; the first is used to select the working directory, where
the SeismoStruct or XML input files are saved, the second is used to run the analyses, while in the third
module users may extract the analysis results that they need. Moving from one module to another can
be done though the buttons of the menu at the left of the window.
NOTE 2: One very important feature of SeismoBatch is the ability to suppress the warning messages at
the beginning of the analysis, in which way the execution is always carried out. This is of particular
importance, when a large series of analysis is to be carried out without the presence of the user.
Suppressing the warning messages can be done within the General tab of the Projects Settings of
SeismoStruct.
NOTE 3: Even if the user chooses to display warning messages at the beginning of the analysis, these
are automatically closed after 2 minutes, if there is no input by the user. This is particularly useful in
SeismoBatch, since the sequence of the analyses does not stop if a warning message appears.
Batch Facility 283
Running the analyses is done by clicking the Run button. The analysis that is running at any time is
denoted with red, whilst green are coloured the entries of the analyses that have already been
executed, and white are the projects that have not been carried out yet. The option of simultaneously
executing multiple analyses has been introduced from SeismoBatch 2016 in order to take full
advantage of multi-core processors.
NOTE: The analyses carried out with the batch facility employ the SeismoStruct Engine, which is
SeismoStruct's solver without the graphical environment. Consequently, the batch analyses run much
faster than the ones carried out with SeismoStruct, because no time is spent on the graphical updating
of the application and other Windows related functions.
Batch Facility 285
Bathe K.J. [1996] "Finite Element Procedures in Engineering Analysis," 2nd Edition, Prentice Hall.
Beyer, K., Dazio, A., and Priestley, M.J.N. [2008] "Seismic design of torsionally eccentric buildings with
U-shaped RC walls," ROSE School, Pavia, Italy.
Beyer, K., Dazio, A., and Priestley, M.J.N. [2008] "Inelastic Wide-Column Models for U-Shaped
Reinforced Concrete Walls," Journal of Earthquake Engineering 12:Sp1, 1-33.
Beyer, K., Dazio, A., and Priestley, M.J.N.[2008] "Elastic and inelastic wide-column models for RC non
rectangular walls," Proceedings of the fortieth World Conference on Earthquake Engineering, Beijing,
China.
Benjamin S.T., Williams H.A. [1958] "The behaviour of one-storey brick shear walls," ASCE Journal of
Structural Division, Vol. 84, No.ST4, pp. 30.
Bento R., Pinho R., Bhatt C. [2008] "Nonlinear Static Procedures for the seismic assessment of the 3D
irregular SPEAR building," Proceedings of the Workshop on Nonlinear Static Methods for
Design/Assessment of 3D Structures, Lisbon, Portugal.
Bernuzzi C., Zandonini R., Zanon P. [1996] "Experimental analysis and modelling of semi-rigid steel
joints under cyclic reversal loading," Journal of Constructional Steel Research, Vol. 38, No. 2, pp. 95-
123.
Bertoldi S.H., Decanini L.D., Gavarini C. [1993] "Telai tamponati soggetti ad azione sismica, un modello
semplificato: confronto sperimentale e numerico," (in Italian) Atti del 6° convegno nazionale ANIDIS,
Vol. 2, pp. 815-824, Perugia, Italy.
Bertoldi S.H., Decanini L.D., Santini S., Via G. [1994] "Analytical models in infilled frames," Proceedings
of the Tenth European Conference on Earthquake Engineering, Vienna, Austria.
Beyer K, Dazio A., Priestley M.J.N. [2008] "Inelastic wide-column models for U-shaped reinforced
concrete wall," Journal of Earthquake Engineering, Vol. 12, No. 1, pp. 1-33.
Binda L., Fontana A., Frigerio G. [1988] "Mechanical behaviour of brick masonries derived from unit
and mortar characteristics," Proceedings of the Eighth International Brick and Block Masonry
Conference, Dublin, Ireland.
Blandon, C.A. [2005] Implementation of an Infill Masonry Model for Seismic Assessment of Existing
Buildings, Individual Study, European School for Advanced Studies in Reduction of Seismic Risk (ROSE
School), Pavia, Italy.
Bouc, R. [1967]. "Forced vibration of mechanical systems with hysteresis". Proceedings of the Fourth
Conference on Nonlinear Oscillation. Prague, Czechoslovakia. p. 315.
Broderick B.M., Elnashai A.S., Izzuddin B.A. [1994] "Observations on the effect of numerical dissipation
on the nonlinear dynamic response of structural systems," Engineering Structures, Vol. 16, No. 1, pp.
51-62.
Butterfield, R., Gottardi, G. [1994] “A complete three-dimensional failure envelope for shallow footings
on sand,” Géotechnique, Vol. 44, No. 1, pp. 181-184.
Calabrese A., Almeida J.P., Pinho R. [2010] "Numerical issues in distributed inelasticity modelling of RC
frame elements for seismic analysis," Journal of Earthquake Engineering, Vol. 14, Special Issue 1, pp.
38-68.
Casarotti C., Pinho R. [2006] "Seismic response of continuous span bridges through fibre-based finite
element analysis," Journal of Earthquake Engineering and Engineering Vibration, Vol. 5, No. 1, pp. 119-
131.
Casarotti C., Pinho R. [2007] "An Adaptive capacity spectrum method for assessment of bridges
subjected to earthquake action," Bulletin of Earthquake Engineering, Vol. 5, No. 3, pp. 377-390.
CEB [1996] RC Frames under Earthquake Loading: State of the Art Report, - Comite Euro-International
du Beton, Thomas Telford, London, England.
288 SeismoStruct User Manual
Dawe J. L. and Seah C. K. [1989] "Out-of-plane resistance of concrete masonry infilled panels." Can. J.
Civ. Eng., 16(6), 854-856
Decanini L.D., Fantin G.E. [1987] "Modelos Simplificados de la Mamposteria Incluida en Porticos.
Características s de Rigidez y Resistencia Lateral en Estado Limite," Jornadas Argentinas de Ingenieria
Estructural, Buenos Aires, Argentina, Vol. 2, pp. 817-836. (in Spanish)
Deierlein G.G., Reinhorn A.M., and Willford M.R. [2010] "Nonlinear structural analysis for seismic
design," NEHRP Seismic Design Technical Brief No. 4, produced by the NEHRP Consultants Joint
Venture, a partnership of the Applied Technology Council and the Consortium of Universities for
Research in Earthquake Engineering, for the National Institute of Standards and Technology,
Gaithersburg, MD, NIST GCR 10-917-5.
Della Corte G., De Matteis G., Landolfo R. [2000] "Influence of connection modelling on seismic
response of moment resisting steel frames," in Moment Resistant Connections of Steel Frames in
Seismic Areas: Design and Reliability (ed. F.M. Mazzolani), Chapter 7, E&FN Spon, London, New York.
De Martino A., Faella C., Mazzolani F.M. [1984] "Simulation of Beam-to-Column Joint Behaviour under
Cyclic Loads," Construzioni Metalliche, Vol. 6, pp. 346-356.
De Sortis A., Di Pasquale G., Nasini U. [1999] Criteri di Calcolo per la Progettazione degli Interventi –
Terremoto in Umbria e Marche del 1997, Servizio Sismico Nazionale, Rome, Italy. (in Italian)
Dionysis Biskinis and Michael N. Fardis [2013] "Stiffness and cyclic deformation capacity of circular RC
columns with or wothout lap-splices and FRP wrapping," Bulletin of Earthquake Engineering 11(5)
Dodd L., Restrepo-Posada J. [1995] “Model for Predicting Cyclic Behavior of Reinforcing Steel,” Journal
of Structural Engineering, Vol. 121, No. 3, pp. 433–445.
Drysdale R.G., Khattab M.M. [1995] "In-plane behaviour of grouted concrete masonry under biaxial
tension-compression," American Concrete Institute Journal, Vol. 92, No. 6, pp. 653-664.
EC8 – Part 5 [2003] Eurocode 8: Design of structures for earthquake resistance – Part 5: Foundations,
retaining structures and geotechnical aspects, EN 1998-5:2004, European Committee for Standardization
(CEN), Belgium.
Elnashai A.S., Elghazouli A.Y. [1993] "Performance of composite steel/concrete members under
earthquake loading, Part I: Analytical model," Earthquake Engineering and Structural Dynamics, Vol.
22, pp. 315-345.
Emori K., Schnobrich W.C. [1978] Analysis of Reinforced Concrete Frame-Wall Structures for Strong
Motion Earthquakes, Structural Research Series No. 434, Civil Engineering Studies, University of
Illinois at Urbana-Champaign.
EN 1998-1 (2004) (English): Eurocode 8: Design of structures for earthquake resistance – Part 1:
General rules, seismic actions and rules for buildings.
EN 1998-3 (English) [2004]: Eurocode 8: Design of structures for earthquake resistance -Part 3:
Assessment and retrofitting of buildings.
Felippa C.A. [2001] "Nonlinear Finite Element Methods," Lecture Notes, Centre for Aerospace
Structure, College of Engineering, University of Colorado, USA. Available from URL:
http://www.colorado.edu/engineering/CAS/courses.d/NFEM.d/Home.html.
Felippa C.A. [2004] "Introduction to Finite Element Methods," Lecture Notes, Centre for Aerospace
Structure, College of Engineering, University of Colorado, USA. Available from URL:
http://www.colorado.edu/engineering/CAS/courses.d/IFEM.d/Home.html.
Ferracuti B., Savoia M. [2005] "Cyclic behaviour of FRP-wrapped columns under axial and flexural
loadings," Proceedings of the International Conference on Fracture, Turin, Italy.
Ferracuti B., Pinho R., Savoia M., Francia R. [2009] "Verification of Displacement-based Adaptive
Pushover through multi-ground motion incremental dynamic analyses," Engineering Structures, Vol.
31, pp. 1789-1799.
290 SeismoStruct User Manual
FIB [2001] "Externally Bonded FRP Reinforcement for RC Structures," FIB Bulletin n. 14, Federation
Internationale du Beton, pp. 138.
FIB [2006] Retrofitting of Concrete Structures by Externally Bonded FRPS, with Emphasis on Seismic
Applications, FIB Bulletin n. 35, Federation Internationale du Beton, pp. 220.
Filippou F.C., Popov E.P., Bertero V.V. [1983] "Effects of bond deterioration on hysteretic behaviour of
reinforced concrete joints," Report EERC 83-19, Earthquake Engineering Research Center, University
of California, Berkeley.
Filippou F.C., Fenves G.L. [2004] "Methods of analysis for earthquake-resistant structures", Chapter 6
in 'Earthquake Engineering - From Engineering Seismology to Performance-Based Engineering', eds. Y.
Bozorgnia and V.V. Bertero, Cambridge University Press, Cambridge, United Kingdom.
Fiorato A.E., Sozen M.A., Gamble W.L. [1970] An Investigation of the Interaction of Reinforced Concrete
Frames with Masonry Filler Walls, Report UILU-ENG-70-100, Department of Civil Engineering,
University of Illinois, Urbana-Champaign IL, USA.
Fragiadakis M., Pinho R., Antoniou S. [2008] "Modelling inelastic buckling of reinforcing bars under
earthquake loading," in Progress in Computational Dynamics and Earthquake Engineering, Eds. M.
Papadrakakis, D.C. Charmpis, N.D. Lagaros and Y. Tsompanakis, A.A. Balkema Publishers – Taylor &
Francis, The Netherlands.
Fragiadakis M., Papadrakakis M. [2008] "Modeling, analysis and reliability of seismically excited
structures: computational issues," International Journal of Computational Methods, Vol. 5, No. 4, pp.
483-511.
Freitas J.A.T., Almeida J.P.M., Pereira E.M.B.R. [1999] "Non-conventional formulations for the finite
element method," Computational Mechanics, Vol. 23, pp. 488-501.
Fugazza D. [2003] Shape-memory Alloy Devices in Earthquake Engineering: Mechanical Properties,
Constitutive Modelling and Numerical Simulations, MSc Dissertation, European School for Advanced
Studies in Reduction of Seismic Risk (ROSE School), Pavia, Italy.
Gazetas, G. [1991] “Foundation vibrations,” Foundation Engineering Handbook, 2nd Ed., Fang, H.Y. (Ed.),
pp. 553-593, Van Nostrand Reinhold, New York, USA.
Gere J.M., Timoshenko S.P. [1997] Mechanics of Materials, 4th Edition.
Giannakas A., Patronis D., Fardis M. [1987] "The influence of the position and the size of openings to
the elastic rigidity of infill walls," Proceedings of Eighth Hellenic Concrete Conference, Xanthi-Kavala,
Greece. (in Greek)
Giberson, M.F. [1967] “The Response of Nonlinear Multi-Story Structures subjected to Earthquake
Excitation,” Doctoral Dissertation, California Institute of Technology, Pasadena, CA., May 1967, 232pp.
Giberson, M.F. [1969] “Two Nonlinear Beams with Definition of Ductility,” Journal of the Structural
Division, ASCE, Vol. 95, No. 2, pp. 137-157.
Gostic S., Zarnic R. [1985] "Cyclic lateral response of masonry infilled R/C frames and confined
masonry walls," Proceedings of the Eighth North-American Masonry Conference, Austin, Texas, USA.
Hall J.F. [2006] "Problems encountered from the use (or misuse) of Rayleigh damping," Earthquake
Engineering and Structural Dynamics, Vol. 35, No. 5, pp. 525-545.
Hamburger R.O. [1993] "Methodology for seismic capacity evaluation of steel-frame buildings with
infill unreinforced masonry," Proceedings of the US National Conference on Earthquake Engineering,
Memphis, Tennesse, USA.
Hamburger R.O., Foutch D.A., Cornell C.A. [2000] "Performance basis of guidelines for evaluation,
upgrade and design of moment-resisting steel frames," Proceedings of the Twelfth World Conference
on Earthquake Engineering, Auckland, New Zealand, paper No. 2543.
Han T.-S., Feenstra P.H., Billington S.L. [2003] “Simulation of Highly Ductile Fiber-Reinforced Cement-
Bibliography 291
Based Composite Components Under Cyclic Loading.”, ACI Structural Journal, Vol. 100, No. 6, pp. 749-
757
Hellesland J., Scordelis A. [1981] "Analysis of RC bridge columns under imposed deformations," IABSE
Colloquium, Delft, pp. 545-559.
Hendry A.W. [1990] Structural Masonry, Macmillan Education Ltd, London, England.
Hilber H.M., Hughes T.J.R., Taylor R.L. [1977] "Improved numerical dissipation for time integration
algorithms in structural dynamics," Earthquake Engineering and Structural Dynamics, Vol. 5, No. 3, pp.
283-292.
Holmes M. [1961] "Steel Frames with Brickwork and Concrete Infilling," Proceedings of the Institution
of Civil Engineers, Vol. 19, pp. 473-478.
Hughes T.J.R. [1987] The Finite Element Method, Linear Static and Dynamic Finite Element Analysis,
Prentice-Hall.
Hyodo M., Yamamoto Y., Sugyiama M. [1994] "Undrained cyclic shear behavior of normally
consolidated clay subjected to initial static shear stresses," Soils and Foundations, Vol. 34, No. 4, pp. 1-
11.
Ibarra L.F., Medina R.A., Krawinkler H. [2005] "Hysteretic Models that Incorporate Stiffness and
Strength Deterioration." Earthquake Engineering and Structural Dynamics, Vol. 34 pp. 1489-1511.
Irons B.M. [1970] "A frontal solution program for finite element analysis," International Journal for
Numerical Methods in Engineering, Vol. 2, pp. 5-32.
Izzuddin B.A. [1991] Nonlinear Dynamic Analysis of Framed Structures, PhD Thesis, Imperial College,
University of London, London, UK
Kaldjian M.J. [1967] "Moment-curvature of beams as Ramberg-Osgood functions," Journal of Structural
Division, ASCE, Vol. 93, No. ST5, pp. 53-65.
KANEPE [2017] Earthquake Planning and Protection Organisation of Greece: Code for Structural
Interventions, 2nd revision.
Kappos A., Konstantinidis D. [1999] "Statistical analysis of confined high strength concrete," Materials
and Structures, Vol. 32, pp. 734-748.
Karsan I.D., Jirsa J.O. [1969] “Behavior of concrete under compressive loading.”, Journal of the
Structural Division, Proceedings of the American Society of Civil Engineers, Vol. 95, Issue 12, pp. 2543-
2564
Kent D.C., Park R. [1971] “Flexural members with confined concrete.”, Journal of the Structural
Division, Proceedings of the American Society of Civil Engineers, Vol. 97, Issue 7, pp. 1969-1990
Kunnath S.K. [2004] "Identification of modal combination for nonlinear static analysis of building
structures," Computer-Aided Civil and Infrastructure Engineering, Vol. 19, pp. 246-259.
Liauw T.C., Lee S.W. [1977] "On the behaviour and the analysis of multi-storey infilled frames
subjected to lateral loading," Proceedings of Institution of Civil Engineers, Part 2, Vol. 63, pp. 641-656.
Liauw T.C., Kwan K.H. [1984] "Nonlinear behaviour of non-integral infilled frames," Computer and
Structures, Vol. 18, No. 3, pp. 551-560.
Lignos D.G.,Krawinkler H. [2011] "Deterioration Modeling of Steel Components in Support of Collapse
Prediction of Steel Moment Frames under Earthquake Loading." Journal of Structural Engineering, Vol.
137, No. 11, pp. 1291-1302.
Lignos, D.G., Krawinkler, H. [2012]. “Development and Utilization of Structural Component Databases
for Performance-Based Earthquake Engineering", Journal of Structural Engineering, ASCE.
292 SeismoStruct User Manual
Muthukumar S. and DesRoches R. [2006] “Elastoplastic A Hertz contact model with non-linear
damping for pounding simulation”, Earthquake Engineering and Structural Dynamics, Vol. 35, pp. 811-
828
Nagashima T., Sugano S., Kimura H., Ichikawa A. [1992] "Monotonic axial compression tests on ultra
high strength concrete tied columns," Proceedings of the Tenth World Conference on Earthquake
Engineering, Madrid, Spain, pp. 2983-2988.
Neuenhofer A., Filippou F.C. [1997] "Evaluation of nonlinear frame finite-element models," Journal of
Structural Engineering, Vol. 123, No. 7, pp. 958-966.
Newmark N.M. [1959] "A method of computation for structural dynamics," Journal of the Engineering
Mechanics Division, ASCE, Vol. 85, No. EM3, pp. 67-94.
Nogueiro P., Simoes da Silva L., Bento R., Simoes R. [2005a] "Numerical implementation and calibration
of a hysteretic model with pinching for the cyclic response of steel and composite joints," Proceedings
of the Fourth International Conference on Advances in Steel Structures, Shangai, China, Paper no. ISP-
45.
Nogueiro P., Simoes da Silva L., Bento R., Simoes R. [2005b] "Influence of joint slippage on the seismic
response of steel frames," Proceedings of the EuroSteel Conference on Steel and Composite Structures,
Maastricht, Nederlands, Paper no. 314.
NTC 2008, D.M. Infrastrutture Trasporti 14 gennaio 2008 (G.U. 4 febbraio 2008 n. 29 - Suppl. Ord.).
”Norme tecniche per le Costruzioni” (NTC08).
NTC 2018, D.M. Infrastrutture Trasporti 17 gennaio 2018 (G.U. 20 febbraio 2018 n. 8 - Suppl. Ord.).
”Norme tecniche per le Costruzioni” (NTC18).
Oran C. [1973] "Tangent stiffness in space frames," Journal of the Structural Division, ASCE, Vol. 99, No.
ST6, pp. 987-1001.
Otani, S. [1974] SAKE, A Computer Program for Inelastic Response of R/C Frames to Earthquakes,
Report UILU-Eng-74-2029, Civil Engineering Studies, University of Illinois at Urbana-Champaign, USA.
Otani S. [1981] "Hysteresis Models of Reinforced Concrete for earthquake Response Analysis," Journal
of Faculty of Engineering, University of Tokyo, Vol. XXXVI, No2, 1981 pp 407-441.
Papia M. [1988] "Analysis of infilled frames using a coupled finite element and boundary element
solution scheme," International Journal for Numerical Methods in Engineering, Vol. 26, pp. 731-742.
Park R., Paulay T. [1975] Reinforced Concrete Structures, John Wiley & Sons, New York.
Park Y. J., Wen Y. K., Ang H-S. [1986] “Random Vibration of Hysteretic Systems under Bi- Directional
Ground Motions”, Earthquake Engi neering and Structural Dynamics, Vol. 14, No 4, pp. 543-557.
Paulay T., Priestley M.J.N. [1992] Seismic Design of Reinforced Concrete and Masonry Buildings, John
Wiley & Sons Inc., New York.
Pegon P. [1996] "Derivation of consistent proportional viscous damping matrices," JRC Research
Report No I.96.49, Ispra, Italy.
Penelis G.G., Kappos A.J. [1997] Earthquake-resistant Concrete Structures, E & FN Spon, London, UK.
Pietra D., Pinho R. and Antoniou S. [2006] "Verification of displacement-based adaptive pushover for
seismic assessment of high-rise steel buildings," Proceedings of the First European Conference on
Earthquake Engineering and Seismology, Geneva, Switzerland, Paper no. 956.
Pilkey W.D. [1994] Formulas for Stress, Strain, and Structural Matrices, John Wiley & Sons, New York.
Pinho R., Antoniou S. [2005] "A displacement-based adaptive pushover algorithm for assessment of
vertically irregular frames," Proceedings of the Fourth European Workshop on the Seismic Behaviour
of Irregular and Complex Structures, Thessaloniki, Greece.
294 SeismoStruct User Manual
Pinho R., Casarotti C., Antoniou S. [2007] "A comparison of single-run pushover analysis techniques for
seismic assessment of bridges," Earthquake Engineering and Structural Dynamics, Vol. 36, No. 10, pp.
1347–1362.
Pinho R., Bhatt C., Antoniou S., Bento R. [2008a] "Modelling of the horizontal slab of a 3D irregular
building for nonlinear static assessment," Proceedings of the Fourteenth World Conference on
Earthquake Engineering, Beijing, China, Paper no. 05-01-0159.
Pinho R., Marques M., Monteiro R., Casarotti C. [2008b] "Using the Adaptive Capacity Spectrum Method
for seismic assessment of irregular frames," Proceedings of the Fifth European Workshop on the
Seismic Behaviour of Irregular and Complex Structures, Catania, Italy, Paper no. 21.
Pinho R., Monteiro R., Casarotti C., Delgado R. [2009] "Assessment of continuous span bridges through
Nonlinear Static Procedures," Earthquake Spectra, Vol. 25, No. 1, pp. 143-159.
Priestley M.J.N. [2003] Myths and Fallacies in Earthquake Engineering, Revisited. The Mallet Milne
Lecture, IUSS Press, Pavia, Italy.
Priestley M.J.N., Grant D.N. [2005] "Viscous damping in seismic design and analysis," Journal of
Earthquake Engineering, Vol. 9, Special Issue 1, pp. 229-255.
Priestley M.J.N., Seible F., Calvi G.M. [1996] Seismic Design and Retrofit of Bridges, John Wiley & Sons
Inc., New York.
Prota A., Cicco F., Cosenza E. [2009] "Cyclic behavior of smooth steel reinforcing bars: experimental
analysis and modeling issues," Journal of Earthquake Engineering, Vol. 13, No. 4, pp. 500–519.
Przemieniecki J.S. [1968] Theory of Matrix Structural Analysis, McGraw Hill.
Ramberg W., Osgood W.R. [1943] Description of Stress-Strain Curves by Three Parameters, National
Advisory Committee on Aeronautics, Technical Note 902.
Repapis C. [2000] Study of Different Approaches for Nonlinear Dynamic Analysis of RC Frames, MSc
Dissertation, Dept. of Civil Engineering, Imperial College, London, UK.
Ribeiro F.L.A., Barbosa A.R., Scott M.H., Neves L.C. [2014] "Deterioration Modeling of Steel Moment
Resisting Frames Using Finite-Length Plastic Hinge Force-Based Beam-Column Elements." Journal of
Structural Engineering, Vol. 141, No. 2, pp. 04014112.
Richard R.M., Abbott B.J. [1975] "Versatile Elastic Plastic Stress-Strain Formula," Journal of Engineering
Mechanics, ASCE, Vol. 101, No. 4, pp. 511-515.
Riddington J.R., Ghazali M.Z. [1988] "Shear strength of masonry walls," Proceedings of the Eighth
International Brick and Block Masonry Conference, Dublin, Ireland.
Rosenblueth, E.[1951] A basis for a Seismic Design, PhD Thesis, University of Illinois, Urbana, USA..
Sahlin S. [1971] Structural Masonry, Prentice-Hall Inc., New Jersey, USA.
San Bartolome A.[1990] Colleciςn del Ingeniero Civil, Libro No. 4, Colegio de Ingenierios del Peru, Peru.
(in Spanish)
Sattar S. and Liel A.B. [2010] "Seismic Performance of Reinforced Concrete Frame Structures with and
without Masonry Infill Walls". 9th U.S. National and 10th Canadian Conference on Earthquake
Engineering, Toronto, Canada.
Scott B.D., Park R., Priestley M.J.N. [1982] "Stress-strain behaviour of concrete confined by overlapping
hoops at low and high strain rates," ACI Journal, Vol. 79, No. 1, pp. 13-27.
Scott M.H., Fenves G.L. [2006] "Plastic hinge integration methods for force-based beam–column
elements," ASCE Journal of Structural Engineering, Vol. 132, No. 2, pp. 244-252.
Seed H.B., Idriss I.M., Makdisi F., Banerjee N. [1975] "Representation of irregular stress time-histories
by equivalent uniform stress series in liquefaction analysis," Report No. UCB/EERC 75-29, University
of California, Berkeley, USA.
Bibliography 295
Sheikh S.A., Uzumeri S.M. [1982] "Analytical model for concrete confined in tied columns," Journal of
the Structural Division, ASCE, Vol. 108, No. ST12, pp. 2703-2722.
Simo J.C., Hughes T.J.R. [1998] “Computational Inelasticity”, Springer-Verlag New York, USA.
Simoes R., Simoes da Silva L., Cruz P. [2001] "Behaviour of end-plate beam-to-column composite joints
under cyclic loading," International Journal of Steel and Composite Structures, Vol. 1, No. 3, pp. 355-
376.
Sivaselvan M., Reinhorn A.M. [1999] "Hysteretic models for cyclic behavior of deteriorating inelastic
structures," Report MCEER-99-0018, MCEER/SUNY/Buffalo.
Sivaselvan M., Reinhorn A.M. [2001] "Hysteretic models for deteriorating inelastic structures," Journal
of Engineering Mechanics, ASCE, Vol. 126, No. 6, pp. 633-640, with discussion by Wang and Foliente
and closure in Vol. 127, No. 11.
Smyrou E., Blandon C.A., Antoniou S., Pinho R., Crisafulli F. [2011] "Implementation and verification of
a masonry panel model for nonlinear dynamic analysis of infilled RC frames," Bullettin of Earthquake
Engineering, DOI 10.1007/s10518-011-9262-6.
Spacone E., Ciampi V., Filippou F.C. [1996] "Mixed formulation of nonlinear beam finite element,"
Computers & Structures, Vol. 58, No. 1, pp. 71-83.
Spoelstra M., Monti G. [1999] "FRP-confined concrete model," Journal of Composites for Construction,
ASCE, Vol. 3, pp. 143-150.
Shrive N.G. [1991] "Materials and material properties," in Reinforced and Prestressed Masonry,
Longman Scientific and Technical, London, England.
Stafford-Smith B. [1966] "Behaviour of square infilled frames," Proceedings of the American Society of
Civil Engineers, Journal of Structural Division, Vol. 92, No. ST1, pp. 381-403.
Stafford-Smith B. and Carter C. [1969]. "A method for the analysis of infilled frames", Proc. Instn. Civ.
Engrs., 44, 31–48.
Stockl S., Hofmann P. [1988] "Tests on the shear bond behaviour in the bed-joints of masonry,"
Proceedings of the Eighth International Brick and Block Masonry Conference, Dublin, Ireland.
Takeda T., Sozen M.A., Nielsen N.N. [1970] "Reinforced concrete response to simulated earthquakes,"
Journal of Structural Division, ASCE, Vol. 96, No. ST12, pp. 2557-2573.
TBDY [2018]: Turkish Seismic Building Regulations.
Thiruvengadam H. [1980] "On the natural frequencies of infilled frames," Journal of Earthquake
Engineering and Structural Dynamics, Vol. 13, pp. 507-526.
Triantafillou T.C. [2006] "Seismic Retrofitting using Externally Bonded Fibre Reinforced Polymers
(FRP)," (To appear in Chapter 5 of the fib bulletin "Seismic Assessment & Retrofit of RC Buildings")
Trueb U. [1983] Stability Problems of Elasto-Plastic Plates and Shells by Finite Elements, PhD Thesis,
Imperial College, University of London, London.
TS500 [2000]: Requirements for Design and Construction of Reinforced Concrete Structures.
Utku B. [1980] "Stress magnifications in walls with openings," Proceedings of the Seventh World
Conference on Earthquake Engineering, Istanbul, Turkey.
Vamvatsikos D., Cornell C.A. [2002] "Incremental dynamic analysis," Earthquake Engineering and
Structural Dynamics, Vol. 31, No. 3, pp. 491-514.
Varum H.S.A. [2003] Seismic Assessment, Strengthening and Repair of Existing Buildings, PhD Thesis,
University of Aveiro, Portugal.
Wen Y.K. [1976] “Method for Random Vibration of Hysteretic Systems.”, JourJournal of the Engineering
Mechanics Division, ASCE, Vol. 102, Issue 2, Pg. 249-263.
296 SeismoStruct User Manual
Wilson E. [2001] Static and Dynamic Analysis of Structures, Computers and Structures Inc, Berkeley,
California. (available at URL: http://www.edwilson.org/book/book.htm)
Wakabayashi M. [1986] Design of earthquake-resistant buildings, McGraw-Hill, USA.
Wan Q., Yi W. [1986] "The shear strength of masonry walls under combined stresses," Proceedings of
the Fourth Canadian Masonry Symposium, University of New Brunswick, Canada.
Wolf J.P. [1994] Foundation Vibration Analysis Using Simple Physical Models, Prentice Hall, New
Jersey, USA.
Yassin M.H.M. [1994] Nonlinear analysis of prestressed concrete structures under monotonic and
cyclic loads, PhD Thesis, University of California, Berkeley, USA.
Yankelevsky D.Z., Reinhardt H.W. [1989] "Uniaxial behavior of concrete in cyclic tension," Journal of
Structural Engineering, ASCE, Vol. 115, No. 1, pp. 166-182.
Zienkiewicz O.C., Taylor R.L. [1991] The Finite Element Method, 4th Edition, McGraw Hill.
Zona A. and Dall’Asta A. [2012] “Elastoplastic model for Steel buckling-restrained braces”,Journal of
Constructional Steel Research , Vol. 68, pp. 118-125
Appendix A - Theoretical background and
modelling assumptions
This appendix serves the purpose of providing users with a brief overview of the theoretical
foundations and modelling conventions in SeismoStruct, furnishing also pointers to a number of
publications where further and deeper explanations and discussion can be found.
GEOMETRIC NONLINEARITY
Large displacements/rotations and large independent deformations relative to the frame element's
chord (also known as P-Delta effects) are taken into account in SeismoStruct, through the employment
of a total co-rotational formulation developed and implemented by Correia and Virtuoso [2006].
The implemented total co-rotational formulation is based on an exact description of the kinematic
transformations associated with large displacements and three-dimensional rotations of the beam-
column member. This leads to the correct definition of the element's independent deformations and
forces, as well as to the natural definition of the effects of geometrical non-linearities on the stiffness
matrix.
The implementation of this formulation considers, without losing its generality, small deformations
relative to the element's chord, notwithstanding the presence of large nodal displacements and
rotations. In the local chord system of the beam-column element, six basic displacement degrees-of-
freedom (θ2(A), θ3(A), θ2(B), θ3(B), Δ, θT) and corresponding element internal forces (M2(A), M3(A), M2(B), M3(B),
F, MT) are defined, as shown in the figure below:
NOTE 1: If a given beam or column is anticipated to experience large deformations relative to the
chord connecting its end nodes (i.e. p-delta effects), this effect can be taken into account by using 2-3
elements per member, which is enough for most cases.
NOTE 2: It is noted that when assessing single piers, geometric nonlinearity coupled with a non-
baricentrical neutral axis may lead to spurious axial load levels.
MATERIAL INELASTICITY
Distributed inelasticity elements are becoming widely employed in earthquake engineering
applications, either for research or professional engineering purposes. Whilst their advantages in
298 SeismoStruct User Manual
relation to the simpler lumped-plasticity models, together with a concise description of their historical
evolution and discussion of existing limitations, can be found in e.g. Filippou and Fenves [2004] or
Fragiadakis and Papadrakakis [2008], here it is simply noted that distributed inelasticity elements do
not require (not necessarily straightforward) calibration of empirical response parameters against the
response of an actual or ideal frame element under idealized loading conditions, as is instead needed
for concentrated-plasticity phenomenological models. In SeismoStruct, use is made of the so-called
fibre approach to represent the cross-section behaviour, where each fibre is associated with a uniaxial
stress-strain relationship; the sectional stress-strain state of beam-column elements is then obtained
through the integration of the nonlinear uniaxial stress-strain response of the individual fibres
(typically 100-150) in which the section has been subdivided (the discretisation of a typical reinforced
concrete cross-section is depicted, as an example, in the figure below). Such models feature additional
assets, which can be summarized as: no requirement of a prior moment-curvature analysis of
members; no need to introduce any element hysteretic response (as it is implicitly defined by the
material constitutive models); direct modelling of axial load-bending moment interaction (both on
strength and stiffness); straightforward representation of biaxial loading, and interaction between
flexural strength in orthogonal directions.
Distributed inelasticity frame elements can be implemented with two different finite elements (FE)
formulations: the classical displacement-based (DB) ones [e.g. Hellesland and Scordelis 1981; Mari and
Scordelis 1984], and the more recent force-based (FB) formulations [e.g. Spacone et al. 1996;
Neuenhofer and Filippou 1997].
In a DB approach the displacement field is imposed, whilst in a FB element equilibrium is strictly
satisfied and no restraints are placed to the development of inelastic deformations throughout the
member; see e.g. Alemdar and White [2005] and Freitas et al. [1999] for further discussion. In the DB
case, displacement shape functions are used, corresponding for instance to a linear variation of
curvature along the element.
In contrast, in a FB approach, a linear moment variation is imposed, i.e. the dual of previously referred
linear variation of curvature. For linear elastic material behaviour, the two approaches obviously
produce the same results, provided that only nodal forces act on the element. On the contrary, in case
of material inelasticity, imposing a displacement field does not enable to capture the real deformed
shape since the curvature field can be, in a general case, highly nonlinear. In this situation, with a DB
formulation a refined discretisation (meshing) of the structural element (typically 4-5 elements per
structural member) is required for the computation of nodal forces/displacements, in order to accept
the assumption of a linear curvature field inside each of the sub-domains. Still, in the latter case users
Appendix A 299
are not advised to rely on the values of computed sectional curvatures and individual fibre stress-
strain states. Instead, a FB formulation is always exact, since it does not depend on the assumed
sectional constitutive behaviour. In fact, it does not restrain in any way the displacement field of the
element. In this sense this formulation can be regarded as always "exact", the only approximation
being introduced by the discrete number of the controlling sections along the element that are used for
the numerical integration. A minimum number of 3 Gauss-Lobatto integration sections are required to
avoid under-integration, however such option will in general not simulate the spread of inelasticity in
an acceptable way. Consequently, the suggested minimum number of integration points is 4, although
5-7 IPs are typically used (see figure below). Such feature enables to model each structural member
with a single FE element, therefore allowing a one-to-one correspondence between structural
members (beams and columns) and model elements. In other words, no meshing is theoretically
required within each element, even if the cross section is not constant. This is because the force field is
always exact, regardless of the level of inelasticity.
In SeismoStruct, both aforementioned DB and FB element formulations are implemented, with the
latter being typically recommended, since, as mentioned above, it does not in general call for element
discretisation, thus leading to considerably smaller models, with respect to when DB elements are
used, and thus much faster analyses, notwithstanding the heavier element equilibrium calculations. An
exception to this non-discretisation rule arises when localisation issues are expected, in which case
special cautions/measures are needed, as discussed in Calabrese et al. [2010].
In addition, the use of a single element per structural element gives users the possibility of readily
employing element chord-rotations output for seismic code verifications (e.g. Eurocode 8, ASCE/SEI 7-
05, etc). Instead, when the structural member has had to be discretised in two or more frame elements
(necessarily the case for DB elements), then users need to post-process nodal displacements/rotation
in order to estimate the members chord-rotations (e.g. Mpampatsikos et al. [2008]).
Finally, it is noted that, for reasons of higher accuracy, the Gauss quadrature is employed in those cases
where two or three integration sections are chosen by the user (it is recalled that for DB elements only
the former is possible), whilst Lobatto quadrature is used in those cases where four to ten integration
sections are defined. Although users may and should refer to the literature (or to online resources) for
further details on such rules, the approximate coordinates along the element's length (measured from
its baricentre) of the integration sections is given below:
2 integration sections: [-0.577 0.577] x L/2
3 integration sections: [-1 0.0 1] x L/2
4 integration sections: [-1 -0.447 0.447 1] x L/2
5 integration sections: [-1 -0.655 0.0 0.655 1] x L/2
6 integration sections: [-1 -0.765 -0.285 0.285 0.765 1] x L/2
7 integration sections: [-1 -0.830 -0.469 0.0 0.469 0.830 1] x L/2
8 integration sections: [-1 -0.872 -0.592 -0.209 0.209 0.592 0.872 1] x L/2
9 integration sections: [-1 -0.900 -0.677 -0.363 0.0 0.363 0.677 0.900 1] x L/2
10 integration sections: [-1 -0.920 -0.739 -0.478 -0.165 0.165 0.478 0.739 0.920 1] x L/2
300 SeismoStruct User Manual
NOTE 1: It is immediate with FB formulations to take into account loads acting along the member,
while this is not the case for DB approaches, where distributed loads need to be transformed into
equivalent point forces/moments at the end nodes of the element (and then lengthy stress-recovery
need to be employed to retrieve accurate member action-effects).
NOTE 2: Should the user wish to, it is possible to adopt a concentrated plasticity approach employing
the inelastic displacement-based plastic-hinge element (infrmDBPH), as opposed to the distributed
inelasticity modelling philosophy intrinsic to the other beam-column elements of SeismoStruct - for
instance the inelastic force-based plastic hinge frame element (infrmFBPH) also concentrates the
inelasticity at the two ends of the element, however within a fixed length of the element.
The same modelling effect can be achieved by making use of the elastic beam-column frame element
(elfrm) coupled with nonlinear links placed at its end-nodes. Such modelling approach should
however be used with care, since accuracy of the analysis may be compromised whenever users are
not highly experienced in the calibration of the available response curves, used in the definition of link
elements, the uncoupled DOFs nature of which does not also permit the modelling of the necessary
moment-axial force interaction curves/surfaces.
NOTE 3: As mentioned above, the distributed inelasticity modelling, on the other hand, requires no
modelling experience since all that is required from the user is to introduce the geometrical and
material characteristics of structural members (i.e. engineering parameters). Its use is therefore
highly recommended and will grant an accurate prediction of the nonlinear response of structures.
NOTE 4: Users are also invited to read the NEHRP Seismic Design Technical Brief No. 4 (i.e. Deierlein
G.G., Reinhorn A.M., and Willford M.R. [2010]), in which the nonlinear modelling is well covered.
Definition of a beam element with a T-section (local direction (1) along the chord axis)
Whilst the orientation of local vector (1) results unambiguously characterised by the line joining the
two end-nodes of the element (positive direction is that going from node n1 to node n2), an
'orientation object' is required in order to fully describe the orientation of the two other remaining
Appendix A 301
local axes, and thus that of the cross-section. From the software version 6 the element's orientation
may be achieved through two different ways:
1. by defining a rotation angle (default option), which is set equal to 0 by default (models built
with the Wizard facility follow this rule), or
2. by defining additional nodes, called 'orientation node'. If the 'default' object is selected, the
element's orientation is automatically computed by the program, otherwise it will depend on
the position of the selected node.
NOTE: In general, the rotation angle equal to 0 means that the axis (3) is vertical. The vertical elements
(axis (1) is vertical) are a special case, where angle = 0 means that the axis (3) is along the X-direction.
The orientation node allows to define the plane (1-3) in which vector (3) lays in, its direction
(perpendicular to axis (1)) and orientation (pointing towards n3), as shown below. Local vector (2)
was then automatically obtained through the cross-product of vectors (1) and (3), with positive
direction following the so-called right-hand rule.
Orientation of a beam element with a T-section (it depends on the position of (n3))
The vast majority of structures modelled in SeismoStruct are defined in plane frames and feature
vertical elements (e.g. rectangular columns, walls) with symmetrical cross-sections and horizontal T-
beams that are not symmetrical around their (2) axis. Hence, the selection of the 'default' object as a
'third node' can be very advantageous.
computational savings in the formation, assembly and reduction of the stiffness matrix during the
iterative process can be significant when using the mNR instead of the NR procedures. However, more
iterations are often required with the mNR, thus leading in some cases to an excessive computational
effort. For this reason, the hybrid approach, whereby the stiffness matrix is updated only in the first
few iterations of a load increment, does usually lead to an optimum scenario.
The iterative procedure follows the conventional schemes employed in nonlinear analysis, whereby
the internal forces corresponding to a displacement increment are computed and convergence is
checked. If no convergence is achieved, then the out-of-balance forces (difference between applied
load vector and equilibrated internal forces) are applied to the structure, and the new displacement
increment is computed. Such loop proceeds until convergence has been achieved (log flag message
equal to Converg) or the maximum number of iterations, specified by the user, has been reached (log
flag message equal to Max_Ite).
For further discussion and clarifications on the algorithms described above, users are strongly advised
to refer to available literature, such as the work by Cook et al. [1988], Crisfield [1991], Zienkiewicz and
Taylor [1991], Bathe [1996] and Felippa [2002], to name but a few.
NOTE: Some element types (infrmFB, infrmFBPH, infrmDBPH & masonry) require a number of
iterations to be carried in order for internal equilibrium to be reached. In some cases, the latter
element loop equilibrium cannot be reached, as signalled by log flag messages elm_inv and elm_ite.
Refer to General > Project Settings > Element Iterative Strategy menu for further information on this
issue.
CONVRAT < 2.0 2.0 < CONVRAT < 5.0 CONVRAT > 5.0
No
RETURN
To minimise duration of analyses, it is fundamental that once convergence is reached, the load
increment or time-step can be gradually increased. For this reason, an efficiency ratio indicator (efrat),
defined as the ratio between the number of iterations carried out (ite) to reach convergence and the
maximum number of iterations that were allowed (nitmax), is calculated. Depending on how far the
analysis was from 'efficiency' (efrat > 0.8), a small, average or large step increasing factor (sif) is
adopted and employed in the calculation of the new step factor (ifac). The product between the latter
and the initial time-step or load increment, defined by the user at the start of the analysis, yields the
augmented analysis step to be used in the subsequent increment.
It is however noteworthy that the step factor is upper-bounded by a value of 1, so as to ensure that the
time step or load increment do not become larger than its initial counterpart, defined by the user at the
start of the analysis. The only exception to this rule occurs in cases where pushover analysis is carried
out using the Automatic Response Control loading/solution algorithm, employed when users are
primarily focused on the final solution rather than the load/response path required to arrive at such
final equilibrium point.
304 SeismoStruct User Manual
EFRAT < 0.2 0.2 < EFRAT < 0.8 EFRAT > 0.8
IFAC>1 ? Yes
IFAC=1
No
RETURN
Convergence criteria
Four different convergence check schemes, which make use of two distinct criteria
(displacement/rotation and force/moment based), are available in SeismoStruct for checking the
convergence of a solution at the end of every iteration:
Displacement/Rotation based scheme
Force/Moment based scheme
Displacement/Rotation AND Force/Moment based scheme
Displacement/Rotation OR Force/Moment based scheme
Herein, the formulation of the two criteria employed in all four schemes is given, whilst the
applicability of the latter is discussed elsewhere.
The displacement/rotation criterion consists in verifying, for each individual degree-of-freedom of
the structure, that the current iterative displacement/rotation is less or equal than a user-specified
tolerance. In other words, if and when all values of displacement or rotation that result from the
application of the iterative (out-of-balance) load vector are less or equal to the pre-defined
displacement/rotation tolerance factors, then the solution is deemed as having converged. This
concept can be mathematically expressed in the following manner:
nd n𝜃
δdi δ𝜃j
max , ≤ 1 ⇒ convergence
dtol i=1
𝜃tol j=1
where,
δdi is the iterative displacement at translational degree of freedom i
δθj is the iterative rotation at rotational degree of freedom j
nd is the number of translational degrees of freedom
nθ is the number of rotational degrees of freedom
dtol is the displacement tolerance (default = 10-2 mm)
Appendix A 305
2
Gi
i=1..n VREF
Gnorm = ≤ 1 ⇒ convergence
n
where,
Gnorm is the Euclidean norm of iterative out-of-balance load vector
Gi is the iterative out-of-balance load at dof i
VREF is the reference “tolerance” value for forces (i=0,1,2) and moments (i=3,4,5)
n is the number of dofs
NOTE: The use of a global, as opposed to local, force/moment criterion is justified with the fact that, in
SeismoStruct, it is common for load vectors to feature significant variations in the order of magnitude
of forces/moments applied at different degrees-of-freedom of the structure, particularly in the cases
where infinitely stiff/rigid connections are modelled with link elements. Hence, the employment of a
local criterion, as is done in the case of displacement/rotation criterion, would lead to over-
conservative and difficult-to-verify converge checks.
Numerical instability
The possibility of the solution becoming numerically unstable is checked at every iteration by
comparing the Euclidean norm of out-of-balance loads, Gnorm, with a pre-defined maximum tolerance
(default=1.0E+20), several orders of magnitude larger than the applied load vector. If G norm exceeds
this tolerance, then the solution is assumed as being numerically unstable and iterations within the
current increment are interrupted, with a log flag message equal to Max_Tol.
On occasions, very unstable models lead to the sudden development of out-of-balance forces that are
several orders of magnitude larger than the maximum tolerance value. This in turn creates a so-called
Solution Problem (i.e. the analysis crashes, albeit in a "clean manner"), and iterations within the
current increment are interrupted, with a log flag message equal to Sol_Prb.
Solution divergence
Divergence of the solution is checked by comparing the value of G norm obtained in the current iteration
with that obtained in the previous one. If Gnorm has increased, then it is assumed that the solution is
diverging and iterations within the current increment are interrupted, with a log flag message equal to
Diverge.
306 SeismoStruct User Manual
Iteration prediction
Finally, a logarithmic convergence rate check is also carried out, so as to try to predict the number of
iterations (itepred) required for convergence to be achieved. If itepred is larger than the maximum
number of iterations specified by the user, then it is assumed that the solution will not achieve
convergence and iterations within the current increment are interrupted, with a log flag message equal
to Prd_Ite.
The following equation is used to compute the value of itepred, noting that ite represents the current
number of iterations and Gtol is the force/moment tolerance:
Gtol
log ite
Gnorm
itepred = ite +
ite
Gnorm
log ite −1
Gnorm
The three checks described above are usually reliable and effective within the scope of applicability of
SeismoStruct, for as long as the divergence and iteration prediction check is not carried out during the
first iterations of an increment when the solution might not yet be stable enough. This issue is
discussed in further detail in the iterative strategy section, where all user-defined parameters related
to these criteria are described.
NOTE: Some element types (infrmFB, infrmFBPH, infrDBPH, masonry) require a number of iterations
to be carried in order for internal equilibrium to be reached. In some cases, the latter element loop
equilibrium cannot be reached, as signalled by log flag messages elm_inv and elm_ite. Refer to Project
Settings > Element Iterative Strategy menu for further information on this issue.
NOTE: When rigid constraints (rigid links or rigid diaphragms) have been defined in the model, users
are advised not to employ the Force-based convergence criterion, especially when the penalty
functions method is used for the modelling of constraints. A Displacement/Rotation based criterion
with more stringent displacement and rotation tolerance values may be employed, instead.
Appendix A 307
Prd_Ite: This flag is similar to the Max_Ite message, the difference being that the solver does not wait
until the maximum number iterations have been reached. Instead, it makes a prediction of the number
of iterations that are expected to be needed for convergence, based on how the iterative solution is
converging (i.e. size of out-of-balance forces, and how fast the convergence tolerance is being reached).
If the predicted iterations is larger than the maximum iterations specified by the user, the Prd_Ite flag
is output and the analysis diverges. In such cases, either increase the Maximum number of iterations
(Project Settings>Global Iterative Strategy), choose a looser convergence criteria scheme with larger
convergence tolerances (Project Settings>Convergence Criteria), or decrease the loading step, as with
the Max_Ite message. It is noted that Prd_Ite is the most common divergence flag.
Diverge: This flag is output when the iterative process in the current step is diverging, instead of
converging to the solution. It is noted that the check for diverging solutions is always carried out after
the Divergence Iteration that is specified by the user in Project Settings> Global Iterative Strategy. This
is done because in general the solution procedures are unstable at the initial 3-4 steps, before they get
stable and gradually converge to the solution. Users are advised to either increase the Divergence
Iteration and the Maximum number of iterations from the Global Iterative Strategy page of the Project
Settings, choose looser convergence criteria from the Convergence Criteria page, or decrease the
loading step.
elm_Ite: This message appears when the maximum number of iterations is reached in the internal
element loop of the elements that require iterations on the element level (infrmFB, infrmFBPH,
infrmDBPH and masonry), without internal equilibrium having been achieved. Users are advised to
either increase the number of iterations or increase the convergence tolerance from the Element
Iterative Strategy tab of the Project Settings. Alternatively, the ‘Do not allow element unbalanced forces
in case of elm_ite’ option may be unchecked. Finally, measure on the global level may be taken, for
instance the analysis load step can be decreased (by increasing the load factor increments or the time-
steps), and the global convergence criteria can be increased. Users are advised to refer to the specific
documentation [e.g. Spacone et al. 1996; Neuenhofer and Filippou 1997] for a better understanding of
the internal loops of the force-based elements.
elm_Inv: This message appears when the stiffness matrix of an element that employs internal
iterations cannot be inverted during the internal element loops. In such cases, users are advised to
increase the elements' convergence tolerance from the Element Iterative Strategy tab of the Project
Settings, to decrease the global analysis load step or to increase the global convergence tolerance
values.
elm_Tol: This message appears when the maximum tolerance value, as specified in the Global Iterative
Strategy page of the Project Settings, has been exceeded during the internal element loops of the force-
based elements. Similar actions with the elm_Inv flag should be taken.
Max_Tol: This flag signifies solutions that become very unstable numerically with out-of-balance
forces larger than the Maximum Tolerance (default=1.0E+20) that is specified in the Global Iterative
Strategy page of the Project Settings. Users are advised to decrease the load increment, or to adopt
looser convergence criteria. Alternatively, the Maximum Tolerance may be increased, but its value
should never exceed values of 1.0E+35 or 1.0E+40, whilst it is noted that in very few cases the latter
will lead to stable solutions. If the Max_Tol message appears in first 2-3 steps of the analysis, or at the
application of the initial loads, an eigenvalue analysis should be run, in order to confirm that all the
members of the model are correctly connected to each other.
Sol_Prb: This message means that a solution of the analysis equations in the current iteration could
not be found. There are numerous reasons for this behaviour, such as extreme values of out-of-balance
forces or zero diagonal stiffness values. Similar measures to those suggested for the case of Max_Tol
flag should be taken.
Apply the automatic adaptation of the norms in the Convergence criteria tab of the program’s
Project Settings.
Select to show Convergence problems in the post-processor through the Project Settings>
Convergence criteria tab. The visualisation of the locations of the structure (elements or
nodes), where the convergence difficulties arise, provides significant feedback for the
identification of the reasons for divergence (e.g. under-reinforced beams that cannot sustain
the gravity loads, elements with very high deformations demand, such as short columns or
coupling beams, etc.).
Uncheck the ‘Do not allow unbalanced forces in case of elm_Ite’ for both the force-based
(infrmFB & infrmFBPH) and the masonry element types in the Element Iterative Strategy tab
of the Project Settings.
Reduce the maximum pushover displacement to 2% in general. This value should not exceed
1.00 or 1.20% for tall buildings and for stiff buildings with large shear walls.
Assign 50 to 100 pushover analysis steps in the general case. This value should be increased in
cases of demanding loading.
Change the fracture/buckling strain for the steel materials to a very large value (e.g. 1) in the
Materials module. When the fracture/buckling strain for the steel materials is reached, the
rebar is deactivated and leads to a sudden drop of the building strength and convergence
difficulties. There are cases, such as coupling beams, where the deformations are enormous. It
is very likely that, if this strain level is reached, the rebars are deactivated (assumed as
fractured) and the beams cannot sustain any gravity load and convergence cannot be reached.
Go to the Element Class module and change the element type of all short elements (e.g. short
columns, and coupling beams) from infrmFBPH or infrmFB to infrmDB. It is noted that the
infrmDB element type generally provides acceptable accuracy only for short members only.
Hence, if applied to short members, this does not affect the analytical results, whilst typically it
leads to significantly improvements in the convergence and overall stability of the analysis.
Increase the Maximum Number of Iterations to 70, the Number of Stiffness Updates to 60 and
the Divergence Iterations to 60 in Iterative Strategy tab of the Project Settings.
Use the elastic frame element type for the coupling beams that cause convergence problems.
In such cases the elements’ moment releases should released by selecting the relevant
checkboxes for the M2a, M3a, M2b and M3b degrees-of–freedom, through the element’s
Properties window within the Element Connectivity module, in order to account for the
formation of plastic hinges at the ends of the coupling beams.
Increase the values of the convergence norms from the Convergence Criteria tab of the
program’s Project Settings.
Increase the rigidity of the rigid diaphragms to 1.0E+13 through the Constraints tab of the
Project Settings.
If the divergence messages of the analysis are mostly Max_Tol or elm_tol, increase the
Maximum Tolerance value to 1e40 in the Iterative Strategy tab of the Project Settings.
Increase the number of fibers for the walls in the Element Class Properties window of the
members within the Element Classes module.
For taller buildings uncheck the Include Geometric Nonlinearities checkbox in the Analysis tab
of the Project Settings.
Moreover:
users are advised to check the last or the 2-3 last steps of the analysis with convergence
problems in order to understand and resolve the reasons for divergence. In such cases the
Convergence Problems page of the post-processor should be advised. Furthermore, running
an Eigenvalue analysis with the same model might offer valuable insight to the problem (e.g.
identify a beam that is accidentally not connected to the adjacent column and behaves as a
cantilever, not being able to sustain the gravity load);
it is noted that elements that cause divergence problems are not necessarily the ones that
withstand significant loading. They are the ones that at the current step face increased
tangential change of the deformation state/internal force re-distribution. Sometimes failed
Appendix A 309
elements can increase significantly the load sustained by adjacent elements, thus leading them
to convergence difficulties, contrary to the failed elements themselves, which converge easily;
the removal of the effective width of beams should also be considered by unchecking the
‘Include Effective Width’ checkbox in the Structural Modelling tab of the Building Modelling
Settings inside the Building Modeller. The introduction of rectangular, rather than T-shaped,
beams sometimes leads to more stable solutions, however it should be noted that removing
the slab effective width weakens the beams and it could render lightly reinforced beams
unable to sustain the gravity loads, hence leading to new convergence problems.
Appendix B - Analysis Types
In this appendix the available analysis types are described in details.
EIGENVALUE ANALYSIS
The efficient Lanczos algorithm [Hughes, 1987] is used by default for the evaluation of the structural
natural frequencies and mode shapes. However, the Jacobi algorithm with Ritz transformation may
also be chosen by the user in the Project Settings menu. Evidently, no loads are to be specified.
Eigenvalue analysis is a purely elastic type of structural analysis, since material properties are taken as
constant throughout the entire computation procedure and hence it is natural for elastic frame
elements (elfrm) to be employed in the creation of the structural model. As described in Pre-Processor
> Element Classes > elfrm, this type of elements do not call for the definition of material or section
types, as their inelastic counterparts, being instead fully described by the values of the following
sectional mechanical properties: cross-section, moment of inertia, torsional constant, modulus of
elasticity and modulus of rigidity [e.g. Pilkey, 1994]. Therefore, an estimate of the vibration period
corresponding to the cracked, as opposed to uncracked, state of the structure, can be readily obtained
by applying reduction factors to the moment of inertia of beam and column cross-sections, as
recommended by Paulay and Priestley [1992], amongst others. These factors may vary from values of
0.3 up to 0.8, depending on the type of member being considered (beam or column), loading
characteristics, and structural configuration. Users are advised to refer to the work of Priestley [2003]
for a thorough discussion on this matter.
If the user, however, wishes to carry out not only eigenvalue but also other types of analysis, possibly
within the inelastic material response range, then he/she might prefer to build only one structural
model, employing inelastic rather than elastic frame elements, that will be employed on all analyses,
including the eigenvalue one. Hence, different material and section types are employed in the
characterisation of the elements' sectional mechanical properties, which are not defined by the user,
but internally determined by the program, using classic formulae that can be found on any book or
publication on basics of structural mechanics [e.g. Gere and Timoshenko, 1997; Pilkey, 1994]. As a
consequence, it results impossible for users to directly modify the second moment of area (or moment
of inertia) of cross-sections to account for the effects of cracking, for which reason the stiffness
reduction of members due to cracking should be instead simulated by changes applied to the modulus
of elasticity of the concrete material (e.g. by reducing it by the same factor that one would apply to the
moment of inertia of a cross-section).
NOTE 1: The use of inelastic elements in eigenvalue analysis features also the advantage of exempting
the user from the onus of (manually) calculating the section mechanical properties of each element
type, taking full account of the presence of longitudinal reinforcement bars within the section.
NOTE 2: Concrete confinement will increase the compressive strength of the material, and hence the
stiffness of the member, leading thus to shorter periods of vibration.
Appendix B 311
NOTE 3: When running an eigenvalue analysis using Lanczos algorithm, user may be presented with a
message stating: "could not re-orthogonalise all Lanczos vectors", meaning that the Lanczos algorithm,
currently the eigenvalue solver in SeismoStruct, could not calculate all or some of the vibration modes
of the structure. This behaviour may be observed in either (i) models with assemblage errors (e.g.
unconnected nodes/elements) or (ii) complex structural models that feature links/hinges etc. If users
have checked carefully their model and found no modelling errors, then they may perhaps try to
"simplify" it, by removing its more complex features until the attainment of the eigenvalue solutions.
This will enable a better understanding of what might be causing the analysis problems, and thus
assist users in deciding on how to proceed. This message typically appears when too many modes are
sought, e.g. when 30 modes are asked in a 24 DOF model, or when the eigensolver cannot simply find
so many modes (even if DOFs > modes).
Load Control
Refers to the case where the load factor is directly incremented and the global structural
displacements are determined at each load factor level.
Response Control
Refers to direct incrementation of the global displacement of one node and the calculation of the
loading factor that corresponds to this displacement.
NOTE: Conventional pushover analysis features an inherent inability to account for the effects that
progressive stiffness degradation, typical in structures subjected to strong earthquake loading, has on
the dynamic response characteristics of structures, and thus on the patterns of the equivalent static
loads applied during a pushover analysis. Indeed, the fixed nature of the load distribution applied to
the structure ignores the potential redistribution of forces during an actual dynamic response, which
pushover tries to somehow reproduce. Consequently, the resulting changes in the modal
characteristics of the structure (typically period elongation) and consequent variation in dynamic
response amplification are not accounted for, which might introduce non-negligible inaccuracies,
particularly in those cases where the influence higher mode is, or becomes, significant. These effects
can only be accounted for by means of Adaptive Pushover.
calculated from a given accelerogram. This spectrum is employed for both the two horizontal (EX, EY)
and the vertical (EZ) seismic directions. Alternatively, different response spectrum factors between
horizontal and vertical directions may be defined in the loading combination module. Further, the
modal combination rule (ABSSUM, SRSS, CQC) should be determined, as well as which modes are to be
combined, as a function of the target cumulative effective modal mass.
Finally, for each case of loading combination (G+Q±E), users are asked to define the factor of static
gravity loading (fG+Q) and the factor of the seismic loading (fE). Seismic loading directions may be
combined linearly (E = ±EX±EY±EZ) with different factors per direction (f EX, fEY, fEZ) or by the SRSS rule
(E = ± EX 2 +EY 2 + EZ 2 ). It should be noted that the gravity loads have an explicitly defined algebraic
sign, while for the seismic loadings both signs for every direction are taken into account. Consequently,
the results of RSA loading combinations in terms of any response quantity are presented as envelopes.
BUCKLING ANALYSIS
In general, in order to identify the limit point that recognises the transition from a stable to an unstable
structure, an incremental analysis should be performed. The incremental analysis considers both
geometric and material nonlinearities. In some cases, i.e. slender steel structures, the stability is
governed by the geometric nonlinearities. Hence, neglecting nonlinear material behaviour and
assuming the relative distribution of internal force equal at all ratios of the applied load, a buckling
analysis can be performed in place of the incremental one. Besides at these two assumptions, the
element geometric stiffness matrices are linear functions of their end forces. Hence, these hypothesis
permit to write the global stiffness equation in the form of a generalised eigenvalue problem in which
the equation of equilibrium at the critical state is
[𝛫𝐸 + 𝜆𝑖 𝛫𝐺 ]𝑑𝑖 = 0
KE is the linear elastic stiffness matrix. KG is the geometric stiffness matrix which represents the change
in stiffness that results from changes in geometry as the applied loading is increased. It is computed for
a reference loading pattern Pref which corresponds to the base state of structure with preloads. λi is a
vector of load factors (eigenvalues) with respect to Pref and di is the buckling mode shape
(eigenvectors), where i refers to the ith buckling mode. The lowest value of λ i provides the elastic
critical load vector λmin Pref. Commonly, it is easier to solve this kind of problem than to solve an
incremental analysis.
Appendix C - Materials
In this appendix the available material types are described in details.
STEEL MATERIALS
Bilinear steel model - stl_bl
NOTE: Due to its very simple and basic formulation, this model is not recommended for the modelling
of reinforced concrete members subject to complex loading histories, where significant load reversals
might occur. For such cases, models stl_mp and stl_mn should be employed instead.
This is a uniaxial bilinear stress-strain model with kinematic strain hardening, whereby the elastic
range remains constant throughout the various loading stages, and the kinematic hardening rule for
the yield surface is assumed as a linear function of the increment of plastic strain. This simple model is
also characterised by easily identifiable calibrating parameters and by its computational efficiency. It
can be used in the modelling of both steel structures, where mild steel is usually employed, as well as
reinforced concrete models, where worked steel is commonly utilised.
Five model-calibrating parameters must be defined in order to fully describe the mechanical
characteristics of the material:
Material Properties Typical values Default values
Modulus of elasticity – Es 2.00E+08 - 2.10E+08 (kPa) 2.00E+08 (kPa)
Yield strength – fy 230000 - 650000 (kPa) 500000 (kPa)
Strain hardening parameter – μ 0.005 - 0.015 (-) 0.005 (-)
Fracture/buckling strain 0.1 (-)
Specific weight – γ 78 (kN/m3) 78 (kN/m3)
316 SeismoStruct User Manual
Nine model-calibrating parameters must be defined in order to fully describe the mechanical
characteristics of the material:
Material Properties Typical values Default values
Modulus of elasticity – Es 2.00E+08 - 2.10E+08 (kPa) 2.00E+08 (kPa)
Yield strength – fy 230000 - 650000 (kPa) 500000 (kPa)
Strain hardening parameter – μ 0 - 0.03 (-) 0.005 (-)
Isotropic Hardening in Compression -0.5 - 0.5 (-) (set as 0 for no 0.1 (-)
Parameter – A1 isotropic hardening in
compression)
Isotropic Hardening in Compression 1 - 7 (-) 7 (-)
Parameter – A2
Isotropic Hardening in Tension Parameter – -0.5 - 0.5 (-) (set as 0 for no 0.1 (-)
A3 isotropic hardening in tension)
Isotropic Hardening in Tension Parameter – 1 - 7 (-) 7 (-)
A4
Fracture / Buckling Strain 0.1 (-)
Specific Weight 78.00 (KN/m3) 78.00 (KN/m3)
Appendix C 317
Six model-calibrating parameters must be defined in order to fully describe the mechanical
characteristics of the material:
Material Properties Typical values Default values
Yield strength – fy 230000 - 650000 (kPa) 500000.00 (kPa)
Yield strain 0.0025
Ramberg Osgood Parameter - γ 10.00- 30.00 (-) 20.00 (-)
Convergence Limit for the Newton-Raphson 1.00E-02 - 1.00E-04 (-) 0.001 (-)
procedure – β1
Fracture / Buckling strain 0.10 (-)
Specific Weight 78.00 (KN/m3) 78.00 (KN/m3)
Ten model-calibrating parameters must be defined in order to fully describe the mechanical
characteristics of the material:
Material Properties Typical values Default values
Modulus of elasticity – Es 2.00E+08 - 2.10E+08 (kPa) 2.00E+08 (kPa)
Yield strength – fy 230000 - 650000 (kPa) 500000 (kPa)
Strain hardening parameter – μ 0.005 - 0.015 (-) 0.005 (-)
Transition curve initial shape parameter – 20 (-) 20 (-)
R0
Transition curve shape calibrating 18.5 (-) 18.5 (-)
coefficient – A1
Transition curve shape calibrating 0.05 - 0.15 (-) 0.15 (-)
coefficient – A2
Isotropic hardening calibrating coefficient – 0.01 – 0.025 (-) 0 (-)
A3
Isotropic hardening calibrating coefficient – 2 - 7 (-) 1 (-)
A4
Fracture/buckling strain 0.1 (-)
Specific weight – γ 78 (kN/m3) 78 (kN/m3)
Thirteen model-calibrating parameters must be defined in order to fully describe the mechanical
characteristics of the material:
Material Properties Typical values Default values
Modulus of elasticity – Es 2.00E+08 - 2.10E+08 (kPa) 2.00E+08 (kPa)
Yield strength – fy 230000 - 650000 (kPa) 500000 (kPa)
Strain hardening parameter – μ 0 - 0.03 (-) 0.005 (-)
Initial Value of Curvature Parameter– R0 10 - 20 (-) 20 (-)
Curvature Degradation Parameter– R1 0 - 0.98 (-) (Recommended 0.925 (-)
value is 0.925)
Curvature Degradation Parameter– R2 Recommened value is 0.15(-) 0.15 (-)
Isotropic Hardening in Compression -0.5 - 0.5 (-) (set as 0 for no 0.1 (-)
Parameter – A1 isotropic hardening in
compression)
Isotropic Hardening in Compression 1 - 7 (-) 7 (-)
Parameter – A2
Isotropic Hardening in Tension Parameter – -0.5 - 0.5 (-) (set as 0 for no 0.1 (-)
A3 isotropic hardening in tension)
Isotropic Hardening in Tension Parameter – 1 - 7 (-) 7 (-)
A4
Initial Stress –σ0 0 (kPa)
Fracture / Buckling Strain 0.1 (-)
Specific Weight 78.00 (KN/m3) 78.00 (KN/m3)
320 SeismoStruct User Manual
Eight model-calibrating parameters must be defined in order to fully describe the mechanical
characteristics of the material:
Material Properties Typical values Default values
Modulus of elasticity – Es 2.00E+08 - 2.10E+08 (kPa) 2.10E+08 (kPa)
Yield strength – fy 230000 - 650000 (kPa) 295400 (kPa)
Stress at peak load 479500 (kPa)
Strain at initiation of strain hardening curve (-) 0.016 (-)
Strain at peak load (-) 0.207 (-)
Strain of the intermediate point of the (-) 0.053 (-)
strain hardening curve
Stress of the intermediate point of the (-) 420000 (kPa)
strain hardening curve
Specific weight 78 (kN/m3) 78 (kN/m3)
Ten model-calibrating parameters must be defined in order to fully describe the mechanical
characteristics of the material:
Material Properties Typical values Default values
Modulus of elasticity – Es 2.00E+08 - 2.10E+08 (kPa) 2.00E+08 (kPa)
Yield strength – fy 230000 - 650000 (kPa) 500000 (kPa)
Strain hardening parameter – μ 0.005 - 0.015 (-) 0.005 (-)
Transition curve initial shape parameter – 20 (-) 20 (-)
R0
Transition curve shape calibrating 18.5 (-) 18.5 (-)
coefficient – A1
Transition curve shape calibrating 0.05 - 0.15 (-) 0.15 (-)
coefficient – A2
Kinematic/isotropic weighing coefficient – Close to 0.9 (-) 0.9 (-)
P
Spurious unloading corrective parameter – 2.5 - 5 (%) 2.5 (%)
r
Fracture strain - 0.1 (-)
Specific weight – γ 78 (kN/m3) 78 (kN/m3)
322 SeismoStruct User Manual
CONCRETE MATERIALS
Trilinear concrete model - con_tl
This is a simplified uniaxial trilinear concrete model that assumes no resistance to tension and features
a residual strength plateau.
Five model-calibrating parameters must be defined in order to fully describe the mechanical
characteristics of the material:
Material Properties Typical values Default values
Mean Compressive strength – fc1 15000 - 45000 (kPa) 28000 (kPa)
Initial stiffness – E1 1.50E+07 - 3.00E+07 (kPa) 2.00E+07 (kPa)
Post-peak stiffness – E2 -5.00E+06 - -3.00E+07 (kPa) -1.00E+07 (kPa)
Residual strength – fc2 5000 - 15000 (kPa) 5000 (kPa)
Specific weight – γ 24 (kN/m3) 24 (kN/m3)
NOTE 1: Values of compressive strength capacity obtained through testing of concrete cubes are
usually 25 to 10 percent higher than their cylinder counterparts, for cylinder concrete strengths of 15
to 50 MPa, respectively.
NOTE 2: Some researchers [e.g. Scott et al., 1982] have suggested that the influence of the high strain
rates expected under seismic loading (0.0167/sec) on the stress-strain behaviour of the core concrete
can be accounted for by adjusting the results of tests conducted at usual strain rates (0.0000033/sec);
the adjustment could consist simply of applying a multiplying factor of 1.25 to the peak stress, the
strain at the peak stress, and the slope of the post-yield falling branch. Mander et al. [1989] also
present methods by which strain rate effects can be incorporated into the model, although the basic
formulae, implemented here, do not include the effect.
324 SeismoStruct User Manual
Five model-calibrating parameters must be defined in order to fully describe the mechanical
characteristics of the material:
Material Properties Typical values Default values
Mean Compressive strength – fc 15000 - 45000 (kPa) 28000 (kPa)
Mean Tensile strength – ft 2000 - 3000 (kPa) 2200 (kPa)
Modulus of Elasticity – Ec 18000 - 30000 (MPa) 24870 (MPa)
Strain at peak stress – c 0.002 - 0.0022 (m/m) 0.002 (m/m)
Specific weight – γ 24 (kN/m3) 24 (kN/m3)
NOTE 1: Values of compressive strength capacity obtained through testing of concrete cubes are
usually 25 to 10 percent higher than their cylinder counterparts, for cylinder concrete strengths of 15
to 50 MPa, respectively.
NOTE 2: Some researchers [e.g. Scott et al., 1982] have suggested that the influence of the high strain
rates expected under seismic loading (0.0167/sec) on the stress-strain behaviour of the core concrete
can be accounted for by adjusting the results of tests conducted at usual strain rates (0.0000033/sec);
the adjustment could consist simply of applying a multiplying factor of 1.25 to the peak stress, the
strain at the peak stress, and the slope of the post-yield falling branch. Mander et al. [1989] also
present methods by which strain rate effects can be incorporated into the model, although the basic
formulae, implemented here, do not include the effect.
Appendix C 325
NOTE 3: On occasions, depending on the structural model and applied loading, crack opening may
introduce numerical instabilities in the analyses. If, on some of those instances, the user is interested
in predicting, for example, the top displacement of a building (i.e. global response) rather than
accurately reproducing the local response of elements and sections (e.g. section curvatures), then
tensile resistance may be simply ignored altogether (i.e. ft = 0 MPa), and in this way stability of the
analysis will most certainly be achieved in easier fashion.
NOTE 4: The confinement factor employed by this material type is a constant confinement factor. It is
defined as the ratio between the confined and unconfined compressive stress of the concrete, and used
to scale up the stress-strain relationship throughout the entire strain range. Although it may be
computed through the use of any confinement model available in the literature [e.g. Ahmad and Shah,
1982; Sheikh and Uzumeri, 1982; Eurocode 8, 2004; Penelis and Kappos, 1997], the Mander et al.
[1989] is used by the program both in the Sections and in the Confinement Factor Calculation module.
Its value usually fluctuates between the values of 1.0 and 2.0 for reinforced concrete members and
between 1.5 and 4.0 for steel-concrete composite members.
Eight model-calibrating parameters must be defined in order to fully describe the mechanical
characteristics of the material:
Material Properties Typical values Default values
Mean Compressive strength – fc 15000 - 45000 (kPa) 28000 (kPa)
Mean Tensile strength – ft - 2200 (kPa)
Modulus of Elasticity – Ec 10000 - 30000 (MPa) 22960 (MPa)
326 SeismoStruct User Manual
NOTE 1: Values of compressive strength capacity obtained through testing of concrete cubes are
usually 25 to 10 percent higher than their cylinder counterparts, for cylinder concrete strengths of 15
to 50 MPa, respectively.
NOTE 2: The non-dimensional critical strain values, r for compression and xcr for tension, determine
the shape of the descending branches of the curve. Users are advised to view the plot on the New
Material dialog box, in order to understand how the curve changes with different values of the
parameters.
NOTE: The need for a special-purpose high-strength concrete model raises from the fact that this type
of concrete features a stress-strain response that differs quite significantly from its normal strength
counterpart, particularly in what concerns the post-peak behaviour, which tends to be considerably
less ductile.
This is a uniaxial nonlinear constant confinement for high-strength concrete model, developed and
initially programmed by Kappos and Konstantinidis [1999]. It follows the constitutive relationship
proposed by Nagashima et al. [1992] and has been statistically calibrated to fit a very wide range of
experimental data. The confinement effects provided by the lateral transverse reinforcement are
incorporated through the modified Sheikh and Uzumeri [1982] factor (i.e. confinement effectiveness
coefficient), assuming that a constant confining pressure is applied throughout the entire stress-strain
range.
Appendix C 327
Four model-calibrating parameters must be defined in order to fully describe the mechanical
characteristics of the material:
Material Properties Typical values Default values
Mean Compressive strength – fc 50000 - 120000 (kPa) 78000 (kPa)
Mean Tensile strength – ft - 4600 (kPa)
Modulus of Elasticity - Ec 35000 – 45000 (MPa) 40742 (MPa)
Specific weight – γ 24 (kN/m3) 24 (kN/m3)
NOTE: On occasions, depending on the structural model and applied loading, crack opening may
introduce numerical instabilities in the analyses. If, on some of those instances, the user is interested
in predicting, for example, the top displacement of a building (i.e. global response) rather than
accurately reproducing the local response of elements and sections (e.g. section curvatures), then
tensile resistance may be simply ignored altogether (i.e. ft = 0 MPa), and in this way stability of the
analysis will most certainly be achieved in easier fashion.
OTHER MATERIALS
Trilinear masonry model - mas_tl
This is a simplified uniaxial trilinear material model that assumes no resistance to tension and features
a residual strength plateau.
Five model-calibrating parameters must be defined in order to fully describe the mechanical
characteristics of the material:
Material Properties Typical values Default values
Mean Compressive strength – fc1 1000 - 10000 (kPa) 5000 (kPa)
Initial stiffness – E1 5.0E+06 - 2.00E+07 (kPa) 1.05E+07 (kPa)
Poisson Ratio 0.10-0.30 (-) 0.20 (-)
Post-peak stiffness – E2 -2.50E+06 - -3.00E+07 (kPa) -1.00E+07 (kPa)
Residual strength – fc2 500 - 5000 (kPa) 1000 (kPa)
Specific weight – γ 24 (kN/m3) 24 (kN/m3)
Seven model-calibrating parameters, the values of which can be obtained from simple uniaxial tests
performed on SMA elements (wires or bars, typically), must be defined in order to fully describe the
mechanical characteristics of the material:
Material Properties Typical values Default values
Modulus of elasticity - E 1.00E+07 - 8.00E+07 (kPa) 1.00E+07 (kPa)
Austenite-to-martensite starting stress - s-
200000 - 600000 (kPa) 200000 (kPa)
AS
Four model-calibrating parameters must be defined in order to fully describe the mechanical
characteristics of the material:
Material Properties Typical values Default values
2.10E+06 - 4.80E+06 (kPa)
(carbon-based fibres)
1.90E+06 - 4.80E+06 (kPa)
Tensile strength - ft 3.00E+06 (kPa)
(glass fibres)
3.50E+06 - 4.10E+06 (kPa)
(aramid fibres)
2.15E+08 - 7.00E+08 (kPa)
(carbon-based fibres)
7.00E+07 - 9.00E+07 (kPa)
Initial stiffness - E1 3.00E+08 (kPa)
(glass fibres)
7.00E+07 - 1.30E+08 (kPa)
(aramid fibres)
Post-peak stiffness - E2 - -5.00E+08 (kPa)
Specific weight – γ 18 (kN/m3) 18 (kN/m3)
Appendix C 333
Two model-calibrating parameters must be defined in order to fully describe the mechanical
characteristics of the material:
Material Properties Typical values Default values
Modulus of elasticity - Es - 2.00E+08 (kPa)
Specific weight – γ 20 (kN/m3) 20 (kN/m3)
NOTE: From SeismoStruct 2016 onwards it is possible to apply concrete material models to the rss
section type.
NOTE: Users may use this section to model the retrofitting of a RC rectangular member with
longitudinally-oriented steel. To do this, first create a material model featuring the properties of the
retrofitting material and then use an rhs-section element with internal height/depth that equals that
of the original element's section, a thickness corresponding to the thickness of the retrofitting layer,
and connect this new retrofitting element to the same nodes to which the existing element is
connected to.
NOTE: Users may use this section to model the retrofitting of a RC circular member with
longitudinally-oriented steel. To do this, first create a material model featuring the properties of the
retrofitting material and then use a chs-section element with internal diameter that equals that of the
original element's section, a thickness corresponding to the thickness of the retrofitting layer, and
connect this new retrofitting element to the same nodes to which the existing element is connected to.
NOTE 1: A T-section can be obtained by assigning identical values to bottom flange width and web
thickness.
NOTE 2: Users may use an I-section to model the retrofitting of a RC rectangular member with
longitudinally-oriented steel or FRP layers applied on the two opposite sides of the section. To do this,
first create a material model featuring the properties of the retrofitting material and then use an I-
section element with web height that equals that of the original element's section, a web thickness that
is approximately zero, flange width/thickness dimensions corresponding to the width/thickness of
the retrofitting layer, and connect this new retrofitting element to the same nodes to which the
existing element is connected to. Evidently, for those cases where the fibres are placed only on one
side (e.g. retrofitting of beams) a T-shaped section can be used.
NOTE: A C-shaped section can be obtained by defining zero-length bottom and top flange eccentricities.
An L-shaped section, on the other hand, can be obtained by assigning identical values to top flange
width and web thickness (together with bottom and top flange eccentricities equal to zero).
Double I type 1 section with top, bottom and web plates – di1tbwp
This is a section frequently adopted for the modelling of double I steel profiles with distance between
the flanges with top, bottom and web plates.
Appendix D 343
Double I type 2 section with top, bottom and web plates – di2tbwp
This is a section frequently adopted for the modelling of double I steel profiles without distance
between the flanges with top, bottom and web plates.
Built up box double channel section with top and bottom plates – bbdctbp
This is a section frequently adopted for the modelling of double C channel steel profiles with top and
bottom plates.
NOTE: Users may use a built up box formed by four angle sections to model the retrofitting of a RC
rectangular member with longitudinally-oriented steel or FRP layers applied on the two opposite
sides of the section. To do this, first create a material model featuring the properties of the retrofitting
material and then use a built up box formed by four angle sections element that equals that of the
original element's section, flange thickness dimensions corresponding to the thickness of the
retrofitting layer, and connect this new retrofitting element to the same nodes to which the existing
element is connected to.
NOTE 1: The confined concrete region is automatically computed by the program using the R/C cover
thickness defined in the section’s module (the default value is 2.5 cm).
NOTE 2: All rebars must be located within the confined concrete region.
NOTE: Re-bar distances d3 and d2 are to be measured from the bottom left corner of the section.
FRP Strengthening
FRP wrapping may be introduced by selecting the FRP Wrap from a list of the most common products
found in the market, or by introducing user defined values.
Appendix D 359
FRP Strengthening
FRP wrapping may be introduced by selecting the FRP Wrap from a list of the most common products
found in the market, or by introducing user defined values.
360 SeismoStruct User Manual
NOTE 2: From version 6 it is possible to define asymmetric flanges thicknesses (see above).
Appendix D 361
IMPORTANT: Users are warmly advised to read the work of Beyer et al. [2008] for further guidance on
this topic, especially when interested in using this cross-section to model L- or U-shaped walls.
362 SeismoStruct User Manual
IMPORTANT: Users are warmly advised to read the work of Beyer et al. [2008] for further guidance on
this topic.
loading, the use of this section should be avoided, and assemblage of properly connected rectangular
wall sections (rcrws, rcrs) is instead strongly advised.
IMPORTANT: Users are warmly advised to read the work of Beyer et al. [2008] for further guidance on
this topic.
NOTE: Re-bar distances d3 and d2 are to be measured from the bottom left corner of the section.
Appendix D 367
Reinforcement
Longitudinal reinforcement bars can be defined in two different ways:
1. By editing the reinforcement pattern;
2. By entering the respective area and sectional coordinates (the latter being defined in the local
coordinate system of the section).
Further, the transverse reinforcement may be specified, in terms of the stirrups' diameters and legs, as
well as the distance between them. Diamond stirrups may be also added.
FRP Strengthening
FRP wrapping may be introduced by selecting the FRP Wrap from a list of the most common products
found in the market, or by introducing user defined values.
Further, the transverse reinforcement may be specified, in terms of the stirrups' diameters and legs, as
well as the distance between them. Diamond stirrups may be also added.
FRP Strengthening
FRP wrapping may be introduced by selecting the FRP Wrap from a list of the most common products
found in the market, or by introducing user defined values.
FRP Strengthening
FRP wrapping may be introduced by selecting the FRP Wrap from a list of the most common products
found in the market, or by introducing user defined values.
Appendix D 377
NOTE: Re-bar distances d3 and d2 are to be measured from the bottom left corner of the section.
FRP Strengthening
FRP wrapping may be introduced by selecting the FRP Wrap from a list of the most common products
found in the market, or by introducing user defined values.
378 SeismoStruct User Manual
NOTE: Re-bar distances d3 and d2 are to be measured from the bottom left corner of the section.
FRP Strengthening
FRP wrapping may be introduced by selecting the FRP Wrap from a list of the most common products
found in the market, or by introducing user defined values.
Appendix D 379
NOTE: Re-bar distances d3 and d2 are to be measured from the bottom left corner of the section.
FRP Strengthening
FRP wrapping may be introduced by selecting the FRP Wrap from a list of the most common products
found in the market, or by introducing user defined values.
380 SeismoStruct User Manual
NOTE: Re-bar distances d3 and d2 are to be measured from the bottom left corner of the section.
FRP Strengthening
FRP wrapping may be introduced by selecting the FRP Wrap from a list of the most common products
found in the market, or by introducing user defined values.
Appendix D 381
COMPOSITE SECTIONS
Composite I-section - cpis
This is a section frequently adopted for the modelling of simply-supported composite beams.
NOTE: The reinforcement in the concrete slab is currently not modelled; hence the section will have a
reduced negative moment resistance capacity.
NOTE: A parabolic curve has been assumed to represent the boundary between fully and partially
confined concrete areas. Its depth may be conservatively estimated as 20% of the profile's flange
width. More rigorous estimation procedures, however, can be found in the work of Mirza [1989] or
Elnashai and Elghazouli [1993], amongst others.
2. By entering the respective area and sectional coordinates (the latter being defined in the local
coordinate system of the section).
MASONRY SECTIONS
Masonry wall section - mws
This is a section frequently adopted for the modelling of masonry members.
Rectangular Column
Rectangular columns may be inserted from the main menu (Insert > Rectangular Column) or through
the corresponding toolbar button . On the Properties Window that appears, users can adapt the
section’s dimensions either in the View/Modify Geometry window or by selecting one section from the
predefined standard sections (square or rectangular).
It is possible to define a column height different from the storey height, through the selection of the
Free length radio button and the assignment of different length. If, on the other hand, the Full length
radio button is selected then the member has the same height with the storey height. In addition, the
foundation level of the column may be adapted, thus providing the possibility to the user to define
different foundation levels.
Further, the longitudinal and transverse reinforcement may be defined by editing the relevant
reinforcement patterns.
Appendix E 393
Reinforcement Pattern
Adding single longitudinal reinforcement bars may also be carried out through the corresponding
Additional Rebars module, where additional reinforcement may be introduced graphically as shown in
the following figure:
On the Properties Window users may choose between the View Reinforcement, where the
reinforcement of the section is displayed (longitudinal and transverse), and the View/Modify
Geometry, where the section’s dimensions may be viewed and modified.
Reinforcement View
The material set properties can be defined from the main menu (Tools > Define Material Sets), through
the corresponding toolbar button, or through the Define Material Sets button within the member’s
Properties Window. The required values for the definition of the materials properties depend on the
type of the members, i.e. existing or new members. By default, there are two material schemes, one for
the existing elements and one for the new ones. The code-based settings of the structural member can
also be defined through the Advanced Member Properties dialog box that opens from the
corresponding button. The member’s modelling parameters may be defined from the Modelling
Parameters dialog box, accessed by the corresponding button. Further, FRP wraps may be assigned to
column elements through the FRP Wrapping module, where the users may select the FRP wrap from a
list of the most common products found in the market, or introduce user defined values.
The insertion point (point of the section that corresponds to the location of the mouse click), and
rotation of the section on plan view may be selected.
Selecting the insertion point and rotate the section’s plan view
Appendix E 395
After defining all the section's properties, the new member may be added with a simple click on the
Building Modeller Main Window.
L-Shaped Column
L-Shaped columns can be inserted from the main menu (Insert > L-Shaped Column) or through the
corresponding toolbar button . On the Properties Window that appears, users can adapt the
section’s dimensions either in the View/Modify Geometry window or by selecting one section from the
predefined standard sections (symmetric or asymmetric).
It is possible to define a column height different from the storey height, through the selection of the
Free length radio button and the assignment of different length. If, on the other hand, the Full length
radio button is selected then the member has the same height with the storey height. In addition, the
foundation level of the column may be adapted, thus providing the possibility to the user to define
different foundation levels.
Further, the longitudinal and transverse reinforcement may be defined by editing the relevant
reinforcement patterns.
396 SeismoStruct User Manual
Reinforcement Pattern
Adding single longitudinal reinforcement bars may also be carried out through the corresponding
Additional Rebars module, where additional reinforcement may be introduced graphically as shown in
the following figure:
On the Properties Window users may choose between the View Reinforcement, where the
reinforcement of the section is displayed (longitudinal and transverse), and the View/Modify
Geometry, where the section’s dimensions may be viewed and modified.
Reinforcement View
The material set properties can be defined from the main menu (Tools > Define Material Sets), through
the corresponding toolbar button, or through the Define Material Sets button within the member’s
Properties Window. The required values for the definition of the materials properties depend on the
type of the members, i.e. existing or new members. By default, there are two material schemes, one for
the existing elements and one for the new ones. The code-based settings of the structural member can
also be defined through the Advanced Member Properties dialog box that opens from the
corresponding button. The member’s modelling parameters may be defined from the Modelling
Parameters dialog box, accessed by the corresponding button. Further, FRP wraps may be assigned to
column elements through the FRP Wrapping module, where the users may select the FRP wrap from a
list of the most common products found in the market, or introduce user defined values.
The insertion point (point of the section that corresponds to the location of the mouse click), and
rotation of the section on plan view may be selected.
Selecting the insertion point and rotate the section’s plan view
398 SeismoStruct User Manual
After defining all the section's properties, the new member may be added with a simple click on the
Building Modeller Main Window.
T-Shaped Column
T-Shaped columns may be inserted from the main menu (Insert > T-Shaped Column) or through the
corresponding toolbar button . On the Properties Window that appears, users can adapt the
section’s dimensions either in the View/Modify Geometry window or by selecting one section from the
predefined standard sections (symmetric or asymmetric).
It is possible to define a column height different from the storey height, through the selection of the
Free length radio button and the assignment of different length. If, on the other hand, the Full length
radio button is selected then the member has the same height with the storey height. In addition, the
foundation level of the column may be adapted, thus providing the possibility to the user to define
different foundation levels.
Further, the longitudinal and transverse reinforcement may be defined by editing the relevant
reinforcement patterns.
Appendix E 399
Reinforcement Pattern
Adding single longitudinal reinforcement bars may also be carried out through the corresponding
Additional Rebars module, where additional reinforcement may be introduced graphically as shown in
the following figure:
400 SeismoStruct User Manual
On the Properties Window users may choose between the View Reinforcement, where the
reinforcement of the section is displayed (longitudinal and transverse), and the View/Modify
Geometry, where the section’s dimensions may be viewed and modified.
Reinforcement View
The material set properties can be defined from the main menu (Tools > Define Material Sets), through
the corresponding toolbar button, or through the Define Material Sets button within the member’s
Properties Window. The required values for the definition of the materials properties depend on the
type of the members, i.e. existing or new members. By default, there are two material schemes, one for
the existing elements and one for the new ones. The code-based settings of the structural member can
also be defined through the Advanced Member Properties dialog box that opens from the
corresponding button. The member’s modelling parameters may be defined from the Modelling
Appendix E 401
Parameters dialog box, accessed by the corresponding button. Further, FRP wraps may be assigned to
column elements through the FRP Wrapping module, where the users may select the FRP wrap from a
list of the most common products found in the market, or introduce user defined values.
The insertion point (point of the section that corresponds to the location of the mouse click), and
rotation of the section on plan view may be selected.
Selecting the insertion point and rotate the section’s plan view
After defining all the section's properties, the new member may be added with a simple click on the
Building Modeller Main Window.
Circular Column
Circular columns may be inserted from the main menu (Insert > Circular Column) or through the
corresponding toolbar button . On the Properties Window that appears, users can adapt the
section’s dimensions either in the View/Modify Geometry window or by selecting one section from the
predefined standard sections.
402 SeismoStruct User Manual
It is possible to define a column height different from the storey height, through the selection of the
Free length radio button and the assignment of different length. If, on the other hand, the Full length
radio button is selected then the member has the same height with the storey height. In addition, the
foundation level of the column may be adapted, thus providing the possibility to the user to define
different foundation levels.
Further, the longitudinal and transverse reinforcement may be defined by editing the relevant
reinforcement patterns.
Reinforcement Pattern
Adding single longitudinal reinforcement bars may also be carried out through the corresponding
Additional Rebars module, where additional reinforcement may be introduced graphically as shown in
the following figure:
Appendix E 403
On the Properties Window users may choose between the View Reinforcement, where the
reinforcement of the section is displayed (longitudinal and transverse), and the View/Modify
Geometry, where the section’s dimensions may be viewed and modified.
Reinforcement View
The material set properties can be defined from the main menu (Tools > Define Material Sets), through
the corresponding toolbar button, or through the Define Material Sets button within the member’s
Properties Window. The required values for the definition of the materials properties depend on the
type of the members, i.e. existing or new members. By default, there are two material schemes, one for
the existing elements and one for the new ones. The code-based settings of the structural member can
also be defined through the Advanced Member Properties dialog box that opens from the
corresponding button. The member’s modelling parameters may be defined from the Modelling
Parameters dialog box, accessed by the corresponding button. Further, FRP wraps may be assigned to
column elements through the FRP Wrapping module, where the users may select the FRP wrap from a
list of the most common products found in the market, or introduce user defined values.
404 SeismoStruct User Manual
The insertion point (point of the section that corresponds to the location of the mouse click), and
rotation of the section on plan view may be selected.
After defining all the section's properties, the new member may be added with a simple click on the
Building Modeller Main Window.
Wall
Walls may be added from the main menu (Insert > Wall) or the corresponding toolbar button . On
the Properties Window that appears, users can adapt the section’s width dimension in the
View/Modify Geometry window, whereas its length is graphically defined with its insertion by
specifying two points, start and end. Initially, the pseudo-columns width is automatically estimated as
one fifth (1/5) of the total wall’s length with a maximum value equal to 600 mm. After the insertion of
the wall, it can be modified from the wall's Properties Window.
It is possible to define a wall height different from the storey height, through the selection of the Free
length radio button and the assignment of different length. If, on the other hand, the Full length radio
button is selected then the member has the same height with the storey height. In addition, the
foundation level of the column may be adapted, thus providing the possibility to the user to define
different foundation levels.
Further, the longitudinal and transverse reinforcement may be defined by editing the relevant
reinforcement patterns.
Reinforcement Pattern
Adding single longitudinal reinforcement bars may also be carried out through the corresponding
Additional Rebars module, where additional reinforcement may be introduced graphically as shown in
the following figure:
NOTE: In order to add longitudinal reinforcement bars through the Additional Rebars module, users
should first insert the wall section in the model, so as to have completely defined the wall’s
dimensions, that is wall’s total length and pseudo-columns width.
406 SeismoStruct User Manual
On the Properties Window users may choose between the View Reinforcement, where the
reinforcement of the section is displayed (longitudinal and transverse), and the View/Modify
Geometry, where the section’s dimensions may be viewed and modified.
Reinforcement View
The material set properties can be defined from the main menu (Tools > Define Material Sets), through
the corresponding toolbar button, or through the Define Material Sets button within the member’s
Properties Window. The required values for the definition of the materials properties depend on the
type of the members, i.e. existing or new members. By default, there are two material schemes, one for
the existing elements and one for the new ones. The code-based settings of the structural member can
also be defined through the Advanced Member Properties dialog box that opens from the
corresponding button. The member’s modelling parameters may be defined from the Modelling
Parameters dialog box, accessed by the corresponding button. Further, FRP wraps may be assigned to
wall elements through the FRP Wrapping module, where the users may select the FRP wrap from a list
of the most common products found in the market, or introduce user defined values.
Contrary to the columns definition, where a simple click is adequate to define the member, in wall
sections two points should be outlined on the Building Modeller Window. The inserting line can lie at
the centre or at either of the two sides of the wall; this can be determined by clicking on any of the
three lines on the View/Modify Geometry window (the black line is the selected option).
Beam
Beams may be inserted from the main menu (Insert > Beam...) or through the corresponding toolbar
button . On the Properties Window that appears, users can adapt the section’s dimensions either in
the View/Modify Geometry window or by selecting one section from the predefined standard sections.
Appendix E 407
Inclined beams may be efficiently modelled by specifying the elevation differences of the two beam
ends relatively to the storey height. The height of the supporting columns is then automatically
adapted.
NOTE: In the case of beams being supported by the same column at different heights, the program
automatically subdivides the column member, so that to simulate effectively the short column that is
generated.
Inclined beam
408 SeismoStruct User Manual
Further, the longitudinal and transverse reinforcement may be assigned through the relevant
reinforcement patterns. Different reinforcement patterns may be defined at the middle and at the two
edges of the beam.
Reinforcement Pattern
Adding single longitudinal reinforcement bars may also be carried out through the corresponding
Additional Rebars modules, where additional reinforcement can be introduced graphically as shown in
the following figure:
In the beams sections module, additional permanent distributed load may also be assigned, which will
serve to define any load not associated to the self-weight of the structure (e.g. finishings, infills,
variable loading, etc).
On the Properties Window users may choose between the View Reinforcement, where the
reinforcement of the start, middle and end sections is displayed (longitudinal and transverse), and the
View/Modify Geometry, where the section’s dimensions may be viewed and modified.
The material set properties can be defined from the main menu (Tools > Define Material Sets), through
the corresponding toolbar button, or through the Define Material Sets button within the member’s
Properties Window. The required values for the definition of the materials properties depend on the
type of the members, i.e. existing or new members. By default, there are two material schemes, one for
the existing elements and one for the new ones. The code-based settings of the structural member can
also be defined through the Advanced Member Properties dialog box that opens from the
corresponding button. Further, the member’s modelling parameters may be defined from the
Modelling Parameters dialog box, accessed by the corresponding button.
In a similar fashion to the walls, for beam’s definition two points should be outlined on the Main
Window. The inserting line can lie at the centre or at either of the two sides of the beam; this can be
determined by clicking on any of the three lines on the View/Modify Geometry (the black line is the
selected option).
When an assigned beam intersects an existing column or wall, it is automatically subdivided and two
members are thus created. Consequently, several beams may be defined in a row with just two clicks.
After the definition of the slabs, two additional options may appear on the beams Properties Window:
(i) select whether to include or not the beam's effective width in the calculations and (ii) select
whether the beam is inverted or not. The effective width is automatically calculated by the program,
but it can also be modified by the user.
It is possible to define a column height different from the storey height, through the selection of the
Free length radio button and the assignment of different length. If, on the other hand, the Full length
radio button is selected then the member has the same height with the storey height. In addition, the
foundation level of the column may be adapted, thus providing the possibility to the user to define
different foundation levels.
Further, both external and internal longitudinal and transverse reinforcement may be defined by
editing the relevant reinforcement patterns. It is noted that the term ‘internal’ refers to the
old/existing part of the section, whether the ‘external’ refers to the new/added part of the section.
Reinforcement Pattern
Adding single longitudinal reinforcement bars may also be carried out through the corresponding
Additional Rebars module, where additional reinforcement may be introduced graphically to both the
existing and the new part of the section, as shown in the following figure:
412 SeismoStruct User Manual
On the Properties Window users may choose between the View Reinforcement, where the
reinforcement of the section is displayed (longitudinal and transverse), and the View/Modify
Geometry, where the section’s dimensions may be viewed and modified.
Reinforcement View
The material set properties can be defined from the main menu (Tools > Define Material Sets), through
the corresponding toolbar button, or through the Define Material Sets button within the member’s
Properties Window. The required values for the definition of the materials properties depend on the
type of the members, i.e. existing or new members. By default, there are two material schemes, one for
the existing elements and one for the new ones. The code-based settings of the structural member can
Appendix E 413
also be defined through the Advanced Member Properties dialog box that opens from the
corresponding button. The member’s modelling parameters may be defined from the Modelling
Parameters dialog box, accessed by the corresponding button. Further, FRP wraps may be assigned to
column elements through the FRP Wrapping module, where the users may select the FRP wrap from a
list of the most common products found in the market, or introduce user defined values.
NOTE: In the Advanced Member Properties module users should take decisions about the jacketed
section’s properties, selecting the parameters so as to account for the whole section, both existing and
new one.
The insertion point (point of the section that corresponds to the location of the mouse click), and
rotation of the section on plan view may be selected.
Selecting the insertion point and rotate the section’s plan view
After defining all the section's properties, the new member may be added with a simple click on the
Building Modeller Main Window.
adapt the section’s dimensions either in the View/Modify Geometry window or by selecting one
section from the predefined standard sections (symmetric or asymmetric).
It is possible to define a column height different from the storey height, through the selection of the
Free length radio button and the assignment of different length. If, on the other hand, the Full length
radio button is selected then the member has the same height with the storey height. In addition, the
foundation level of the column may be adapted, thus providing the possibility to the user to define
different foundation levels.
Further, both external and internal longitudinal and transverse reinforcement may be defined by
editing the relevant reinforcement patterns. It is noted that the term ‘internal’ refers to the
old/existing part of the section, whether the ‘external’ refers to the new/added part of the section.
Reinforcement Pattern
Appendix E 415
Adding single longitudinal reinforcement bars may also be carried out through the corresponding
Additional Rebars module, where additional reinforcement may be introduced graphically to both the
existing and the new part of the section, as shown in the following figure:
On the Properties Window users may choose between the View Reinforcement, where the
reinforcement of the section is displayed (longitudinal and transverse), and the View/Modify
Geometry, where the section’s dimensions may be viewed and modified.
Reinforcement View
The material set properties can be defined from the main menu (Tools > Define Material Sets), through
the corresponding toolbar button, or through the Define Material Sets button within the member’s
Properties Window. The required values for the definition of the materials properties depend on the
type of the members, i.e. existing or new members. By default, there are two material schemes, one for
416 SeismoStruct User Manual
the existing elements and one for the new ones. The code-based settings of the structural member can
also be defined through the Advanced Member Properties dialog box that opens from the
corresponding button. The member’s modelling parameters may be defined from the Modelling
Parameters dialog box, accessed by the corresponding button. Further, FRP wraps may be assigned to
column elements through the FRP Wrapping module, where the users may select the FRP wrap from a
list of the most common products found in the market, or introduce user defined values.
NOTE: In the Advanced Member Properties module users should take decisions about the jacketed
section’s properties, selecting the parameters so as to account for the whole section, both existing and
new one.
The insertion point (point of the section that corresponds to the location of the mouse click), and
rotation of the section on plan view may be selected.
Selecting the insertion point and rotate the section’s plan view
After defining all the section's properties, the new member may be added with a simple click on the
Building Modeller Main Window.
It is possible to define a column height different from the storey height, through the selection of the
Free length radio button and the assignment of different length. If, on the other hand, the Full length
radio button is selected then the member has the same height with the storey height. In addition, the
foundation level of the column may be adapted, thus providing the possibility to the user to define
different foundation levels.
Further, both external and internal longitudinal and transverse reinforcement may be defined by
editing the relevant reinforcement patterns. It is noted that the term ‘internal’ refers to the
old/existing part of the section, whether the ‘external’ refers to the new/added part of the section.
418 SeismoStruct User Manual
Reinforcement Pattern
Adding single longitudinal reinforcement bars may also be carried out through the corresponding
Additional Rebars module, where additional reinforcement may be introduced graphically to both the
existing and the new part of the section, as shown in the following figure:
On the Properties Window users may choose between the View Reinforcement, where the
reinforcement of the section is displayed (longitudinal and transverse), and the View/Modify
Geometry, where the section’s dimensions may be viewed and modified.
Reinforcement View
The material set properties can be defined from the main menu (Tools > Define Material Sets), through
the corresponding toolbar button, or through the Define Material Sets button within the member’s
Properties Window. The required values for the definition of the materials properties depend on the
type of the members, i.e. existing or new members. By default, there are two material schemes, one for
the existing elements and one for the new ones. The code-based settings of the structural member can
also be defined through the Advanced Member Properties dialog box that opens from the
corresponding button. The member’s modelling parameters may be defined from the Modelling
Parameters dialog box, accessed by the corresponding button. Further, FRP wraps may be assigned to
column elements through the FRP Wrapping module, where the users may select the FRP wrap from a
list of the most common products found in the market, or introduce user defined values.
NOTE: In the Advanced Member Properties module users should take decisions about the jacketed
section’s properties, selecting the parameters so as to account for the whole section, both existing and
new one.
The insertion point (point of the section that corresponds to the location of the mouse click), and
rotation of the section on plan view may be selected.
Selecting the insertion point and rotate the section’s plan view
420 SeismoStruct User Manual
After defining all the section's properties, the new member may be added with a simple click on the
Building Modeller Main Window.
It is possible to define a column height different from the storey height, through the selection of the
Free length radio button and the assignment of different length. If, on the other hand, the Full length
radio button is selected then the member has the same height with the storey height. In addition, the
foundation level of the column may be adapted, thus providing the possibility to the user to define
different foundation levels.
Further, both external and internal longitudinal and transverse reinforcement may be defined by
editing the relevant reinforcement patterns. It is noted that the term ‘internal’ refers to the
old/existing part of the section, whether the ‘external’ refers to the new/added part of the section.
Appendix E 421
Reinforcement Pattern
Adding single longitudinal reinforcement bars may also be carried out through the corresponding
Additional Rebars module, where additional reinforcement may be introduced graphically to both the
existing and the new part of the section, as shown in the following figure:
On the Properties Window users may choose between the View Reinforcement, where the
reinforcement of the section is displayed (longitudinal and transverse), and the View/Modify
Geometry, where the section’s dimensions may be viewed and modified.
422 SeismoStruct User Manual
Reinforcement View
The material set properties can be defined from the main menu (Tools > Define Material Sets), through
the corresponding toolbar button, or through the Define Material Sets button within the member’s
Properties Window. The required values for the definition of the materials properties depend on the
type of the members, i.e. existing or new members. By default, there are two material schemes, one for
the existing elements and one for the new ones. The code-based settings of the structural member can
also be defined through the Advanced Member Properties dialog box that opens from the
corresponding button. The member’s modelling parameters may be defined from the Modelling
Parameters dialog box, accessed by the corresponding button. Further, FRP wraps may be assigned to
column elements through the FRP Wrapping module, where the users may select the FRP wrap from a
list of the most common products found in the market, or introduce user defined values.
NOTE: In the Advanced Member Properties module users should take decisions about the jacketed
section’s properties, selecting the parameters so as to account for the whole section, both existing and
new one.
The insertion point (point of the section that corresponds to the location of the mouse click), and
rotation of the section on plan view may be selected.
After defining all the section's properties, the new member may be added with a simple click on the
Building Modeller Main Window.
Appendix E 423
Jacketed Beam
Jacketed beams may be inserted from the main menu (Insert > Jacketed Beam) or through the
corresponding toolbar button . On the Properties Window that appears, users can adapt the
section’s dimensions either in the View/Modify Geometry window or by selecting one section from the
predefined standard sections.
Inclined jacketed beams may be efficiently modelled by specifying the elevation difference of the two
beam ends relatively to the storey height. The height of the supporting columns is then automatically
adapted.
NOTE: In the case of beams being supported by the same column at different heights, the program
automatically subdivides the column member, so that to simulate effectively the short column that is
generated.
424 SeismoStruct User Manual
Further, both external and internal longitudinal and transverse reinforcement may be defined by
editing the relevant reinforcement patterns. Different reinforcement patterns may be defined at the
middle and at the two edges of the beam. It is noted that the term ‘internal’ refers to the old/existing
part of the section, whether the ‘external’ refers to the new/added part of the section.
Reinforcement Pattern
Appendix E 425
Adding single longitudinal reinforcement bars may also be carried out through the corresponding
Additional Rebars module, where additional reinforcement may be introduced graphically to both the
existing and the new part of the section, as shown in the following figure:
In the jacketed beams sections module, additional permanent distributed load may also be assigned,
which will serve to define any load not associated to the self-weight of the structure (e.g. finishings,
infills, variable loading, etc).
On the Properties Window users may choose between the View Reinforcement, where the
reinforcement of the start, middle and end sections is displayed (longitudinal and transverse), and the
View/Modify Geometry, where the section’s dimensions may be viewed and modified.
Reinforcement View
426 SeismoStruct User Manual
The material set properties can be defined from the main menu (Tools > Define Material Sets), through
the corresponding toolbar button, or through the Define Material Sets button within the member’s
Properties Window. The required values for the definition of the materials properties depend on the
type of the members, i.e. existing or new members. By default, there are two material schemes, one for
the existing elements and one for the new ones. The code-based settings of the structural member can
also be defined through the Advanced Member Properties dialog box that opens from the
corresponding button. Further, the member’s modelling parameters may be defined from the
Modelling Parameters dialog box, accessed by the corresponding button.
NOTE: In the Advanced Member Properties module users should take decisions about the jacketed
section’s properties, selecting the parameters so as to account for the whole section, both existing and
new one.
In a similar fashion to the walls, for jacketed beam’s definition two points should be outlined on the
Main Window. The inserting line can lie at the centre or at either of the two sides of the beam; this can
be determined by clicking on any of the three lines on the View/Modify Geometry (the black line is the
selected option).
When an assigned jacketed beam intersects an existing column or wall, it is automatically subdivided
and two members are thus created. Consequently, several jacketed beams may be defined in a row
with just two clicks.
After the definition of slabs, two additional options may appear on the jacketed beams Properties
Window: (i) select whether to include or not the beam's effective width in the calculations and (ii)
select whether the beam is inverted or not. The effective width is automatically calculated by the
program, but it can also be modified by the user.
Appendix E 427
The ideal number of section fibres, sufficient to guarantee an adequate reproduction of the stress-
strain distribution across the element's cross-section, varies with the shape and material
characteristics of the latter, depending also on the degree of inelasticity to which the element will be
forced to. As a crude rule of thumb, users may consider that single-material sections will usually be
adequately represented by 100 fibres, whilst more complicated sections, subjected to high levels of
inelasticity, will normally call for the employment of 200 fibres or more. However, and clearly, only a
sensitivity study carried out by the user on a case-by-case basis can unequivocally establish the
optimum number of section fibres.
Appendix F 429
In the Section Discretization Pattern dialog box the software provides the desired and the actual (after
the section discretisation has been performed, employing triangulation procedures) number of
monitoring points. By clicking on the Refresh button it is possible to update the view of the section
discretisation.
Section triangulation
In addition, the number of integration sections needs to be defined. A number between 4 and 7
integration sections will typically be adopted, though users are warmly invited to search the
bibliography [e.g. Papadrakakis 2008; Calabrese et al. 2010] for further guidance on this matter (it is
recalled that the location of such integration sections across the element's length are indicated in
Material Inelasticity). In particular it is noted that up to 7 integration sections may be needed to
accurately model hardening response, but, on the other hand, 4 or 5 integration sections may be
advisable when it is foreseen that the elements will reach their softening response range.
NOTE: Instead of discretizing the elements to represent the changes in reinforcement details (see
above), it is possible to use one single infrmFB element per member and then define multiple sections.
It is noted that these sections may differ only in the reinforcement (i.e. section type, dimensions and
materials have to be the same).
430 SeismoStruct User Manual
Multiple sections
In this element's dialog box it is also possible to define an element-specific damping, as opposed to the
global damping defined in General > Project Settings > Damping. To do so, users need simply to press
the Damping button and then select the type of damping that better suits the element in question
(users should refer to the Damping menu for a discussion on the different types of damping available
and hints on which might the better options).
IMPORTANT: Damping defined at element level takes precedence over global damping, that is, the
"globally-computed" damping matrix coefficients that are associated to the degrees-of-freedom of a
given element will be replaced by coefficients that will have been calculated through the
multiplication of the mass matrix of the element by a mass-proportional parameter, or through the
multiplication of the element stiffness matrix by a stiffness-proportional parameter, or through the
calculation of an element damping Rayleigh matrix.
NOTE: If Rayleigh damping is defined at element level, using varied coefficients from one element to
the other, or with respect to those employed in the global damping settings, then non-classical
Rayleigh damping is being modelled, since Rayleigh damping requires uniform damping definition.
Local axes and output notation are defined in the figure below. Refer to the discussion on global and
local frame axes in Appendix A for a detailed description on the determination of the orientation of the
local element axis system.
Similarly to infrmFB, changes in reinforcement details can be achieved with the use of a single
infrmFBPH element per member, when multiple sections have been defined. It is noted that these
sections may differ only in the reinforcement (i.e. section type, dimensions and materials have to be
the same).
In this element's dialog box it is also possible to define an element-specific damping, as opposed to the
global damping defined in General > Project Settings > Damping. To do so, users need simply to press
the Damping button and then select the type of damping that better suits the element in question
(users should refer to the Damping menu for a discussion on the different types of damping available
and hints on which might the better options).
Appendix F 433
IMPORTANT: Damping defined at element level takes precedence over global damping, that is, the
"globally-computed" damping matrix coefficients that are associated to the degrees-of-freedom of a
given element will be replaced by coefficients that will have been calculated through the
multiplication of the mass matrix of the element by a mass-proportional parameter, or through the
multiplication of the element stiffness matrix by a stiffness-proportional parameter, or through the
calculation of an element damping Rayleigh matrix.
NOTE: If Rayleigh damping is defined at element level, using varied coefficients from one element to
the other, or with respect to those employed in the global damping settings, then non-classical
Rayleigh damping is being modelled, since Rayleigh damping requires uniform damping definition.
Local axes and output notation are the same as the infrmFB elements.
The force-displacements relationships of the four nonlinear rotational springs at the element's ends
feature a hysteretic curve that is based on SeismoStruct’s built-in MIMK_bilin nonlinear curve
(Modified Ibarra-Medina-Krawinkler deterioration curve with bilinear hysteretic rules). The yield and
ultimate bending moment (My and Mu respectively), as well as the deformation at yield d y are
calculated from a moment-curvature section analysis after the application of the initial loads on the
structure, taking into account the axial load imposed on the element. Instead, the plastic rotation
capacity a and the rotation at ultimate b are estimated directly from ASCE 41-17, and in particular
434 SeismoStruct User Manual
from Tables 10-7 (for beams), 10-8 & 10-9 (for columns) and 10-19 (for walls); see also ASCE 41-17,
Figure 10-1 and the figure below for more details.
moment
Mu
My
rotation
Apart from the automatic calculation of the plastic hinge properties, SeismoStruct also allows the input
of a, b and c values (c being the ratio of the residual to the ultimate strength) that are different from the
Appendix F 435
calculated ones. This can be achieved, if in the Definition of Modelling Parameters drop-down menu
the User-defined option is selected. Users are than allowed to freely introduce the plastic hinge
modelling parameters. Note however that even in the case of user defined parameters a section should
be specified, mainly for display purposes (e.g. to show the member in the 3D plot).
Definition of a new infrmDBPH element with user defined plastic hinge parameters
Finally, by clicking the Calculate Hinge Properties button a new dialog box appears that provides
assistance in the determination of these parameters, based on several parameters such as the ratio of
the area of the distributed longitudinal reinforcement to the gross concrete area l, the ratio of the area
of the distributed transverse reinforcement to the gross concrete area t, the gross section area Ag, the
expected yield strength of the longitudinal and transverse reinforcing steel fylE & fytE, the expected
compressive strength of concrete f’cE, the member axial force Nud, whether the member’s shear
reinforcement is conforming or not, whether the member is controlled by flexure or shear etc.
It is also possible to define an element-specific damping, as opposed to the global damping defined in
General > Project Settings > Damping, as described in the sections on infrmFB and infrmFBPH. Finally,
local axes and output notation are the same with the force-based elements.
of deformations. Typically, 4 to 6 elements per structural member need to be defined, hence users
need to post-process nodal displacements/rotation in order to estimate the members chord-rotations
[e.g. Mpampatsikos et al. 2008].
Similarly to the force-based elements, the number of section fibres used in equilibrium computations
carried out at each of the element's integration sections needs to be defined. Users can click the View
Discretization button in order to visualise the section triangulation (see figure below).
Similarly to infrmFB and infrmFBPH, multiple sections can be employed to define changes in
reinforcement details between the two integration sections. Further, the element-specific damping can
also be defined by the Damping dialog box (users should refer to the Damping menu for a discussion
on the different types of damping available and hints on which might the better options).
Local axes and output notation are defined as with the other frame element types.
The stiffness matrix of the elfrm element, as defined in the local chord system, is:
4𝐸𝐼2 0 2𝐸𝐼2 0 0 0
0 4𝐸𝐼3 0 2𝐸𝐼3 0 0
1 2𝐸𝐼2 0 4𝐸𝐼2 0 0 0
𝐿 0 2𝐸𝐼3 0 4𝐸𝐼3 0 0
0 0 0 0 𝐸𝐴 0
0 0 0 0 0 𝐺𝐽
In this element's dialog box it is also possible to define an element-specific damping, as opposed to the
global damping defined in General > Project Settings > Damping. To do so, users need simply to press
the Damping button and then select the type of damping that better suits the element in question
(users should refer to the Damping menu for a discussion on the different types of damping available
and hints on which might the better options).
IMPORTANT: Damping defined at element level takes precedence over global damping, that is, the
"globally-computed" damping matrix coefficients that are associated to the degrees-of-freedom of a
given element will be replaced by coefficients that will have been calculated through the
multiplication of the mass matrix of the element by a mass-proportional parameter, or through the
multiplication of the element stiffness matrix by a stiffness-proportional parameter, or through the
calculation of an element damping Rayleigh matrix.
NOTE 1: In the elfrm element, P-delta effects as well as large displacement/rotation effects are duly
taken into account.
438 SeismoStruct User Manual
NOTE 2: If Rayleigh damping is defined at element level, using varied coefficients from one element to
the other, or with respect to those employed in the global damping settings, then non-classical
Rayleigh damping is being modelled, since Rayleigh damping requires uniform damping definition.
Local axes and output notation are the same as infrmDB and infrmFB elements.
In this element's dialog box it is also possible to define an element-specific damping, as opposed to the
global damping defined in General > Project Settings > Damping. To do so, users need simply to press
the Damping button and then select the type of damping that better suits the element in question
(users should refer to the Damping menu for a discussion on the different types of damping available
and hints on which might the better options).
IMPORTANT: Damping defined at element level takes precedence over global damping, that is, the
"globally-computed" damping matrix coefficients that are associated to the degrees-of-freedom of a
given element will be replaced by coefficients that will have been calculated through the
multiplication of the mass matrix of the element by a mass-proportional parameter, or through the
multiplication of the element stiffness matrix by a stiffness-proportional parameter, or through the
calculation of an element damping Rayleigh matrix.
NOTE 1: Given that no flexure will be present in the element, a much-reduced number of fibres, with
respect to the case of infrm elements, needs to be employed in order to warrant accurate results.
Appendix F 439
NOTE 2: Modelling a rigid floor diaphragm using pinned crossed struts may give rise to unrealistically
high axial forces in floor beams. In order to avoid this, one may think of introducing a coincident elfrm
element featuring infinite axial stiffness and connected to link elements that would only transmit axial
load. In this way, the very rigid element would absorb the axial load, whilst the rotations (hence
moments) would be transmitted to the original beam elements.
NOTE 3: If Rayleigh damping is defined at element level, using varied coefficients from one element to
the other, or with respect to those employed in the global damping settings, then non-classical
Rayleigh damping is being modelled, since Rayleigh damping requires uniform damping definition.
Local axes and output notation are defined in the figure below:
NOTE: Although the inelastic infill panel elements have been created for the modelling of the
nonlinear response of infill panels in framed structures (as stated above), they might also be
employed for the modelling of slabs with a specific stiffness contribution and inelastic behaviour
pattern, e.g. by strategically placing these elements and/or inelastic truss elements with properties set
to mimic the desired behaviour (as suggested in the Seismosoft Forum).
In order to fully characterise this type of element, the following needs to be defined:
Strut Curve Parameters
Employed in the definition of the masonry strut hysteresis model, which is modelled with the inf_strut
response curve.
Curve Properties Typical values Default values
Initial Young modulus – Em 400fm - 1000 fm (kPa) 1600000 (kPa)
Compressive strength – fm (see Help System) 1000 (kPa)
Tensile strength – ft - 0 (kPa)
Strain at maximum stress – m 0.001 - 0.005 (m/m) 0.0012 (m/m)
Ultimate strain – u - 0.024 (m/m)
Closing strain – cl 0 - 0.003 (m/m) 0.004 (m/m)
Strut area reduction strain – 1 0.0003 - 0.0008 (m/m) 0.0006 (m/m)
Residual strut area strain – 2 0.0006 - 0.016 (m/m) 0.001 (m/m)
Starting unload. stiffness factor – un 1.5 - 2.5 (-) 1.5 (-)
NOTE: Acceleration-triggered de-activation has not been introduced, because it could result very
sensitive to high frequency and/or spurious acceleration modes. However, a workaround is
nonetheless suggested in note 5, below.
4 𝐸𝑚 𝑡𝑤 sin(2𝜗)
𝜆=
4𝐸𝑐 𝐼𝑐 𝑤
442 SeismoStruct User Manual
IMPORTANT: Damping defined at element level takes precedence over global damping, that is, the
"globally-computed" damping matrix coefficients that are associated to the degrees-of-freedom of a
given element will be replaced by coefficients that will have been calculated through the
multiplication of the mass matrix of the element by a mass-proportional parameter, or through the
multiplication of the element stiffness matrix by a stiffness-proportional parameter, or through the
calculation of an element damping Rayleigh matrix.
NOTE 1: This model (with its struts configuration) is capable of describing only the commonest of
modes of failure, since a model that would account for all types of masonry failure would not be
practical due to the appreciable level of complexity and uncertainty involved. Users are strongly
advised to consult the publications of Crisafulli et al. [2000] and Smyrou et al. [2006] for further
details on this model.
NOTE 2: Strength and stiffness of the infills are introduced after the application of the initial loads, so
that the former do not resist to gravity loads (which are normally absorbed by the surrounding frame,
erected first). If users wish their infills to resist gravity loads, then they should define the latter as non-
initial loads.
NOTE 3: In very refined models, users may wish to introduce link elements between the frame and
infill panel nodes, in order to taken into account the fact that the infills are commonly not rigidly
connected to the surrounding frames.
NOTE 4: Users may also want to check for values of out-of-plane acceleration exceeding a certain
threshold limit that may be inducing out-of-plane failure of the panel.
NOTE 5: The presence of openings in infill panels constitutes an important uncertainty in the
evaluation of the behaviour of infilled frames. Several researchers [e.g. Benjamin and Williams, 1958;
Fiorato et al., 1970; Mallick and Garg, 1971; Liauw and Lee, 1977; Utku, 1980; Dawe and Young, 1985;
Thiruvengadam, 1985; Giannakas et al., 1987; Papia, 1988; Dawe and Seah, 1989; Hamburger, 1993;
Bertoldi et al., 1994; CEB, 1996; Mosalam et al., 1997; Gostic and Zarnic, 1999; De Sortis et al., 1999;
Asteris, 2003] have investigated the influence that different configurations of openings (in terms of
size and location) might have on strength and stiffness. Unfortunately, though somewhat
understandably given the large number of variables and uncertainties involved, agreement on this
topic has not yet been reached; the above-listed publications have all lead to diverse quantitative
conclusions and recommendations. Users will therefore need to resort to their own engineering
judgement and experience, coupled with a thorough consultation of the literature on this topic (a
small percentage of it has been listed above), in order to decide on how the presence of openings in the
structure being studied should be taken into account. As an expedite recommendation, we might
perhaps suggest that the effect of openings on the response of an infilled frame can be pragmatically
taken into account by reducing the value of the Strut Area (A1), and hence of the panel's stiffness, in
proportion to the area of the opening with respect to the panel. That is, as shown by Smyrou et al.
[2006], if a given infill panel features openings of 15% to 30% with respect to the area of the panel,
good response predictions might be obtained by reducing the value of A1 (i.e. its stiffness) by a value
that varies between 30% and 50%. As far as the strength of the infill panel is concerned, and given the
extremely varied nature of the observations made on this issue by past researchers, we would perhaps
suggest that, in the absence of good evidence otherwise, users should not change its value to take into
account the presence of standard openings (i.e. openings that are not larger than 30% of the area of
the infill panel).
NOTE 6: Users are also warmly advised to read the publication of Celarec and Dolšek [2012] in which
the effects of masonry infills on the shear demand and failure of columns, for the case when reinforced
concrete frames with such infills are modelled by means of simplified nonlinear models that are not
capable of the direct simulation of these effects, have been investigated.
444 SeismoStruct User Manual
- In ASCE 41-17 and for unreinforced masonry URM walls, the lower value of the bed-joint
sliding strength and the diagonal tension strength is used, according to the following
expressions:
Q CE = Vbjs 1 = vme A n (11-9) ASCE 41-17
fα
′
Q CL = Vdt = fdt An β 1 + (11-12) ASCE 41-17
f ′dt
- In ASCE 41-17 and for unreinforced masonry URM spandrels, the lower value of the bed-joint
strength and the diagonal tension strength is used, according to the following expressions:
2
Vs1 = cbj + μf psp hsp bsp (11-17) ASCE 41-17
3
f ′dt p sp
Vs2 = 2 1+ hsp bsp (11-18) ASCE 41-17
2.3 1+
l sp f ′dt f dt
2h sp
- In ASCE 41-17 and for masonry walls or spandrels with reinforcement, the following
expression is employed:
Vn = Vnm + Vns γg (Equation 9-21) TMS 402
- In NTC-18 and for unreinforced masonry URM, different expressions are used for the different
material types: (i) in masonry with blocks the Mohr-Coulomb criterion is employed, (ii) in
masonry with bricks or regular stones, the strength assumes the lower value of the Turnšek-
Appendix F 445
Čačovič and the Mann-Müller criteria and (iii) for masonry with irregular stones the Turnšek-
Čačovič expression is employed.
Mohr-Coulomb (§7.8.2.2.2 NTC-18 and §6.2 EC6): Vt = fvd l′t
Turnšek-Čačovič (§C8.7.1.3.1.1 Commentary of NTC-18):
1.5τ0d lt ς0 ftd lt ς0
Vt = 1+ = 1+
b 1.5τ0d b ftd
lt f v 0d μ
Mann-Müller (§C8.7.1.3.1.1 Commentary of NTC2018): Vt = + ς0 ≤ Vt,lim
b 1+μϕ 1+μϕ
- In NTC-18 and for reinforced masonry RM, the shear capacity is calculated according to
§7.8.3.2.2 NTC-18:
Vt = Vt,M + Vt,S (7.8.7) NTC-18
where:
Vt,M = d ∙ t ∙ fvd (7.8.8) NTC-18
and
Vt,S = 0,6 ∙ d ∙ A sw ∙ fyd s (7.8.9) NTC-18
Note that in for the checks according to KANEPE the expressions of EC8 are employed. Similarly, with
TBDY the ASCE 41 equations are used. For a complete description of the employed expressions in each
Standard, users may refer to the Appendices H1 to H6.
Two special masonry material models may be used with the masonry element type, mas_par and
mas_tl. The former is based on the con_ma concrete material model, whilst the latter is a simpler multi-
linear model with degradation and residual strength. Both models feature parameters, such as the
compressive, the shear and the tensile strength, which are employed in the determination of the
member shear strength. Similarly, there are two masonry specific section types in SeismoStruct, one
for walls mws, and one for spandrels mss. Both unreinforced URM and reinforced RM masonry
members can be effectively be modelled with the proposed features.
NOTE: The masonry element type can only be used with the mas_par and the mas_tl material models.
Similarly, only the special masonry section types mws and mss can be employed. The reason for this, is
that these can store parameters that are used for the automatic calculation of the member shear
strength.
Users may choose whether to calculate the masonry shear strength (i) only at the initial step, (ii) at all
the steps until yielding in shear or (iii) at every step, i.e. even after reaching the peak member capacity.
The default option is the second, that is to update the shear strength until yield, which is the best
combination of accuracy and stability, since updating the shear strength in the descending branch of
the capacity curve may lead to convergence difficulties without significantly improving the accuracy of
the solution.
446 SeismoStruct User Manual
The parameters required for the full definition of the element properties are the following (see figure
above):
- The number of section fibres used in equilibrium computations carried out at each of the
integration sections of the internal sub-element.
- The elastic stiffness reduction is the reduction of the elastic uncracked stiffness of the shear
force-deformation curve that is employed in the calculations
- The total shear deformation capacity, which is the ultimate deformation capacity of the
member dtot=dyield+dplastic. It is noted that the deformation at yield dyield is directly calculated by
the program from the elastic shear stiffness and the yield strength.
- The post-capping shear deformation capacity: this is the deformation level, at which the
extrapolation of the descending branch of the shear force-deformation curve reaches the zero
axis.
- The ultimate shear deformation capacity: this is the deformation level, after which there is no
residual strength
- The residual shear strength ratio is the ratio between the maximum strength (at the total
deformation capacity level) and the residual strength
- The shear deformation hardening ratio is the ratio between the elastic and the plastic
branches of the shear force-deformation curve
- The cyclic deterioration parameters for the shear strength and stiffness are the following
three parameters: (i) the cyclic deterioration parameter for strength deterioration and
accelerated reloading deterioration – Λs, Λα, (ii) the cyclic deterioration parameter for
unloading stiffness deterioration – ΛK, and (iii) the cyclic deterioration parameter for post-
capping strength deterioration– Λc. For all parameters, the smaller the factor, the larger the
imposed deterioration on the curve, however note that a zero value leads to no deterioration.
For a complete description of the parameters refer to the documentation of the MIMK_bilin
curve
- Ratio between force at start of reloading to the force corresponding to the maximum
experienced deformation for positive and negative loading directions.
Appendix F 447
force Fy
ko
displacement
deformation capacity
total
deformation capacity
deformation capacity
post-capping
ultimate
Shear force-deformation curve employed in the masonry model
Regarding the section fibres, the ideal number, sufficient to guarantee an adequate reproduction of the
stress-strain distribution across the element's cross-section, varies with the shape and material
characteristics of the latter, and the degree of inelasticity to which the element will be forced to. As a
crude rule of thumb, users may consider that usually 100 fibres should be adequate.
In the Section Discretization Pattern dialog box the software provides the desired and the actual (after
the section discretization has been performed, employing triangulation procedures) number of
monitoring points that will be employed in the analysis. By clicking on the Refresh button it is possible
to update the view of the section discretization.
Similarly to the inelastic frame element types, instead of discretizing the elements to represent the
changes in reinforcement details, it is possible to use one single element per member and then define
448 SeismoStruct User Manual
multiple sections within it. It is noted that these sections may differ only in the reinforcement (i.e.
section type, dimensions and materials have to be the same).
Multiple sections
In this element's dialog box it is also possible to define an element-specific damping, as opposed to the
global damping defined in General > Project Settings > Damping. To do so, users need simply to press
the Damping button and then select the type of damping that better suits the element in question
(users should refer to the Damping menu for a discussion on the different types of damping available
and hints on which might the better options).
IMPORTANT: Damping defined at element level takes precedence over global damping, that is, the
"globally-computed" damping matrix coefficients that are associated to the degrees-of-freedom of a
given element will be replaced by coefficients that will have been calculated through the
multiplication of the mass matrix of the element by a mass-proportional parameter, or through the
multiplication of the element stiffness matrix by a stiffness-proportional parameter, or through the
calculation of an element damping Rayleigh matrix.
NOTE: If Rayleigh damping is defined at element level, using varied coefficients from one element to
the other, or with respect to those employed in the global damping settings, then non-classical
Rayleigh damping is being modelled, since Rayleigh damping requires uniform damping definition.
Local axes and output notation are defined in the figure below. Refer to the discussion on global and
local frame axes in Appendix A for a detailed description on the determination of the orientation of the
local element axis system.
The section geometry can be defined in a dialog box. Any thin-walled open section configuration can be
modelled, and different thicknesses may be assigned at the different parts of the section. After the user
defines the coordinates of the corner points of the section, and clicks on the Create Section button, the
section is shown on the screen and the elastic section properties, the Wagner coefficients and the
position of the shear centre are automatically calculated.
In this element's dialog box it is also possible to define an element-specific damping, as opposed to the
global damping defined in General > Project Settings > Damping. To do so, users need simply to press
the Damping button and then select the type of damping that better suits the element in question
(users should refer to the Damping menu for a discussion on the different types of damping available
and hints on which might the better options).
Appendix F 451
IMPORTANT: Damping defined at element level takes precedence over global damping, that is, the
"globally-computed" damping matrix coefficients that are associated to the degrees-of-freedom of a
given element will be replaced by coefficients that will have been calculated through the
multiplication of the mass matrix of the element by a mass-proportional parameter, or through the
multiplication of the element stiffness matrix by a stiffness-proportional parameter, or through the
calculation of an element damping Rayleigh matrix.
NOTE: If Rayleigh damping is defined at element level, using varied coefficients from one element to
the other, or with respect to those employed in the global damping settings, then non-classical
Rayleigh damping is being modelled, classing Rayleigh damping requires uniform damping definition.
Local axes and output notation are defined in the figure below. Refer to the discussion on global and
local frame axes in Appendix A for a detailed description of the determination of the orientation of the
local element axis system.
IMPORTANT: Damping defined at element level takes precedence over global damping, that is, the
"globally-computed" damping matrix coefficients that are associated to the degrees-of-freedom of a
given element will be replaced by coefficients that will have been calculated through the
multiplication of the mass matrix of the element by a mass-proportional parameter, or through the
multiplication of the element stiffness matrix by a stiffness-proportional parameter, or through the
calculation of an element damping Rayleigh matrix.
The element-specific damping facility is typically used here to model radiation damping in soil-
structure interaction springs (featuring varied force-displacement rules, such as ssi_py or any other
response curve), thus avoiding the need for introducing parallel dashpot elements.
NOTE 1: Only the response curves that have been previously activated in the Constitutive Model tab
window (Tools > Project Settings > Constitutive Model) can be selected from the drop-down menu and
associated to a link element
NOTE 2: When a link element is introduced between two initially coincident nodes, a force-
displacement relationship must compulsorily be defined for all six degrees-of-freedom, including
those for which the response of the two nodes is identical. The latter are usually modelled by the
adoption of linear response curves with very large stiffness values, so as to guarantee no relative
displacement between the two nodes in that particular degree-of-freedom. The very large value to be
adopted in such cases depends very much on the type of the analysis being carried out and on the
order of magnitude of results being obtained. Too low a value will not reproduce infinitely stiff
connection conditions, whilst a value that is too large may lead too numerical difficulties, especially
when a force-based convergence criterion is adopted. Usually, and as a rule of thumb, users should
consider a stiffness value that is 100 to 250 times larger than that of adjacent elements, noting
however that only a sensitivity study will permit the determination of the optimum value.
454 SeismoStruct User Manual
NOTE 3: On some analyses, the adoption of K0 = 0 to model pinned joint conditions may lead to
difficulties in getting the analysis to converge. This usually can be easily solved by the adoption of a
non-zero but still small value of stiffness (e.g. 0.001). Should the user wish to optimise the model (i.e.
find the smallest possible stiffness value that will not give rise to accentuated numerical difficulties),
then a sensitivity study ran on a case-by-case basis is highly recommended.
NOTE 4: If Rayleigh damping is defined at element level, using varied coefficients from one element to
the other, or with respect to those employed in the global damping settings, then non-classical
Rayleigh damping is being modelled, since classic Rayleigh damping requires uniform damping
definition.
NOTE 5: Damping is here typically coupled with link elements for the introduction of Soil-Structure
Interaction springs adequate for dynamic analysis (see also ssi_py response curve).
Local axes and output notation are defined in the figure below:
An uplift model is adopted which is based on a nonlinear elastic-uplift response which also considers
some degradation of the contact at the soil/footing interface due to irrecoverable changes in its
geometry. A bounding surface plasticity model is also used which correctly takes into account the
simultaneous elastic-uplift and plastic nonlinear responses. Finally, this macro-element formulation is
fully applicable to three-dimensional loading cases. Figure 2 schematically represents the type of
phenomena intended to be modelled with the macro-element.
Figure 2. Schematic footing response in 3D case, accounting for uplift, inelasticity and contact degradation
The footing macro-element model represents the dynamic behaviour of isolated rigid footings,
subjected to three-dimensional inertial loading, from the initial stages of loading up until reaching
failure. The macro-element is based on the three major features of the response of footings, namely:
i) Initial elastic response,
ii) Uplift in rocking response,
iii) Failure loading conditions.
The bounding surface plasticity model is used to represent a continuous transition between the initial
elastic response and the plastic flow at failure, for monotonic, cyclic and dynamic loading conditions.
The uplift phenomenon is represented by a nonlinear elastic model which, however, takes into account
and is influenced by the plastic deformation state in the underlying soil.
456 SeismoStruct User Manual
The bounding surface adopted in this macro-element depends on the type of soil and its drainage
conditions during a seismic event. Therefore, different 3D failure surfaces are considered for drained
and undrained conditions. The ultimate surface adopted to describe the drained behaviour
corresponds to the “rugby-ball” shape, while for undrained loading the ultimate surface corresponds to
the so-called "scallop" shape, which is represented in Figure 3 in terms of its intersection in the H-N
and M-N planes of loading. The "rugby-ball" shape corresponds to have the ultimate surface
represented by the continuous line in both planes of loading.
1.2
1
M/Mmax or H/Hmax
0.8
H
0.6
M
0.4
0.2
0
0 0.1 0.2 0.3 0.4 0.5 0.6 0.7 0.8 0.9 1
N/Nmax
The macro-element model requires the definition of 25 input parameters, from which only 3 need to
be calibrated. The model parameters along with their definition and suggested values are given in
Table 1. They correspond to:
The six foundation initial stiffness components, indicated as KN1, KH2, KH3, KM2, KM3, KM2, KTT for
vertical, horizontal and rotational directions, respectively, can be evaluated by using formulas from
literature (e.g. Gazetas, 1991), or calibrated based on test results. The same applies to the
corresponding six equivalent dashpot coefficients for radiation damping representation.
-the maximum centred vertical load capacity Nmax that corresponds to the ultimate static bearing
capacity of the foundation and can be evaluated by standard superposition formulas (e.g. Brinch-
Hansen,1970);
Appendix F 457
- the maximum base shear capacities Hmax2 and Hmax3 and maximum base moment capacities
Mmax2, Mmax3, Tmax, which can be calibrated based either on material properties (e.g. soil friction
angle) or on theoretical values.
Characterised as follows:
- the uplift initiation parameter, α, is only dependent on the assumed stress distribution of vertical
stresses underneath the foundation and can be determined from simple static considerations, as
shown in
Suggested
Symbol Definition
Values
𝐻𝑚𝑎𝑥
direction
Eurocode8
Suggested
Symbol Definition
Values
Calibratedon
Normalised reference
H 0pl experimental 0.2 to 0.4
plastic modulus
results
Plastic potential
𝜒𝑔 0.5 to 2
parameter
Table 1.Summary of macro-element parameters related to: (i) geometric and elastic parameters; (ii)
strength parameters; (iii) model specific parameters
It is not affecting much the results, and is typically taken as 3, which corresponds to assuming a linear
distribution stresses for the soil at the beginning of the analysis;
- the exponent for loading history in unloading/reloading, nUR, is usually equal to 1, being related to
different plastic modulus values for unloading/reloading in comparison to the virgin loading;
- the soil/footing contact degradation parameter,d, takes into account the decrease of the contact area
due to cumulative inelastic rocking in the damage model and can be evaluated based on experimental
results;
pl
- the normalised reference plastic modulus, H 0 , calibrated based on experimental results;
- and the plastic potential surface parameter,g, also calibrated based on experimental results.
From the above, it turns out that, once the classical elastic and strength parameters for the soil-
foundation system are known, a small number of 3 free-parameters remains to be calibrated in the
pl
validation process: H 0 , the normalised reference plastic modulus, g, the plastic potential surface
parameter, and d, the damage model parameter.
NOTE 1: Given that the SSI macro-element presents a nonlinear response from the outset of the
analysis, it is very important to apply the initial loading in several steps in order to avoid lack of
convergence or erroneous results. Typically a number of steps between 50 and 100 should be enough,
although in more demanding cases of analyses might be needed.
Appendix F 459
NOTE 2: Care should be taken on the ground motion input when a dynamic time history analysis with
the SSI macro-element is made. In fact, given that the two nodes of the macro-element should have the
same motion while no inertial interaction is present, the soundest way of performing the analysis is
not by imposing the ground motion acceleration history at the base node but by imposing the
corresponding inertia forces on the structural masses above.
Suggested
Symbol Definition
Values
𝐻𝑚𝑎𝑥
direction
Eurocode8
Suggested
Symbol Definition
Values
Normalised reference
H 0pl 0.2 to 0.4
plastic modulus
Plastic potential
𝜒𝑔 0.5 to 2
parameter
Table 1.Summary of macro-element parameters related to: (i) geometric and elastic parameters; (ii)
strength parameters; (iii) model specific parameters
Stress distribution
below the footing
𝛼 2 3 4 +∞
Table 2.Stress distribution below the footing and the corresponding value of uplift initiation parameter
(𝛂)
Some theoretical background on SSI analysis
SSI analysis can be carried out through the employment of a nonlinear solid finite element model (i.e.
soil-block), or by means of a simpler and thus more practical substructure approach, which is the one
that can be adopted in SeismoStruct.
In principle, when modelling SSI using the substructure method, one should first analyse the kinematic
interaction with the full model of the soil and the structure, with the structural stiffness but no
structural mass. In such procedure, the seismic input propagation in the soil is explicitly modelled,
typically in the frequency domain (though not necessarily), and the end result is the foundation input
motion (FIM), i.e. the motion of the foundation if it were massless. This initial step is, however, often
avoided by assuming that the kinematic interaction may be neglected and thus using the free-field
ground motion as the FIM (this free-field motion is also often assumed to result only from the vertical
propagation of shear waves through horizontal soil layers).
A second stage in the modelling of SSI using the substructure method would then be the calculation of
the foundation impedances (i.e. dynamic response properties of the foundation), typically represented
by a set of springs, dashpots (and possibly fictitious masses to get the correct frequency-dependence of
the impedances). This second step may be simplified by determining the impedances from existing
expressions in the literature.
The final step is the analysis of the structure, with its stiffness and mass, supported on the foundation
impedances and subjected to the FIM. This is what can be done in SeismoStruct, which features the
added advantage of being able, through the employment of the SSI macro-element, of considering also
the nonlinear response of the foundation system. In other words, an SSI analysis carried out using this
macro-element corresponds to a hybrid approach in-between the inertial interaction analysis of the
substructure approach, which is strictly valid only for linear response, and a nonlinear solid finite
element modelling of SSI effects.
Within the context defined above, therefore, the following should be kept in mind by the user:
A. The substructure method is only theoretically correct if the response is linear, i.e. without
sliding or uplifting of a footing, gapping of a pile, stiffness degradation, plastic behaviour, and
Appendix F 461
These two seismic input definition approaches are supposed to lead to identical analysis
results in terms of nodal relative displacements (and hence material strains/stress and
member internal forces). The first approach is easier to apply because only a base motion
in the fixed nodes needs to be defined. However, it may give rise to numerical problems in
special cases when the stiffnesses of the macro-element are very large. The second
approach is more difficult to apply, because one has to apply a dynamic force time-history
in all nodes with lumped masses and becomes cumbersome when distributed masses are
used. But this method works in all cases.
The pile-head macro-element model represents the lateral behaviour of single vertical piles, subjected
to a horizontal load and a moment, from the initial stages of loading up until reaching failure. The
effects of vertical loading are not directly considered in this model except for its influence on the
plastic moment of the pile cross-section. Otherwise, it is considered that the upper zone of the soil
profile, until the depth at which the plastic hinge will form, only contributes to the lateral load
resistance. The vertical load is assumed to be transferred to the surrounding soil below that depth,
where there is no influence of gap opening.
A saturated soil deposit is considered and, upon seismic motion, it is assumed to be impervious. The
soil is thus considered to have undrained behaviour since the aim of the macro-element is to simulate
the pile response under seismic actions, or short-term cyclic loads, and the Tresca failure criterion is
assumed to be valid. Figure5a represents the two simplified geotechnical scenarios considered, in
terms of undrained shear strength (Su) distribution along the depth of the soil deposit: constant or
linear. Figure5b illustrates the characteristic soil response for a laterally loaded long pile, namely: a
soil passive wedge failure at shallow depths and flow-around failure at larger depths, with a possible
gap formation at the back of the pile.
Figure5. Simplified (a) geotechnical scenarios and (b) soil response for pile-head lateral loading
The proposed macro-element is based on the three major features of the behaviour of laterally loaded
piles, namely:
i) Initial elastic response,
ii) Gap opening and closure,
iii) Failure loading conditions.
The bounding surface plasticity model is used to represent a continuous transition between the initial
elastic response and the plastic flow at failure, for monotonic as well as cyclic pile-head loading
conditions. The gapping behaviour is represented by a nonlinear elastic model which, however, takes
into account and is influenced by the plastic deformation state in the surrounding soil.
The bounding surface in the macro-element model corresponds to the failure surface for laterally
loaded piles. Since there is no evidence showing that non-associative behaviour should be considered,
associative plasticity is used and the bounding surface acts simultaneously as the plastic potential
surface. No axial load effects are considered in this macro-element formulation and, consequently, the
failure surface is defined in the loading space of the pile-head horizontal force and moment only.
Furthermore, a planar loading is assumed.
A “rounded” approximate failure surface was proposed in Correia and Pecker [2019a], which is based
on the so-called superellipse. Supposing a superellipse centred at the point (Hc, Mc), with a horizontal
H
axis length u , e 0 and a vertical axis length My, which is also superimposed to a distortion of its shape,
< 0, this approximate failure surface can be expressed as:
Appendix F 463
nH nM
H Hc M Mc M Mc
1 (1)
H u , e 0 My My
The positive exponents nH and nM control the curvature of the sides of the superellipse. Figure 6
represents such distorted superellipse configuration, centred at the origin (Hc = Mc = 0), with its
parameters calibrated in order to fit the failure surface for the linear Su soil profile.
1.2
0.8
0.4
Mu/My
0
Distorted
-0.4 superellipse
-0.8
-1.2
Idealised
-2 -1.5 -1 -0.5 0 0.5 1 1.5 2 failure
Hu/Hu,e=0 surface
The macro-element model requires the definition of 23 input parameters: D, KVV, KHH, KMM, KHM, KTT,
CVV, CHH, CMM, CHM, CTT, Hu, e=0, My, nH, nM, , zw, E p I p
eff
, , , H 0pl ,nUR and Lim. Only the last 5 of
these parameters must be calibrated, since all the remaining ones are computed directly through
expressions developed in the literature.
E I
p p
The pile flexural stiffness, eff
, can be easily computed, while the pile yield moment, My, can be
computed using any cross-section analysis tool (and considering the static vertical load on the pile). On
the other hand, formulas for Hu, e=0 and zw, are derived in Correia and Pecker [2019a].
Gazetas [1991] provides formulas for a direct computation of pile-head lateral and axial stiffness and
damping coefficients. These are valid for soil profiles with constant, linear or parabolic increase of soil
stiffness with depth, which are representative of OC clay, NC clay and sand, respectively. Figure 7
represents the soil stiffness evolution with depth in such idealised soil profiles. His expressions for
pile-head static stiffnesses have been adopted, with slight modifications, in the current version of EC 8
– Part 5 [2003]. These are valid for flexible or long piles and are summarised in Table 3.. In those
expressions, D is the pile diameter, ESD is the soil modulus of deformation at a depth equal to the pile
diameter and Ep is the Young’s modulus of the pile material. The pile-head stiffness matrix
components follow the sign convention expressed in Figure 8.Gazetas [1991] also presents the
corresponding pile-head damping coefficients, which are computed for each frequency f according to
the expressions in Figure 8.
464 SeismoStruct User Manual
The dynamic components of the pile-head stiffnesses have been shown by Gazetas [1984] to be
roughly equal to one, for the usual frequency range of interest for structural response. Hence, pile-head
static stiffnesses may be approximately used as dynamic ones, for single flexible piles. Variation of the
damping ratio components with frequency is linear, as predicted by the expressions in Table 4. This
means that radiation damping behaviour may be approximated by physical dashpots with constant
damping coefficient C.
The bounding surface parameters are fixed for each of the soil strength profiles and are shown in Table
5.The limit value Lim is a parameter related to the numerical convergence and varies between 0.01 and
0.2, with a default value of 0.1.
Soil stiffness K HH K MM K HM
profile ESD D ESD D 3 ESD D 2
Table 3. Pile-head static stiffness coefficients for flexible piles (after EC8 – Part 5 [2003])
Appendix F 465
Finally, the remaining 4 calibration parameters, 2 of them are related to monotonic response – and
H 0pl , and the 2 others are related to cyclic behaviour – and nUR. Alternatively, 2 of the parameters
pl
are related to the gapping behaviour – and , and 2 others are related to the plasticity model – H 0
pl
and nUR. The parameters , H 0 and nUR are always positive, while can also be equal to zero if no
residual gap opening is considered. Their default values and ranges of variation are presented in Table
6.
NOTE: Care should be taken on the ground motion input when a dynamic time history analysis with
the SSI macro-element is made. In fact, given that the two nodes of the macro-element should have the
same motion while no inertial interaction is present, the soundest way of performing the analysis is
not by imposing the ground motion acceleration history at the base node but by imposing the
corresponding inertia forces on the structural masses above.
Linear
1.80 0.40 1.00
ES ESD z / D
Table 4. Pile-head radiation damping coefficients for flexible piles and fundamental shear frequencies of
soil deposit (after Gazetas [1991])
Su profile nH nM
Constant Su 8.435 2.000 -0.597
Linear Su 7.040 2.000 -0.667
Table 5. Pre-determined failure surface parameters
H 0pl nUR
1 1 0.4 1
0.1-10 0-100 0.1-10 0.5-2
Table 6. Default values and ranges of values for calibration parameters
466 SeismoStruct User Manual
These two seismic input definition approaches are supposed to lead to identical analysis
results in terms of nodal relative displacements (and hence material strains/stress and
member internal forces). The first approach is easier to apply because only a base motion
in the fixed nodes needs to be defined. However, it may give rise to numerical problems in
special cases when the stiffnesses of the macro-element are very large. The second
approach is more difficult to apply, because one has to apply a dynamic force time-history
Appendix F 467
in all nodes with lumped masses and becomes cumbersome when distributed masses are
used. But this method works in all cases.
where η_shear_2 and η_shear_3 are the ratios of the Post Yield Stiffness to the Elastic (Pre-Yielding)
Stiffness of the bearing in each shear direction (Bearing Hardening Ratios), K2 and K3 are the elastic
Stiffnesses of the bearing in each direction, Y2 and Y3 the yielding deformations in each shear direction while
z2 and z3 are internal hysteretic variables.
Thirteen parameters are needed in order to describe the bearing 1 element behaviour:
Elastic Stiffness in the axial (local axis 1) 2E+05 - 150E+05 [kN/m] 2E+06 [kNm]
direction - K_axial
Elastic Stiffness in the shear (local axis 2 3000 – 40000 [kN/m] 3000 [kNm]
and 3) directions - K_shear_1, K_Shear_2
In this element's dialog box it is also possible to define an element-specific damping, as opposed to the global
damping described in here. To do so, users need simply to press the Damping button and then select the type
of damping that better suits the element in question (users should refer to the Damping menu for a discussion
on the different types of damping available and hints on which might the better options). Users are reminded
also that damping defined at element level takes precedence over global damping, that is, the "globally-
computed" damping matrix coefficients that are associated to the degrees-of-freedom of a given element will
be replaced by coefficients that will have been calculated through the multiplication of the mass matrix of the
element by a mass-proportional parameter, or through the multiplication of the element stiffness matrix by a
stiffness-proportional parameter, or through the calculation of an element damping Rayleigh matrix.
Local axes and output notation are defined in the figure below:
𝑄𝑦𝑖𝑒𝑙𝑑 = 𝜇𝑃
where P is the total vertical load on the bearing. Plastic deformations after the yielding point are computed
using a Return-Mapping Algorithm as described for hardening models by Simo and Hughes [1998]. The
post-yielding stiffness is equal to P/R where R is the radius of curvature of the friction pendulum and P is the
total vertical load on the bearing.
Fourteen parameters are needed in order to describe the bearing 1 element behaviour:
Elastic Stiffness in the axial (local axis 1) 1E+06 - 30E+06 [kN/m] 2E+06 [kNm]
direction - K_axial
Elastic Stiffness in the shear (local axis 2 500 – 20000 [kN/m] 3000 [kNm]
and 3) directions - K_shear_1, K_Shear_2
In this element's dialog box it is also possible to define an element-specific damping, as opposed to the global
damping described in here. To do so, users need simply to press the Damping button and then select the type
of damping that better suits the element in question (users should refer to the Damping menu for a discussion
on the different types of damping available and hints on which might the better options). Users are reminded
also that damping defined at element level takes precedence over global damping, that is, the "globally-
470 SeismoStruct User Manual
computed" damping matrix coefficients that are associated to the degrees-of-freedom of a given element will
be replaced by coefficients that will have been calculated through the multiplication of the mass matrix of the
element by a mass-proportional parameter, or through the multiplication of the element stiffness matrix by a
stiffness-proportional parameter, or through the calculation of an element damping Rayleigh matrix.
Local axes and output notation are defined in the figure below:
NOTE: Analyses of large models featuring distributed mass/loading are inevitably longer than those
where lumped masses, and corresponding point loads, are employed to model, in a more simplified
fashion, the mass/weight of the structure. If users are not interested in obtaining information on the
local stress state of structural elements (e.g. beam moment distribution), but are rather focused only
on estimating the overall response of the structure (e.g. roof displacement and base shear), then the
employment of a faster lumped mass/force modelling approach may prove to be a better option, with
respect to its distributed counterpart.
The lumped mass element (lmass) is a single-node mass element, characterised by three translational
and three rotational inertia values. The latter are defined by means of the mass moment of inertia (not
to be confused with the second moment of area, commonly named also as moment of inertia), and may
be computed using formulae available in the literature [e.g. Pilkey, 1994; Gere and Timoshenko, 1997].
The inertia mass values are to be defined with respect to the global reference system (X, Y and Z), and
lead to a diagonal 6x6 element mass matrix.
Appendix F 471
The distributed mass (dmass) is a two-node mass element. The user needs only to specify the unitary
mass (mass/length) value, from which the program computes internally the total element mass M, and
subsequently derives the respective diagonal mass matrix with reference to the global translational
degrees-of-freedom of the member.
NOTE 1: When the structure is subjected to very large deformations (e.g. buckling), the employment of
two or more dmass elements per member is recommended, for accurate modelling.
NOTE 2: If the loads are derived from masses (in the gravity direction based on the g value or in any
translational direction, according to user-defined coefficients), then the program will automatically
compute and effectively apply distributed permanent loads.
NOTE 3: Distributed loads obtained from dmass elements are not considered in stress-recovery
operations (because they are separate elements from the beams/columns), hence moment values
throughout an element's length are bound to be wrong. Users interested in obtaining correct moments
throughout an element's length, should define distributed mass/load using the 'material volumetric
weight' in the Materials module and/or 'section added mass' in the Sections module.
472 SeismoStruct User Manual
IMPORTANT: In SeismoStruct, dampers are normally modelled by means of link elements with
adequate response curves that may be able to characterise the non-velocity-dependent (at least within
the typical range of earthquake velocities) force-displacement relationship of a given damper.
However, in those cases where velocity dependence is important, this dashpt element may be
employed instead, noting that currently only a linear force-velocity relationship is featured.
This is a two-node damping element, which may be employed to represent a linear dashpot between
any two given nodes, e.g. it can be used to represent a damper installed on a steel brace.. Damping
coefficients may be defined on all six global degrees-of-freedom, though, commonly, dampers will
work only in one or two directions. The dashpot accounts for the relative motion between the two
element nodes, in order to calculate the dashpot forces.
NOTE: This dashpt element may also be employed whenever the need arises for the introduction of a
Maxwell model (i.e. series coupling of damping and stiffness), by placing in series a link and a dashpt
element. For a Kelvin-Voigt model (i.e. parallel coupling of damping and stiffness), one may again
make use of a link element, this time placed in parallel with a dashpt, though in these cases it may
result easier to simply assign directly to the link element a given viscous damping value.
Appendix G - Response Curves
In this appendix the available response curves are described in details.
IMPORTANT: In previous releases of SeismoStruct, link elements featuring lin_sym response curve
were typically employed to model pinned joints (zero stiffness) and/or constraints. However, users
may now use the Equal DOF facility (see Constraints) to achieve the same objective; e.g. a pin/hinge
may be modelled by introducing an 'Equal DOF' constrain defined for translation degrees-of-freedom
only.
This is a curve frequently employed to model idealised linear behaviour, soil/foundation flexibility,
laminated-rubber bearings (if their usually low viscous damping is ignored), and so on.
A single parameter needs to be defined in order to fully characterise this response curve:
Curve Properties Typical values Default values
Stiffness – K0 - 10000 (-)
Two parameters need to be defined in order to fully characterise this response curve:
Curve Properties Typical values Default values
Stiffness in positive region – K0(+) - 10000 (-)
Stiffness in negative region – K0(-) - 5000 (-)
Three parameters need to be defined in order to fully characterise this response curve:
Curve Properties Typical values Default values
Initial stiffness – K0 - 20000 (-)
Yield force – Fy - 1000 (-)
Post-yield hardening ratio – r - 0.005 (-)
NOTE: Evidently, in those (relatively common) cases where the post-yield stiffness is not very high and
the maximum force does not thus reach a value that is twice its yield counterpart, this response curve
will behave in the same manner as curve bl_kin.
476 SeismoStruct User Manual
Six parameters need to be defined in order to fully characterise this response curve:
Curve Properties Typical values Default values
Initial stiffness in positive region – K0(+) - 20000 (-)
Yield force in positive region – Fy(+) - 1000 (-)
Post-yield hardening ratio in positive
- 0.005 (-)
region – r(+)
Initial stiffness in negative region – K0(-) - 10000 (-)
Yield force in negative region – Fy(-) - -1500 (-)
Post-yield hardening ratio in negative
- 0.01 (-)
region – r(-)
NOTE 2: The image above reflects those (relatively common) cases where the post-yield stiffness is not
very high and the maximum force does not thus reach a value that is twice its yield counterpart,
making the curve behaviour resemble that of a kinematic-hardening curve such as bl_kin. This
however will not be the case on all instances, and hence an isotropic-hardening type of response (such
as that shown clearly in here) should be expected.
Three parameters need to be defined in order to fully characterise this response curve:
Curve Properties Typical values Default values
Initial stiffness – K0 - 20000 (-)
Yield force – Fy - 1000 (-)
Post-yield hardening ratio – r - 0.005 (-)
Five parameters need to be defined in order to fully characterise this response curve:
Curve Properties Typical values Default values
Initial stiffness – K0 - 1000 (-)
First branch displacement limit – d1 - 1 (-)
Second branch stiffness – K1 - 10 (-)
Second branch displacement limit – d2 - 5 (-)
Third branch stiffness – K2 - 100 (-)
478 SeismoStruct User Manual
NOTE: Stiffness values K0, K1 and K2 must be positive. Further, K1 and K2 should always be smaller than
K0.
Ten parameters need to be defined in order to fully characterise this response curve:
Curve Properties Typical values Default values
Initial stiffness in positive region – K0(+) - 1000 (-)
First branch positive displacement limit –
- 1 (-)
d1(+)
Second branch positive stiffness – K1(+) - 50 (-)
Second branch positive displacement limit –
- 5 (-)
d2(+)
Third branch stiffness in positive region –
- 100 (-)
K2(+)
Initial stiffness in negative region – K0(-) - 10000 (-)
First branch negative displacement limit –
- -5 (-)
d1(-)
Second branch negative stiffness – K1(-) - 35 (-)
Second branch negative displacement limit
- -15 (-)
– d2(-)
Third branch stiffness in negative region –
- 100 (-)
K2(-)
NOTE 1: Stiffness values K0(+), K1(+), K2(+) and K0(-), K1(-), K2(-) must be positive. Further, K1 and K2 should
always be smaller than K0 in both positive and negative displacement regions.
Appendix G 479
NOTE 2: Example. To model the pounding of two adjacent buildings separated by an expansion joint of
20 mm, the following trl_asm curve parameters could be adopted: K0(+)=1e12, d1(+)=0, K1(+)=0,
d2(+)=1e10, K2(+)=0, K0(-)=1e12, d1(-)=0, K1(-)=0, d2(-)=-20,K2(-)=1e10. However, the employment of
response curve gap_hk is recommended for these cases.
NOTE 3: Users may refer to the figure relating to the trl_sym curve, for further indications on the cyclic
rules employed this response curve. Ultimately, users are always advised to run simple cyclic load
analyses (e.g. using a single link element connected to the ground on one end, and then imposing cyclic
displacements at its free node) in order to gain a full understanding of this hysteretic relationship,
before its employment within more elaborate models.
Five parameters need to be defined in order to fully characterise this response curve:
Curve Properties Typical values Default values
Yielding strength – Fy - 500
Yielding displacement – dy - 0.005
Ultimate strength – Fu - 550
Ultimate displacement capacity – du - 0.02
Residual strength - 200
Ten parameters need to be defined in order to fully characterise this response curve:
Curve Properties Typical values Default values
Yielding strength for positive loading
- 500
direction – Fy(+)
Yielding displacement for positive loading
- 0.005
direction – dy(+)
Ultimate strength for positive loading
- 550
direction – Fu(+)
Ultimate displacement capacity for positive
- 0.02
loading direction – du(+)
Residual strength for positive loading
- 200
direction (+)
Yielding strength for negative loading
- 400 (-)
direction – Fy(-)
Yielding displacement for negative loading
- 0.005 (-)
direction – dy(-)
Ultimate strength for negative loading
- 450 (-)
direction – Fu(-)
Ultimate displacement capacity for negative
- 0.02 (-)
loading direction – du(-)
Residual strength for negative loading
- 200 (-)
direction (-)
Seventeen parameters need to be defined in order to fully characterise this response curve:
Material Properties Typical values Default values
Displacement at first point of envelope in - 0.001
the positive direction– d1p(+)
Force at first point of envelope in the - 100.00
positive direction – f1p(+)
Displacement at second point of envelope in - 0.115
the positive direction– d2p(+)
Force at second point of envelope in the - 150
positive direction – f2p(+)
Displacement at third point of envelope in - 0.2
the positive direction– d3p(+)
Force at third point of envelope in the - 145.00
positive direction – f3p(+)
Displacement at first point of envelope in - -0.001
the negative direction– d1n(-)
Force at first point of envelope in the - -100.00
negative direction – f1n(-)
Displacement at second point of envelope in - -0.115
the negative direction– d2n(-)
Force at second point of envelope in the - -150.00
negative direction – f2n(-)
Displacement at third point of envelope in - -0.2
the negative direction– d3n(-)
Force at third point of envelope in the - -145.00
negative direction – f3n(-)
Pinching factor for displacement during 0-1.0(-) 0.8
reloading– pinchdisp
Pinching factor for force during reloading– 0-1.0(-) 0.2
pinchforce
482 SeismoStruct User Manual
Twenty Two parameters need to be defined in order to fully characterise this response curve(an online
tool for defining the model parameters in the case of steel beams can be found in http://dimitrios-
lignos.research.mcgill.ca/databases/component/):
Typical values (for steel
Curve Properties Default values
beams)
Elastic Stiffness – Ke - 200000
Effective yield strength for positive loading direction
- 300
– fy(+)
Effective yield strength for negative loading direction
- 300
– fy(-)
Plastic rotation capacity for positive loading direction
- 0.025
– θp(+)
Plastic rotation capacity for negative loading
- 0.025
direction – θp(-)
Post - capping rotation capacity for positive loading
- 0.3
direction – θpc(+)
Post-capping rotation capacity for negative loading
- 0.3
direction – θpc(-)
Ultimate rotation capacity for positive loading
- 0.4
direction – θu(+)
Ultimate rotation capacity for negative loading
- 0.4
direction – θu(-)
Residual Strength Ratio for positive loading direction
0.0 - 0.5 0.3
– k(+)
Residual Strength Ratio for negative loading direction
0.0 - 0.5 0.3
– k(-)
Strain Hardening Ratio for positive loading direction
0.0 - 0.5 0.03
– as(+)
Strain Hardening Ratio for negative loading direction
0.0 - 0.5 0.03
– as(-)
Cyclic deterioration parameter for strength 0.0-1000.0 (Zero value leads to
0.6
deterioration – Λs no deterioration)
484 SeismoStruct User Manual
Twenty four parameters need to be defined in order to fully characterise this response curve:
Typical values (for steel
Curve Properties Default values
beams)
Elastic Stiffness – Ke - 200000
Effective yield strength for positive loading direction
- 300
– fy(+)
Effective yield strength for negative loading direction
- 300
– fy(-)
Plastic rotation capacity for positive loading direction
- 0.025
– θp(+)
Plastic rotation capacity for negative loading - 0.025
486 SeismoStruct User Manual
strength and deformation bounds, but uses a Pinched hysteretic Model to model hysteresis of the
backbone curve. The Pinched hysteretic is similar to the peak-oriented one, except that reloading
consists of two parts. Initially the reloading path is directed towards a ‘break point’, which is a function
of the maximum permanent deformation and the maximum load experienced in the direction of
loading (Ibarra et al.[2005]. The model includes four modes of cyclic deterioration: a. basic strength
deterioration, b. post-capping strength deterioration, c. unloading/reloading stiffness deterioration
and d. accelerated reloading stiffness deterioration. Modified Ibarra-Medina Krawinkler Deterioration
Model with Pinched Hysteretic Response is able to simulate the behaviour of reinforced concrete
beams that primarily fail in a shear mode. This model is also able to simulate the hysteretic behaviour
of shear connections, beam-to-column gusset plate connections and wooden components.
Twenty seven parameters need to be defined in order to fully characterise this response curve:
488 SeismoStruct User Manual
Four parameters need to be defined in order to fully characterise this response curve:
Curve Properties Typical values Default values
Yield strength – Fy - 500 (-)
Yield displacement – Dy - 0.0023 (-)
Ramberg-Osgood parameter – - 5.5 (-)
Convergence limit for the Newton-Raphson
- 0.001 (-)
procedure – 1
Two parameters need to be defined in order to fully characterise this response curve:
Curve Properties Typical values Default values
Initial force – F0 - 10000 (-)
Post-yield stiffness – K0 - 5 (-)
NOTE: Unloading and reloading stiffness is taken as infinite, which means that, if a sufficiently small
analysis time-step is used, then the unloading/reloading branches of this response curve result
practically vertical. With large time-steps, on the other hand, a finite unloading/reloading stiffness is
obtained through the ratio 2F0/t.
NOTE 1: The unloading stiffness from the post yielding curve in outer hysteresis loop is defined by:
𝜷𝟎
𝑫𝒚
𝑲𝒓𝒐𝒖𝒕 = 𝑲𝒚
𝑫𝒎
where:
Ky is the initial stiffness;
Dy is the yielding displacement
Dm is the previous maximum displacement
0 is the outer loop stiffness degradation factor (Krout), i.e. for unloading from the primary curve
NOTE 2: The curve passes at (Fy, (1+Dy)) for any value of , which controls the shape of the primary
curve. As shown below, the loading curve may vary from a linear elastic line for = 1.0, to an elasto-
plastic bilinear segment for = infinity.
Appendix G 493
NOTE 3: The unloading curve from the maximum point (D0, F0) follows the equation:
𝜸−𝟏
𝑫 − 𝑫𝟎 𝑭 − 𝑭𝟎 𝑭 − 𝑭𝟎
= 𝟏+
𝟐𝑫𝒚 𝟐𝑭𝒚 𝟐𝑭𝒚
NOTE 4: The force is computed by an iterative procedure using the Newton–Raphson method.
NOTE 5: As pointed out by Otani [1981] this hysteretic model dissipates energy even if the ductility
factor is less than one. The dissipated energy is sensitive to , increasing with the increasing of this
parameter.
NOTE: If a symmetric behaviour is sought, the second set of 15 parameters is identical to the first half.
For the descending (negative) branches the corresponding input parameters are:
Curve Properties Typical values Default values
Initial stiffness for the upper bound curve –
15000 - 50000 (kNm/rad) 12000 (kNm/rad)
Kd
Strength for the upper bound curve – Md 75 - 250 (kNm) 45 (kNm)
Post-elastic stiffness for the upper bound
0.02Kd - 0.05Kd 200 (kNm/rad)
curve – Kpd
Shape parameter for the upper bound curve
4 (-) 4 (-)
– Nd
Initial stiffness for the lower bound curve –
Kd 12000 (kNm/rad)
Kdp
Strength for the lower bound curve – Mdp 0.45Md - 0.65Md 5 (kNm)
Post-elastic stiffness for the lower bound
Kpd 200 (kNm/rad)
curve – Kpdp
Shape parameter for the lower bound curve
4 (-) 4 (-)
– Ndp
Empirical parameter related to the pinching
5 - 20 (-) 30 (-)
– t1d
Empirical parameter related to the pinching
0.15 - 0.5 (-) 0.03 (-)
– t2d
Empirical parameter related to the pinching
1 (-) 1 (-)
– Cd
Empirical coefficient related to the stiffness
3 - 25 (-) 0 (-)
damage rate – iKd
Empirical coefficient related to the strength
0.01 - 0.1 (-) 0.03 (-)
damage rate – iMd
Empirical coefficient defining the level of
0.01 - 0.04 (-) 0.02 (-)
isotropic hardening – Hd
Maximum value of deformation reached in
0 - 0.2 (rad) 0.5 (rad)
the loading history – Emaxd
Below, example applications extracted from the work of Nogueiro et al. [2005a] are given, in order to
illustrate the modelling capacities of this response curve:
NOTE: In the Steel Connection below some parameters assume non-typical values.
Appendix G 495
IMPORTANT: This versatile hysteretic model is still being tested and further developed. For instance,
currently this curve caters for the normal force-displacement direction only (i.e. it does not account
for the tangential force-slip response). In addition, or perhaps in tandem, the DOFs are not fully
coupled (a limitation that is also a consequence of the currently uncoupled nature of the link elements
in SeismoStruct). It is envisaged that both of these issues will be addressed in future releases of
SeismoStruct.
This is a nonlinear dynamic soil-structure interaction (SSI) model, developed and implemented by
Allotey and El Naggar [2005a; 2005b], adequate for analysing footings, retaining walls and piles under
different loading regimes (the nomenclature chosen for this curve puts in evidence the fact that this
model can be used to carry out lateral pile analyses, where p-y curves are commonly employed). It
accounts for gap formation with the option of considering soil cave-in, it features cyclic
hardening/degradation under variable-amplitude loading, and it can model responses that are
bounded or unbounded within their initial backbone curves.
Cyclic degradation/hardening due to pore pressure and volumetric changes is accounted for through
the use of elliptical damage functions implemented within the framework of a modified rainflow
counting algorithm [Anthes, 1997]; the equivalent number of cycles approach [e.g. Seed et al. 1975;
Annaki and Lee, 1977] is also used. The effect of soil cave-in is, on the other hand, modelled using an
empirically developed hyperbolic function.
496 SeismoStruct User Manual
Evidently, this hysteretic model, on its own, is not sufficient to model a given foundation system.
Instead, a series of springs (i.e. link elements) featuring an appropriately calibrated ssi_py curve must
be used, normally in association with a beam-column element, in order to model whatever foundation
system the user needs to represent. In other words, this response curve is to be employed within the
realms of beam-on-a-nonlinear Winkler foundation (BNWF) model, whereby a number of spring
elements are used under the foundation and the response curves have to be given for each. For a
footing, the parameters are the same for all springs, whilst for a pile or retaining wall, since the
overburden increases with depth, the parameters change with depth.
In addition, viscous damping may be assigned to the link element whenever the user wishes to
somehow account for radiation damping effects (this will be similar to the introduction of a dashpot
element parallel to the soil spring). Users may refer to the literature [e.g. Wolf, 1994; Allotey and El
Naggar, 2005b] for indications on how to compute appropriate values of damping, as a function of the
vibration characteristics of the soil-structure system. Commonly, if the vibration period of the soil-
structure system is below that of the site, then the effects of radiation damping may be considered as
negligible.
Nineteen parameters need to be defined in order to fully characterise this response curve:
Curve Properties Typical values Default values
Initial stiffness – K0 - 10000 (kNm/rad)
Soil strength ratio at first turning point – Fc 0 - 1 (-) 0.5 (-)
Yielding soil strength – Fy - 100 (kNm)
Initial force ratio at zero displacement – P0 0 - 0.9 0 (-)
Minimum force ratio at baseline – Pa – OR 0 Pa P0; Pa nFy; Pa Fc
0 (-)
Side-shear force factor ratio – fs 0 fs 0.9
Stiffness ratio after first turning point – 0.001 - 1 (-) 0.5 (-)
Unloading stiffness factor – N - 1 (-)
Yielding stiffness ratio – - 0 (-)
Ultimate soil strength – N - 1 (-)
Flag settings combination indicator – Flg See Help System 31 (-)
DRC starting stiffness ratio – ep1 1 (-)
Gap force parameter – p1 1 (-)
Soil cave-in parameter – p2 0 (-)
Stiffness degradation/hardening parameter
1 (-)
– pk
Stiffness degradation/hardening parameter
1 (-)
– ek
Appendix G 497
NOTE 1: Future releases of SeismoStruct are also likely to introduce a significantly more user-friendly
way of calibrating/adjusting the parameters of this response curve, using drop-down menus and/or
radio buttons to select the different modelling options.
NOTE 2: In recent years, an alternative approach to the modelling of foundation systems, consisting in
the employment of a fully-coupled V-H-M (vertical-horizontal-rotation) macro-model has been
proposed [e.g. Cremer at al, 2002]. It uses just one element to model the whole footing response and is
based on a plasticity-type yield surface formulation. Although this is certainly a promising approach to
SSI modelling, it is felt that, given the current state of development and practice, the more traditional
BNWF procedure, currently implemented in SeismoStruct through the employment of the powerful
ssi_py response curve, provides users with all the facilities required for an adequate modelling of the
static, and above all dynamic, interaction between soils, foundations and structures.
Below, example applications are given, in order to illustrate the modelling capacities of this response
curve (it is noted that the 'bordered' parameters have been changed with respect to the default
values):
Appendix G 499
Below, example applications are given, in order to illustrate the modelling capacities of this response
curve (it is noted that the 'bordered' parameters have been changed with respect to the default
values):
Appendix G 501
Twelve parameters are needed in order to describe the mechanical characteristics of the material.
Pairs of stress strain defining the backbone curve must be given in ascending order
Appendix H1 - EUROCODES
In this appendix the parameters used for the structures assessment according to the Eurocodes (EC8-
Part1 and Part3) are presented.
PERFORMANCE REQUIREMENTS
According to EN1998-3 section 2.1, performance requirements refer to the state of damage in the
structure defined through three limit states, namely Near Collapse (NC), Significant Damage (SD) and
Damage Limitation (DL).
Confidence Factors
In the following table of EN1998-3 a summary and recommendations for the confidence factors and
the analysis methods are provided for each knowledge level.
Knowledge
Geometry Details Materials Analysis CF
Level
Simulated design Default values
in accordance in accordance
with relevant with standards
practice and of the time of
KL1 LF-MRS CFKL1
from limited in- construction
situ inspection and from
limited in-situ
testing
From
From incomplete From original
original
original detailed design
outline
construction specifications
construction
drawings with with limited in-
KL2 drawings All CFKL2
limited in-situ situ testing or
with sample
inspection or from extended
visual
from extended in-situ testing
survey or
in-situ inspection
from full
From original From original
survey
detailed test reports
construction with limited in-
drawings with situ testing or
KL3 limited in-situ from All CFKL3
inspection or comprehensive
from in-situ testing
comprehensive
in-situ inspection
NOTE The values ascribed to the confidence factors to be used in a country may be found in its National Annex.
The recommended values are CFKL1=1,35, CFKL2=1,20 and CFKL3=1,00.
Safety Factors
The values of the safety factors and the Code expressions employed may be specified through the
dialog box that opens from the corresponding button. It is noted the default values of the safety factors
are those defined in Eurocode 8 – Part 3.
Deformation Capacity
The deformation capacity of beams, columns and walls is defined in terms of the chord rotation θ, that
is the angle between the tangent to the axis at the yielding end and the chord connecting that end with
the end of the shear span (LV=M/V=moment/shear at the end section). The chord rotation is also equal
to the element drift ratio, which is the deflection at the end of the shear span with respect to the
tangent to the axis at the yielding end divided by the shear span.
Deformation capacity of beams and columns is highly influenced by the lack of appropriate seismic
resistant detailing in longitudinal reinforcement, as well as by the bars type, that is whether there are
smooth bars or/and of cold-worked brittle steel. Inadequate development of splicing along the span
(beams) and height (columns) and inadequate embedment into beam-column joints can control the
member’s response to seismic action, drastically limiting its capacity in respect to the situation in
which the reinforcement is considered fully effective. The above limitations to the deformation
capacity are taken into consideration.
510 SeismoStruct User Manual
The value for the chord rotation capacity for the limit state of near collapse (NC) is the value of the
total chord rotation capacity (elastic plus inelastic part) at ultimate of concrete members under cyclic
loading, which is calculated from the equations (A.1) and (A.3) of EC8: Part 3 (CEN, 2005b):
0,225 f yw
1 max 0,01; ω′ LV 0,35
αρ sx
fc
θum = ∙ 0,016 ∙ 0,3ν f ∙ min(9, ) 25 (1,25100 ρ d )
γel max 0,01; ω c h
(A.1) EC8: Part 3
Where γel is equal to 1,5 for primary seismic elements and to 1,0 for secondary seismic ones and L V is
the ratio between bending moment, M, and shear force, V. The remaining relevant parameters are
defined in section A.3.2.2 of EC8: Part 3.
In walls the value given by the equation (A.1) is multiplied by 0,58.
The total chord rotation capacity at ultimate of concrete members under cyclic loading may be also
calculated as the summary of the chord rotation at yielding and the plastic part of the chord rotation
capacity calculated from the following expression:
θpl
um = θum − θy
0,3 0,35 f yw
1 max 0,01; ω′ 0,2 LV αρ sx
fc
= ∙ 0,0145 ∙ 0,25ν ∙ fc ∙ min 9, 25 1,275100 ρ d
γel max 0,01; ω h
(A.3) EC8: Part 3
Where γel is equal to 1,8 for primary seismic elements and to 1,0 for secondary seismic ones; the chord
rotation at yielding, θy, is calculated in accordance with the section A.3.2.4 of EC8: Part 3 and the
remaining relevant parameters are defined in section A.3.2.2 of EC8: Part 3.
In walls the value of θpl
um given by the equation (A.3) is multiplied by 0,6.
The chord rotation capacity corresponding to the limit state of significant damage (SD) is assumed to
be ¾ of the ultimate chord rotation, calculated from the equations above.
The chord rotation capacity that corresponds to the limit state of damage limitation (DL) is given by
the chord rotation at yielding, evaluated as:
For rectangular beams and columns:
L V +α V z h ε y d bL f y
θy = φy + 0,0014 1 + 1,5 + (A.10a) EC8: Part 3
3 LV d−d ′ 6 f c
Or from alternative and equivalent expressions for rectangular beams and columns
L V +α V z h d bL f y
θy = φy + 0,0014 1 + 1,5 + φy (A.10b) EC8: Part 3
3 LV 8 fc
Where αV is equal to zero if the yielding bending moment is lower than L V multiplied by the concrete
shear resistance – VR,c - and 1.0 otherwise. VR,c is calculated according to EN1992-1-1:2004 provisions
for concrete elements without shear reinforcement. The remaining relevant parameters are defined in
section A.3.2.4 of EC8: Part 3.
Appendix H 511
The yield curvature of the end section is calculated according to the following expression for the
sections whose compressive zone is of constant width and for the case that the section’s yielding is due
to steel yielding.
fy
φy = 1 r y =
Es 1 − ξ y d
If the section yields due to the deformation non-linearities of the concrete in compression, that is for
deformation of the edge compressive fibre larger than εc ≈ 1.8 fc Ec , then the yield curvature is
calculated according to the following expression:
εc 1.8fc
φy = 1 r y = ≈
ξ y d Ec ξ y d
The lower from the two values above is used for the calculation of the chord rotation capacity.
According to Annex A of EN1998-3 the chord rotation capacity is highly influenced by a number of
different factors such as the type of the longitudinal bars. If cold-worked brittle steel is used the plastic
part of chord rotation is divided by 2, whereas if smooth (plain) longitudinal bars are applied, section
A.3.2.2(5) of Annex A is employed, taking, also, into consideration whether the longitudinal bars are
well lapped or not. In case of members with lack of appropriate seismic resistant detailing the values
given by expressions (A.1) and (A.3) are divided by 1,2. Moreover, if the deformed longitudinal bars
have straight ends lapped starting at the end section of the member, the plastic part of chord rotation
is calculated with the value of the compression reinforcement ratio, ω’, doubled over the value
applying outside the lap splice. In addition, in sections where the reinforcement lap length l o is less
than the minimum lap length for ultimate deformation lou,min, the plastic part of the chord rotation
capacity, given in (A.3) EC8: Part 3 equation, is multiplied by the ratio lo/lou,min, for more information
about the calculation of lou,min you may refer to A.3.2.2(4) of Annex A, while the value for chord rotation
at yielding, θy accounts for the effect of the lapping in accordance with A.3.2.4(3) of Annex A.
In the case of circular column sections, the equations above cannot be employed for the calculation of
the elements’ chord rotation capacity. In SeismoStruct the following equations suggested by D. Biskinis
and M.N. Fardis [2013] are employed for θy and θu.
LV + αV z 2 Ls φy dbL fy
θy = φy + 0.0027 1 − min 1; + αsl
3 15 D 8 fc
Where fy and fc values are in MPa, αV=1 if VRc<VMy, VRc is calculated according to Eurocode 2 (CEN
2004), otherwise αV=0, and αsl=0 if pull-out of the tension bars from their anchorage zone beyond the
yielding end is physically impossible, otherwise αsl=1.
θu = θy + φu − φy Lpl 1 − 0.5 Lpl Ls + αsl Δθu,slip γel
Where γel is equal to 2.0 for primary seismic elements and to 1.0 for secondary seismic elements,
Δθu,slip and Lpl are calculated according to the following equations:
Δθu,slip = 10dbl φu + φy 2
1 Ls
Lpl = 0.6D 1 + min 9;
6 D
Users are advised to refer to the relevant publications for the definition of the other parameters and
further details on the expression.
Concrete Jacketing
The following assumptions are made in order to evaluate the deformation capacities of the jacketed
members, according to Annex A of EN1998-3:2005: (i) the jacketed element behaves monolithically,
(ii) the full axial load is assumed to act on the jacketed member, disregarding the fact that the axial
load is originally applied to the old column, and (iii) the concrete properties of the jacket are assumed
to apply over the full section of the element.
512 SeismoStruct User Manual
The values of the jacketed members for 𝑀𝑦∗ , 𝜃𝑦∗ and 𝜃𝑢∗ that are adopted in the capacity verifications
depend on the corresponding values calculated under the assumptions above, according to the
following equations of Annex A of EN1998-3:2005:
The yield moment:
𝑀𝑦∗ = 𝑀𝑦 (A.18) EC8: Part 3
The chord rotation at yield:
𝜃𝑦∗ = 1.05𝜃𝑦 (A.19a) EC8: Part 3
The ultimate chord rotation:
𝜃𝑢∗ = 𝜃𝑢 (A.20) EC8: Part 3
FRP wrapping
The contribution of the FRP wrapping to members’ capacity is taken into account, according to Annex
A of EN1998-3:2005, as described below:
The effect of FRP wrapping on the members' flexural resistance at yielding is neglected, with the θy
computed in accordance with A3.2.1(2) to (4).
The total chord rotation capacity and its plastic part for the members of rectangular sections with
corners rounded is calculated through the expressions (A.1) and (A.3), respectively, with the exponent
of the term due to confinement increased by αρfff,e, where α is the confinement effectiveness factor, ρf
the FRP ratio parallel to the loading direction and ff,e the effectiveness stress given from the (A.35)
equation of EC8: Part 3.
Shear Capacity
The shear capacity of beams, columns and walls is calculated through the following expression
according to Annex A of EN1998-3:2005, as controlled by the stirrups, accounting for the reduction
due to the plastic part of ductility demand.
VR =
1 h−x pl
min N; 0,55Ac fc + 1 − 0,05 min 5; μΔ ∙
γ el 2L V
Where γel is equal to 1,15 for primary seismic elements and to 1,0 for secondary ones, the rest of the
variables are calculated as defined in A.3.3.1 of Annex A of EN1998-3.
The shear strength of a concrete wall is not taken greater than the value corresponding to failure by
web crushing, VR,max, which under cyclic loading is calculated according to A3.3.1(2) of Annex A of
EN1998-3:2005 from the following expression:
pl
0,85 1−0,06min 5;μ Δ N
VR,max = 1 + 1,8min 0,15; 1 + 0,25max 1,75; 100ρtot ∙ 1−
γ el A c fc
If in a concrete column the shear span ratio (LV/h) at the end section with the maximum of the two end
moments is less or equal to 2, the shear strength is not taken greater than the value corresponding to
the failure by web crushing along the diagonal of the column after flexural yielding, VR,max, which under
cyclic loading is calculated according to A3.3.1(3) of Annex A of EN1998-3:2005 from the following
expression:
4 pl
7 1 − 0,02min 5; μΔ N
VR,max = 1 + 1,35 1 + 0,45 100ρtot min 40; fc bw z sin 2δ
γel Ac fc
(A.16) EC8: Part 3
Where δ is the angle between the diagonal and the axis of the column (tan δ = h 2LV ).
Concrete Jacketing
The following assumptions are made in order to evaluate the strength of the jacketed members,
according to Annex A of EN1998-3:2005: (i) the jacketed element behaves monolithically, (ii) the full
axial load is assumed to act on the jacketed member, disregarding the fact that the axial load is
originally applied to the old column, and (iii) the concrete properties of the jacket are assumed to
apply over the full section of the element.
The value for the shear capacity, 𝑉𝑅∗ , of the jacketed members that is adopted in the capacity
verifications depend on the corresponding value calculated under the assumptions above, according to
the following equation of Annex A of EN1998-3:2005:
VR∗ = 0.9VR (A.17) EC8: Part 3
FRP wrapping
According to section A.4.4.2(9) of Annex A of EN1998-3:2005, in members with their plastic hinge
region fully wrapped in an FRP jacket over a length at least equal to the member depth, the cyclic
resistance VR, may be calculated from expression (A.12) of EC8: Part 3 adding in Vw the contribution of
the FRP jacket to shear resistance. The contribution of the FRP jacket to V w is computed through the
following expression:
Vw ,f = 0,5ρf bw zfu,fd (A.33) EC8: Part 3
where ρf is the geometric ratio of the FRP, z the length of the internal lever arm and fu,fd the design
value of the FRP ultimate strength.
Masonry Elements
All the masonry element checks (shear capacity, bending moment and drift) should be carried out for
all the elements of every floor, according to Annex C of EN1998-3:2005, considering the members as
primary or secondary seismic elements, designated in accordance with the definitions in EN1998-
1:2004, 4.2.2(1)P, (2) and (3).
The shear force capacity of unreinforced masonry walls controlled by shear under an axial load N is
calculated according to the following expression:
Vf = fvd D′ t (C.2) EC8: Part 3
514 SeismoStruct User Manual
Drift
The capacity of unreinforced masonry walls may be expressed in terms of drift, which is calculated
from the following equations:
For primary seismic walls controlled by flexure:
H0
0,008 ∙ D C.4.2.1(2) EC8: Part 3
For secondary seismic walls controlled by flexure:
H0
0,012 ∙ D C.4.2.1(2) EC8: Part 3
The drift for masonry walls and spandrels with reinforcement controlled by shear is taken equal to
0,004 for primary seismic walls and 0,006 for secondary ones, according to C.4.3.1(2) of EC8: Part 3.
Capacity Curve
Each pushover analysis leads to a capacity curve, which is a relationship between the total base shear
and the horizontal displacement of a representative point of the structure, termed “control node”, with
the values of the control displacement ranging between zero and a maximum value defined by the
user, which should correspond to 150% of the target displacement.
TARGET DISPLACEMENT
The target displacement is defined as the seismic demand derived from the elastic response spectrum
in terms of displacement of an equivalent single-degree-of-freedom system. To define the target
displacement of a MDOF system a number of steps have to be followed according to Annex B of
EN1998-1.
The following relation between normalized lateral forces F i and normalized displacements Φi is
assumed:
Fi = mi Φi
Where mi is the mass in the i-th storey.
Displacements are normalized in such a way that Φn=1, where n is the control node, consequently
Fn=mn.
m∗ = mi Φi = Fi
dn
d∗ =
Γ
Where Fb and dn are, respectively, the base shear force and the control node displacement of the Multi
Degree of Freedom (MDOF) system.
Based on this assumption, the yield displacement on the idealized SDOF system d y* is given by:
∗
Em
d∗y = 2 d∗m −
Fy∗
Where Em* is the actual deformation energy up to the formation of the plastic mechanism.
PERFORMANCE REQUIREMENTS
According to ASCE 41-17 section 2.2, the objectives of the assessment or redesign (Table C2-2) consist
of combinations of both a performance level and a seismic action, given an "acceptable probability of
exceedance within the life cycle of the building" (design earthquake), as shown in Table C2-2 of ASCE
41-17 below.
Target Building Performance Levels
Immediate
Seismic Hazard Operational Life Safety
Occupancy Collapse Prevention
Level Performance Performance
Performance Performance Level
Level Level
Level (5-D)
(1-A) (3-C)
(1-B)
50%/50years a b c d
BSE-1E
e f g h
(20%/50 years)
BSE-2E
i j k l
(5%/50 years)
BSE-2N
m n o p
(2%/50 years)
Table C2-2. Performance Objectives
The target building performance levels refer to the state of damage in the structure defined through
four limit states, namely Operational Level (1-A), Immediate Occupancy (1-B), Life Safety (3-C) and
Collapse Prevention (5-D).
components are damaged, although partitions and infills have not failed out-of-plane. Moderate
permanent drifts are present.
Minimum Knowledge
The minimum data collection requirements corresponds to a state of knowledge where information is
obtained from design drawings with sufficient information to analyse component demands and
calculate component capacities. The design drawings show the configuration of the gravity load system
and seismic-force-resisting system with sufficient details. Information is verified by a visual condition
assessment.
In the absence of sufficient information from design drawings, incomplete or nonexistent information
is supplemented by a comprehensive condition assessment, including destructive and non-destructive
investigation. In the absence of material test records and quality assurance reports default material
properties are used according to section 10.2.2.5 of ASCE 41-17.
Usual Knowledge
The usual data reliability level corresponds to a state of knowledge where information is obtained
from design drawings with sufficient information to analyse component demands and calculate
component capacities. The design drawings show the configuration of the gravity load system and
seismic-force-resisting system with sufficient details. Information is verified by a visual condition
assessment.
In the absence of sufficient information from design drawings, incomplete or nonexistent information
is supplemented by a comprehensive condition assessment, including destructive and non-destructive
investigation. In the absence of material test records and quality assurance reports default material
properties are used according to section 10.2.2.5 of ASCE 41-17.
Comprehensive Knowledge
The comprehensive data reliability level corresponds to a state of knowledge where information is
obtained from construction documents including design drawings, specifications, material test records,
Appendix H 519
and quality assurance reports covering original construction and subsequent modifications to the
structure. Information is verified by a visual condition assessment.
In cases where construction documents are incomplete, missing information is supplemented by
comprehensive condition assessment, including destructive and non-destructive investigation. In the
absence of material test records and quality assurance reports, material properties are determined by
comprehensive materials testing in accordance to section 10.2.2.4.2 of ASCE 41-17.
Safety Factors
In ASCE 41-17 the safety factors are directly incorporated in the member’s strengths and deformation
limits, and should not be defined.
In members where the longitudinal spacing of transverse reinforcement exceeds half the component
effective depth measured in the direction of shear, transverse reinforcement shall be assumed 50%
effective in resisting shear. Also, in members where the longitudinal spacing of transverse
reinforcement exceeds the component effective depth measured in the direction of shear, transverse
reinforcement shall be assumed ineffective in resisting shear. Users may decide in the Safety Factors
dialog box, whether to enforce such very strict rule or not. For more information on this rule, users
may refer to section 10.3.4 of ASCE 41-17.
Deformation Capacity
The deformation capacity of beams, columns and walls controlled by flexure is defined in terms of the
total chord rotation θ, that is the angle between the tangent to the axis at the yielding end and the
chord connecting that end with the end of the shear span (L V=M/V=moment/shear at the end section)..
The chord rotation is also equal to the element drift ratio, which is the deflection at the end of the
shear span with respect to the tangent to the axis at the yielding end divided by the shear span.
Deformation capacity of beams, columns and walls controlled by flexure is highly influenced by the
lack of appropriate seismic resistant detailing in longitudinal reinforcement, as well as whether there
are smooth bars. Inadequate development of splicing along the span (beams) and height (columns)
and inadequate embedment into beam-column joints can control the members’ response to seismic
action, drastically limiting its capacity, in respect to the situation in which the reinforcement is
considered fully effective. The above limitations to the deformation capacity are taken into
consideration.
The total chord rotation capacity at ultimate of concrete members under cyclic loading is calculated as
the sum of the chord rotation at yielding and the plastic part of the chord rotation capacity
θ = θy + θp
The chord rotation capacity at yield, θy, is calculated as described below:
For beams and columns from the equation of D.Biskinis (2007):
My Ls
θy =
3EIeff
where the effective stiffness value , EIeff, is calculated according to Table 10-5 of ASCE 41-17.
For walls from equation (10-5) of ASCE 41-17:
M yE
θyE = lp (10-5) ASCE 41-17
EI eff
520 SeismoStruct User Manual
The plastic part of the chord rotation capacity is calculated as indicated below:
For beams according to Table 10-7 of ASCE 41-17
For columns according to Table 10-8 of ASCE 41-17
For walls controlled by flexure according to Table 10-19 of ASCE 41-17
The deformation capacity of walls controlled by shear is defined in terms of the interstorey drift ratio
as indicated in Table 10-20 of ASCE 41-17.
The yield moment capacity is calculated according to the equations of Appendix 7A of KANEPE.
Users are advised to refer to the relevant publications for the definition of the other parameters and
further details on the expressions.
FRP wrapping
The contribution of the FRP wrapping to members’ capacity is taken into account in the calculation of
the yield moment capacity.
Shear Capacity
The Shear capacity of columns is calculated through the following expression according to section
10.4.2.3 of ASCE 41-17.
A v f ytL /E d 6 f ′cL /E N UG
VCol = k nl VCol 0 = k nl 𝛼Col +λ 1+ 0.8Ag (lb/in.2 units)
s M UD V UD d
6A g f ′cL /E
or
N
l W 0.1λ f ′c +0.2 u
lW h
Vc = 0.05λ fc′ + M u lW hd (e)
−
Vu 2
The value for Vn at any horizontal section for shear in plane of wall shall not be taken greater than
0.83 fc′ hd according to section 11.5.4.3 of ACI 318-14.
The shear capacity of beam sections is calculated from the equation (22.5.1.1) of ACI 318-14, with the
shear strength provided by the transverse reinforcement computed from equation (22.5.10.5.3) of ACI
Appendix H 521
318-14 and the shear strength provided by concrete computed by the detailed calculation of section
22.5.5.1 of ACI 318-14.
Vu d
0.16λ fc′ + 17𝜌w bw d;
Mu
0.29λ fc′ bw d
Users are advised to refer to the relevant publications for the definition of the other parameters and
further details on the expressions.
FRP wrapping
The shear resistance Vn, may be calculated from expression (10-3) of ASCE 41-17 for columns or the
equation (22.5.1.1) of ACI 318-14 for beams and shear walls adding in V s the contribution of the FRP
jacket to the shear resistance.
The contribution of the FRP jacket to the shear resistance is computed through the following
expression multiplied by a reduction factor ψf, as described in section 11.4 of ACI 440:
A fv f fe sina +cosa d fv
Vf = (11-3) ACI 440
sf
where
Afv = 2nt f wf (11-4) ACI 440
and
ffe = εfe Ef (11-5) ACI 440
The total shear strength provided by the sum of the FRP shear reinforcement and the steel shear
reinforcement should be limited as indicated in the equation below:
Vs + Vf ≤ 8 fc′ bw d in in-lb units
Masonry Elements
All the masonry element checks (shear capacity, bending moment capacity, compression capacity and
drift) should be carried out for all the elements of every floor, according to Section 11.3.2 of ASCE 41-
17 and Sections 9.3.4.1 and 9.3.5 of TMS 402, considering the members as primary or secondary
seismic elements, designated in accordance with the definitions in EN1998-1:2004, 4.2.2(1)P, (2) and
(3).
and
p sp h 2sp b sp p sp
Vfl,r = 1− (11-16) ASCE 41-17
l sp 0.85f hm
The shear strength of unreinforced masonry spandrel is computed as the lesser value calculated from
the following expressions:
2
Vs1 = cbj + μf psp hsp bsp (11-17) ASCE 41-17
3
and
f ′dt p sp
Vs2 = 2 1+ hsp bsp (11-18) ASCE 41-17
2.3 1+
l sp f ′dt f dt
2h sp
Where equation (11-17) is the peak shear strength associated with the formation of cracks through
head and bed joints over almost the entire height of the spandrel and equation (11-18) is used when
fracture of the masonry units will occur.
Masonry Walls/Spandrels with reinforcement
The shear force capacity of masonry walls and spandrels with reinforcement is computed using the
following equations:
Vn = Vnm + Vns γg (Equation 9-21) TMS 402
Where Vn shall not exceed the following:
If Mu Vu dv ≤ 0.25
Vn ≤ 6Anv fm′ γg (Equation 9-22) TMS 402
If Mu Vu dv ≥ 1.0
Vn ≤ 4Anv fm′ γg (Equation 9-23) TMS 402
Users are advised to refer to the Code for the definition of the parameters and further details on the
expressions.
Compressive Capacity
The nominal axial compressive strength shall not exceed Equation 9-19 or Equations 9-20, as
appropriate:
For members having an h/r ratio not greater than 99
Appendix H 523
h 2
Pn = 0.80 0.80fm′ An − A st + fy Ast 1− (Equation 9-19) TMS 402
140 r
Users are advised to refer to the Code for the definition of the parameters and further details on the
expressions.
The Bending moment capacity of masonry walls and spandrels with reinforcement is calculated based
in the following expression of section 9.3.5.2 of TMS 402:
t sp − α t sp
Mn = Pu φ + As fy + As fy d −
2 2
where
As fy + Pu φ
α=
0.80fm′ b
The above equations are valid for both centered and noncentered flexural reinforcement. In the case of
centered flexural reinforcement, d=tsp/2, the bending moment capacity is obtained as:
α
Mn = Pu φ + As fy d −
2
Users are advised to refer to the Code for the definition of the parameters and further details on the
expressions.
Drift
The capacity of unreinforced masonry walls and spandrels may be expressed in terms of drift, which is
calculated from the Table 11-4 of ASCE 41-17.
524 SeismoStruct User Manual
CAPACITY CURVE
Each pushover analysis leads to a capacity curve, which is a relationship between the total base shear
and the horizontal displacement of a representative point of the structure, termed “control node”, with
the values of the control displacement ranging between zero and a maximum value defined by the
user.
TARGET DISPLACEMENT
The target displacement is defined as the seismic demand derived from the elastic response spectrum
in terms of displacement of an equivalent single-degree-of-freedom system. To define the target
displacement of a MDOF system a number of steps have to be followed according to C7.3.4.2 of NTC-18.
The following relation between normalized lateral forces F i and normalized displacements Φi is
assumed:
Fi = mi Φi
Where mi is the mass in the i-th storey.
Displacements are normalized in such a way that Φn=1, where n is the control node, consequently
Fn=mn.
where Sα is the response spectrum acceleration at the effective fundamental period and damping ratio
of the building in the direction under consideration, as calculated in Sections 2.4.1 or 2.4.2 of ASCE 41-
17, and C0, C1 and C2 are modification factors that are defined as follows:
C0: Modification factor that relates the spectral displacement of the equivalent single degree of
freedom (SDOF) system with the roof displacement of the building muli degree of freedom (MDOF)
system calculated using the appropriate value from Table 7-5.
Other
Shear Buildings
Number of Buildings
Stories Triangular Load Pattern Uniform Load Pattern Any Load
(1.1, 1.2, 1.3) (2.1) Pattern
1 1.0 1.0 1.0
2 1.2 1.15 1.2
3 1.2 1.2 1.3
5 1.3 1.2 1.4
10+ 1.3 1.2 1.5
where α is the site class factor (is equal to 130 for site class A or B, 90 for site class C and 60 for site
class D, E, or F), Τe is the fundamental period of the building in the direction under consideration and
μstrength is the ratio of the elastic strength demand to yield strength coefficient calculated in accorgance
with equation (7-31) of ASCE 41-17.
C2: Modification factor to represent the effect of pinched hysteresis shape, cyclic stiffness degradation,
and strength deterioration on the maximum displacement response. For periods greater than 0.7,
C2=1.0;
1 μ strength −1 2
C2 = 1 + (7-30) ASCE 41-17
800 Te
Where the strength ratio μstrength is calculated according to the following equation:
Sα
μstrength = Cm (7-31) ASCE 41-17
Vy W
Cm is the effective mass factor with values according to Table 7-4 of ASCE 41-17.
Users are advised to refer to the Code for the definition of the other parameters and further details on
the expressions.
The equivalent lateral stiffness Ke is determined as the secant stiffness that corresponds to a base
shear force equal to the 60% of the effective yield strength Vy, the latter defined by the intersection of
the lines above. The normalized inclination (α1) of the second branch is determined by a straight line
passing through the point (Vd, Δd) and a point at the intersection with the first line segment such that
the areas above and below the actual curve are approximately balanced. (Vd, Δd) shall be a point on the
actual force-displacement curve at the calculated target displacement, or at the displacement
corresponding to the maximum shear, whichever is least.
where Ti is the elastic fundamental period in the direction under consideration, and is derived by
eigenvalue analysis, Ki is the corresponding elastic lateral stiffness, and K e is the effective lateral
stiffness.
Appendix H3 - NTC-18
In this appendix the parameters used for the structures assessment according to the Italian National
Seismic Code – NTC-18 are presented.
PERFORMANCE REQUIREMENTS
According to NTC-18, performance requirements refer to the state of damage in the structure defined
through four limit states, namely Operational Level (SLC), Damage Limitation (SLD), Life Safety (SLV)
and Collapse Prevention (SLC).
Confidence Factors
In the following table of section C8A.1.B.3 of the commentary of NTC-18 a summary and
recommendations for the confidence factors and the analysis methods are provided for each
knowledge level.
Geometry
Level of Structural Materials Methods of
(structural FC
knowledge details Properties analysis
work)
Project
Usual values
simulated in
for building
compliance linear
practice era
LC1 with analysis static 1.35
and limited
standards era or dynamic
evidence in-
and limited
situ
checks insitu
from the
specifications
original
Construction
project or by
drawings
From original test
incomplete
outline certificates
LC2 with limited All 1.20
construction original with
checks situ or
drawings limited
extensive
with sample evidence in-
checks insitu
visual survey situ or
or from full extensive
survey testing in-situ
By test
certificates
original or
Construction
from original
drawings full
specifications
with limited
LC3 of project All 1.00
checks situ or
with
exhaustive
extensive
testing in-situ
tests in situ or
extensive
testing in-situ
Table C8.5.IV of commentary of NTC-18- Knowledge Levels as a function of the available
information, consequent methods of analysis and allowed values of the confidence factors for
reinforced concrete or steel buildings
Appendix H 531
Safety Factors
The values of the safety factors and the Code expressions employed may be specified through the
dialog box that opens from the corresponding button. It is noted the default values of the safety factors
are those defined in NTC-18.
Deformation Capacity
The deformation capacity of beams, columns and walls is defined in terms of the chord rotation θ, that
is the angle between the tangent to the axis at the yielding end and the chord connecting that end with
the end of the shear span (LV=M/V=moment/shear at the end section). The chord rotation is also equal
to the element drift ratio, which is the deflection at the end of the shear span with respect to the
tangent to the axis at the yielding end divided by the shear span.
Deformation capacity of beams and columns is highly influenced by the lack of appropriate seismic
resistant detailing in longitudinal reinforcement, as well as by the bars type, that is whether there are
smooth bars. Inadequate development of splicing along the span (beams) and height (columns); and
inadequate embedment into beam-column joints can control the members’ response to seismic action,
drastically limiting its capacity in respect to the situation in which the reinforcement is considered
fully effective. The above limitations to the deformation capacity are taken into consideration.
The value for the chord rotation capacity for the limit state of collapse prevention (SLC) is the value of
the total chord rotation capacity at ultimate of concrete members under cyclic loading, which is
calculated from the following expression:
532 SeismoStruct User Manual
For walls:
LV LV db fy
θy = φy + 0,002 1 − 0,125 + 0,13φy (8.7.2.7b) commentary of NTC-18
3 h fc
Where γel is equal to 1,5 for primary seismic elements and to 1,0 for secondary seismic ones; L V is the
ratio between bending moment, M, and shear force, V. The remaining relevant parameters are defined
in section C8.7.2.3.4 of the commentary of NTC-18.
The yield curvature of the end section is calculated according to the following expression for the
sections whose compressive zone is of constant width and for the case that the section’s yielding is due
to steel yielding.
fy
φy = 1 r y =
Es 1 − ξ y d
If the section yields due to the deformation non-linearities of the concrete in compression, that is for
deformation of the edge compressive fibre larger than εc ≈ 1.8 fc Ec , then the yield curvature is
calculated according to the following expression:
εc 1.8fc
φy = 1 r y = ≈
ξ y d Ec ξ y d
The lower from the two values above is used for the calculation of the chord rotation capacity.
According to section C8.7.2.3.2 of the commentary of NTC-18 the chord rotation capacity is highly
influenced by a number of different factors such as the type of the longitudinal bars. If smooth (plain)
longitudinal bars are applied, the ultimate chord rotation should be multiplied by the factor calculated
from equation 8.7.2.4 of the commentary of NTC-18, taking, also, into consideration whether the
longitudinal bars are well lapped or not by employing the factor of 8.7.2.3. In case of members with
lack of appropriate seismic resistant detailing the ultimate chord rotation capacity is multiplied by
0,85.
In the case of circular column sections, the equations above cannot be employed for the calculation of
the elements’ chord rotation capacity. In SeismoStruct the following equations suggested by D. Biskinis
and M.N. Fardis [2013] are employed for θy and θu.
LV + αV z 2 Ls φy dbL fy
θy = φy + 0.0027 1 − min 1; + αsl
3 15 D 8 fc
Appendix H 533
Where fy and fc values are in MPa, αV=1 if VRc<VMy, VRc is calculated according to Eurocode 2 (CEN
2004), otherwise αV=0, and αsl=0 if pull-out of the tension bars from their anchorage zone beyond the
yielding end is physically impossible, otherwise αsl=1.
θu = θy + φu − φy Lpl 1 − 0.5 Lpl Ls + αsl Δθu,slip γel
Where γel is equal to 2.0 for primary seismic elements and to 1.0 for secondary seismic elements,
Δθu,slip and Lpl are calculated according to the following equations:
Δθu,slip = 10dbl φu + φy 2
1 Ls
Lpl = 0.6D 1 + min 9;
6 D
Users are advised to refer to the relevant publications for the definition of the other parameters and
further details on the expression.
Concrete Jacketing
The values of the jacketed members for 𝑀𝑦∗ , 𝜃𝑦∗ and 𝜃𝑢∗ that are adopted in the capacity verifications
depend on the corresponding values calculated under the requirements of section C8.7.2.3.2 of the
commentary of NTC-18, according to the following equations of section C8.7.4.2.1 of the commentary
of NTC-18:
The yield moment:
𝑀𝑦∗ = 0.9𝑀𝑦 (8.7.4.2) commentary of NTC-18
The chord rotation at yield:
𝜃𝑦∗ = 0.9𝜃𝑦 (8.7.4.3) commentary of NTC-18
The ultimate chord rotation:
𝜃𝑢∗ = 𝜃𝑢 (8.7.4.4) commentary of NTC-18
FRP wrapping
The contribution of the FRP wrapping to the members’ capacity is taken into account according to
Annex A of EN1998-3:2005, as described below:
The effect of FRP wrapping on the members' flexural resistance at yielding, computed in accordance
with equations C8.7.4.2.3 of the commentary of NTC-18, is neglected.
The total chord rotation capacity and its plastic part for the members of rectangular sections with
corners rounded is calculated through the expressions 8.7.2.1 of the commentary of NTC-18,
respectively, with the exponent of the term due to confinement increased by αρfff,e, where α is the
confinement effectiveness factor, ρf the FRP ratio parallel to the loading direction and f f,e the
effectiveness stress given from the (A.35) equation of EC8: Part 3.
Shear Capacity
Shear capacity is calculated through the expressions defined in section 4.1.2.3.5 of NTC-18 and section
C.8.7.2.3.5 of the commentary of NTC-18, depending on the value of the ductility demand.
In cases where the value of the ductility demand is less than 1 the shear capacity is calculated from
equation 4.1.23 of NTC-18, which corresponds to the elements without taking into consideration the
transverse reinforcement:
1 3
VRd = 0,18 ∙ k ∙ 100 ∙ ρ1 ∙ fck γc + 0,15 ∙ ςcp ∙ bw ∙ d; (vmin + 0,15 ∙ ςcp ) ∙ bw ∙ d
(4.1.23) NTC-18
534 SeismoStruct User Manual
When the value of the ductility demand is between 1 and 2, then the shear capacity is equal to the
maximum value obtained from the equations 4.1.29 of NTC-18 and 8.7.2.8 of the commentary of NTC-18.
The equations 4.1.29 of NTC-18 corresponds to the shear capacity of the elements taking into
consideration the transverse reinforcement.
VRd = min VRsd , VRcd (4.1.29) NTC-18
where VRsd is the shear strength that corresponds to the contribution of the shear reinforcement and is
calculated according to the equation below:
A sw
VRsd = 0,9 ∙ d ∙ ∙ fyd ∙ ctgα + ctgθ ∙ sinα (4.1.27) NTC-18
s
and VRcd is the shear strength that corresponds to the confined concrete core and is calculated according
to the following equation:
VRcd = 0,9 ∙ d ∙ bw ∙ αc ∙ v ∙ fcd ∙ ctgα + ctgθ 1 + ctg2 θ (4.1.28) NTC-18
The equation 8.7.2.8 of the commentary of NTC-18 corresponds to the shear capacity as controlled by
the stirrups, accounting for the reduction due to the plastic part of ductility demand.
VR =
1 h−x
min N; 0,55Ac fc + 1 − 0,05 min 5; 𝜇Δ,pl ∙
γ el 2L V
LV
0,16 max 0,5; 100ρtot 1 − 0,16 min 5; fc Ac + Vw (8.7.2.8) commentary of NTC-18
h
where γel is equal to 1,15 for primary seismic elements and to 1,0 for secondary ones, the other
variables are calculated as defined in section C.8.7.2.3.5 of the commentary of NTC-18.
If the value of the ductility demand is greater than 3, the shear capacity is calculated from equation
8.7.2.8 of the commentary of NTC-18.
Finally, linear interpolation should be executed for values of ductility demand between 2 and 3.
Concrete Jacketing
The value for the shear capacity, 𝑉𝑅∗ , of the jacketed members that is adopted in the capacity
verifications depend on the corresponding value calculated under the assumptions of section
C8.7.4.2.1 of the commentary of NTC-18, according to the following equation:
VR∗ = 0.9VR (8.7.4.1) commentary of NTC-18
FRP wrapping
The cyclic resistance VR, may be calculated from the section 4.1 of NTC-18 adding to Vw the
contribution of the FRP jacket to shear resistance. The contribution of the fully wrapped FRP jacket to
Vw is computed according to 4.19 equation of CNR-DT 200 R1/2013 in the following form:
1
VRd ,f = ∙ 0.9 ∙ d ∙ ffed ∙ 2 ∙ t f ∙ cotθ + cotβ ∙ sin β
γRd
Masonry Elements
All the masonry element checks (shear capacity, bending moment and drift) should be carried out for
all the elements of every floor, according to sections 7.8.2.2 and 7.8.3.2 of NTC-18 and section
C8.7.1.3.1.1 of Commentary of NTC-18.
1.5τ0d ς0 ftd ς0
Vt = l ∙ t 1+ =l∙t 1+
b 1.5τ0d b ftd
In some cases, it is necessary to take the lower value between the different expressions above. For
example, in the case of Unreinforced Masonry Wall with bricks the Commentary of the NTC-18
requires to take the lower value between the Turnšek-Čačovič and Mann-Müller criterion.
The Bending moment capacity of unreinforced masonry spandrels calculated according to the
following expression:
h Hp
Mu = Hp ∙ ∙ 1 − (7.8.5) NTC-18
2 0,85∙f bd ∙h∙t
The Bending moment capacity of masonry walls and spandrels with reinforcement is calculated based
in the following expression of section 9.3.5.2 of TMS 402:
t sp − α t sp
Mn = Pu φ + As fy + As fy d −
2 2
536 SeismoStruct User Manual
where
As fy + Pu φ
α=
0.80fm′ b
The above equations are valid for both centered and noncentered flexural reinforcement. In the case of
centered flexural reinforcement, d=tsp/2, the bending moment capacity is obtained as:
α
Mn = Pu φ + As fy d −
2
Users are advised to refer to the Code for the definition of the parameters and further details on the
expressions.
Drift
The capacity of masonry walls may be expressed in terms of drift. The drift for masonry walls
controlled by flexure is taken equal to 0,01 for walls without reinforcement and 0,016 for walls with
reinforcement, according to sections 7.8.2.2.1 and 7.8.3.2.1 of NTC-18. Further, the drift for masonry
walls controlled by shear is taken equal to 0,005 for walls without reinforcement and 0,008 for for
walls with reinforcement, according to section 7.8.2.2.2 and 7.8.3.2.2 of NTC-18.
CAPACITY CURVE
Each pushover analysis leads to a capacity curve, which is a relationship between the total base shear
and the horizontal displacement of a representative point of the structure, termed “control node”, with
the values of the control displacement ranging between zero and a maximum value defined by the
user.
TARGET DISPLACEMENT
The target displacement is defined as the seismic demand derived from the elastic response spectrum
in terms of displacement of an equivalent single-degree-of-freedom system. To define the target
displacement of a MDOF system a number of steps have to be followed according to C7.3.4.2 of NTC-18.
The following relation between normalized lateral forces F i and normalized displacements Φi is
assumed:
Fi = mi Φi
Where mi is the mass in the i-th storey.
Displacements are normalized in such a way that Φn=1, where n is the control node, consequently
Fn=mn.
system is determined in such a way that the areas under the actual and the idealized force-deformation
curves are equal, as shown in the figure C7.3.1 of NTC-18 below:
Figure C7.3.1 of commentary of NTC-18: Determination of the idealized elasto-perfectly plastic force-
displacement relationship of NTC-18
The capacity curve of the equivalent system must be replaced by an idealized bilinear curve, which has
a linear first branch and an elastic, perfectly plastic, second branch (see Fig. C7.3.1). The idealized
capacity curve is defined by two points, the first one corresponds to 0,6F bu*, where Fbu* = FBU/Γ is the
maximum resistance of the equivalent system and F BU the maximum resistance of the real structural
system. The second point corresponds to the yielding strength F y*, which can be defined graphically, on
the criterion of approximately equal areas of the sections defined above and below the intersection of
the real and the idealized curves for the maximum displacement d u* that corresponds to a reduction of
the resistance ≤0,15Fbu*.
PERFORMANCE REQUIREMENTS
According to NTC-08, performance requirements refer to the state of damage in the structure defined
through four limit states, namely Operational Level (SLC), Damage Limitation (SLD), Life Safety (SLV)
and Collapse Prevention (SLC).
Confidence Factors
In the following table of section C8A.1.B.3 of the commentary of NTC-08 a summary and
recommendations for the confidence factors and the analysis methods are provided for each
knowledge level.
Geometry
Level of Structural Materials Methods of
(structural FC
knowledge details Properties analysis
work)
Project
Usual values
simulated in
for building
compliance linear
practice era
LC1 with analysis static 1.35
and limited
standards era or dynamic
evidence in-
and limited
situ
checks insitu
from the
specifications
original
Construction
project or by
drawings
From original test
incomplete
outline certificates
LC2 with limited All 1.20
construction original with
checks situ or
drawings limited
extensive
with sample evidence in-
checks insitu
visual survey situ or
or from full extensive
survey testing in-situ
By test
certificates
original or
Construction
from original
drawings full
specifications
with limited
LC3 of project All 1.00
checks situ or
with
exhaustive
extensive
testing in-situ
tests in situ or
extensive
testing in-situ
Table C8A.1.2 of commentary of NTC-08- Knowledge Levels as a function of the available
information, consequent methods of analysis and allowed values of the confidence factors for
reinforced concrete or steel buildings
Appendix H 541
Safety Factors
The values of the safety factors and the Code expressions employed may be specified through the
dialog box that opens from the corresponding button. It is noted the default values of the safety factors
are those defined in NTC-08.
Deformation Capacity
The deformation capacity of beams, columns and walls is defined in terms of the chord rotation θ, that
is the angle between the tangent to the axis at the yielding end and the chord connecting that end with
the end of the shear span (LV=M/V=moment/shear at the end section). The chord rotation is also equal
to the element drift ratio, which is the deflection at the end of the shear span with respect to the
tangent to the axis at the yielding end divided by the shear span.
Deformation capacity of beams and columns is highly influenced by the lack of appropriate seismic
resistant detailing in longitudinal reinforcement, as well as by the bars type, that is whether there are
smooth bars. Inadequate development of splicing along the span (beams) and height (columns); and
inadequate embedment into beam-column joints can control the members’ response to seismic action,
drastically limiting its capacity in respect to the situation in which the reinforcement is considered
fully effective. The above limitations to the deformation capacity are taken into consideration.
The value for the chord rotation capacity for the limit state of collapse prevention (SLC) is the value of
the total chord rotation capacity at ultimate of concrete members under cyclic loading, which is
calculated from the following expression:
542 SeismoStruct User Manual
For walls:
LV LV db fy
θy = φy + 0,002 1 − 0,125 + 0,13φy (8.7.2.1b) commentary of NTC-08
3 h fc
Where γel is equal to 1,5 for primary seismic elements and to 1,0 for secondary seismic ones; L V is the
ratio between bending moment, M, and shear force, V. The remaining relevant parameters are defined
in section C8.7.2.5 of the commentary of NTC-08.
The yield curvature of the end section is calculated according to the following expression for the
sections whose compressive zone is of constant width and for the case that the section’s yielding is due
to steel yielding.
fy
φy = 1 r y =
Es 1 − ξ y d
If the section yields due to the deformation non-linearities of the concrete in compression, that is for
deformation of the edge compressive fibre larger than εc ≈ 1.8 fc Ec , then the yield curvature is
calculated according to the following expression:
εc 1.8fc
φy = 1 r y = ≈
ξ y d Ec ξ y d
The lower from the two values above is used for the calculation of the chord rotation capacity.
According to section C8A.6.1 of the commentary of NTC-08 the chord rotation capacity is highly
influenced by a number of different factors such as the type of the longitudinal bars. If smooth (plain)
longitudinal bars are applied, the ultimate chord rotation should be multiplied by the factor calculated
from equation C8A.6.4 of the commentary of NTC-08, taking, also, into consideration whether the
longitudinal bars are well lapped or not by employing the factor of C8A.6.3. In case of members with
lack of appropriate seismic resistant detailing the ultimate chord rotation capacity is multiplied by
0,85.
In the case of circular column sections, the equations above cannot be employed for the calculation of
the elements’ chord rotation capacity. In SeismoStruct the following equations suggested by D. Biskinis
and M.N. Fardis [2013] are employed for θy and θu.
LV + αV z 2 Ls φy dbL fy
θy = φy + 0.0027 1 − min 1; + αsl
3 15 D 8 fc
Appendix H 543
Where fy and fc values are in MPa, αV=1 if VRc<VMy, VRc is calculated according to Eurocode 2 (CEN
2004), otherwise αV=0, and αsl=0 if pull-out of the tension bars from their anchorage zone beyond the
yielding end is physically impossible, otherwise αsl=1.
θu = θy + φu − φy Lpl 1 − 0.5 Lpl Ls + αsl Δθu,slip γel
Where γel is equal to 2.0 for primary seismic elements and to 1.0 for secondary seismic elements,
Δθu,slip and Lpl are calculated according to the following equations:
Δθu,slip = 10dbl φu + φy 2
1 Ls
Lpl = 0.6D 1 + min 9;
6 D
Users are advised to refer to the relevant publications for the definition of the other parameters and
further details on the expression.
Concrete Jacketing
The values of the jacketed members for 𝑀𝑦∗ , 𝜃𝑦∗ and 𝜃𝑢∗ that are adopted in the capacity verifications
depend on the corresponding values calculated under the requirements of sections C8A.6 and C8.7.2.5
of the commentary of NTC-08, according to the following equations of section C8A.7 of the
commentary of NTC-08:
The yield moment:
𝑀𝑦∗ = 0.9𝑀𝑦 (C8A.7.2) commentary of NTC-08
The chord rotation at yield:
𝜃𝑦∗ = 0.9𝜃𝑦 (C8A.7.3) commentary of NTC-08
The ultimate chord rotation:
𝜃𝑢∗ = 𝜃𝑢 (C8A.7.4) commentary of NTC-08
FRP wrapping
The contribution of the FRP wrapping to the members’ capacity is taken into account according to
Annex A of EN1998-3:2005, as described below:
The effect of FRP wrapping on the members' flexural resistance at yielding, computed in accordance
with equations 8.7.2.1 of the commentary of NTC-08, is neglected.
The total chord rotation capacity and its plastic part for the members of rectangular sections with
corners rounded is calculated through the expressions ((C8A.6.1) of the commentary of NTC-08,
respectively, with the exponent of the term due to confinement increased by αρfff,e, where α is the
confinement effectiveness factor, ρf the FRP ratio parallel to the loading direction and f f,e the
effectiveness stress given from the (A.35) equation of EC8: Part 3.
Shear Capacity
Shear capacity is calculated through the following expression according to section 4.1.2.1.3 of NTC-08.
VR = max[VRd , min VRsd , VRcd ]
VRd is the shear resistance that corresponds to the elements without taking into consideration the
transverse reinforcement:
1 3
VRd = 0,18 ∙ k ∙ 100 ∙ ρ1 ∙ fck γc + 0,15 ∙ ςcp ∙ bw ∙ d ≥ (vmin + 0,15 ∙ ςcp ) ∙ bw ∙ d
(4.1.14) NTC-08
VRsd is the shear strength that corresponds to the contribution of the shear reinforcement and is
calculated according to the equation below:
544 SeismoStruct User Manual
A sw
VRsd = 0,9 ∙ d ∙ ∙ fyd ∙ ctgα + ctgθ ∙ sinα (4.1.18) NTC-08
s
Finally, VRcd is the shear strength that corresponds to the confined concrete core and is calculated
according to the following equation:
′
VRcd = 0,9 ∙ d ∙ bw ∙ αc ∙ fcd ∙ ctgα + ctgθ 1 + ctg2 θ (4.1.19) NTC-08
Concrete Jacketing
The value for the shear capacity, 𝑉𝑅∗ , of the jacketed members that is adopted in the capacity
verifications depend on the corresponding value calculated under the assumptions of section C8A.7.1
of the commentary of NTC-08, according to the following equation:
VR∗ = 0.9VR (C8A.7.1) commentary of NTC-08
FRP wrapping
The cyclic resistance VR, may be calculated from the section 4.1 of NTC-08 adding to Vw the
contribution of the FRP jacket to shear resistance. The contribution of the fully wrapped FRP jacket to
Vw is computed according to 4.19 equation of CNR-DT 200 R1/2013 in the following form:
1
VRd ,f = ∙ 0.9 ∙ d ∙ ffed ∙ 2 ∙ t f ∙ cotθ + cotβ ∙ sin β
γRd
Masonry Elements
All the masonry element checks are carried out according to NTC-18.
CAPACITY CURVE
Each pushover analysis leads to a capacity curve, which is a relationship between the total base shear
and the horizontal displacement of a representative point of the structure, termed “control node”, with
the values of the control displacement ranging between zero and a maximum value defined by the
user.
TARGET DISPLACEMENT
The target displacement is defined as the seismic demand derived from the elastic response spectrum
in terms of displacement of an equivalent single-degree-of-freedom system. To define the target
displacement of a MDOF system a number of steps have to be followed according to C7.3.4.1 of NTC-08.
The following relation between normalized lateral forces F i and normalized displacements Φi is
assumed:
Fi = mi Φi
Where mi is the mass in the i-th storey.
Displacements are normalized in such a way that Φn=1, where n is the control node, consequently
Fn=mn.
Where Fb and dc are the base shear force at the control node and the displacement of the Multi Degree
of Freedom (MDOF) system, respectively.
Figure C7.3.1 of commentary of NTC-08: Determination of the idealized elasto-perfectly plastic force-
displacement relationship of NTC-08
The capacity curve of the equivalent system must be replaced by an idealized bilinear curve, which has
a linear first branch and an elastic, perfectly plastic, second branch (see Fig. C7.3.1). The idealized
capacity curve is defined by two points, the first one corresponds to 0,6F bu*, where Fbu* = FBU/Γ is the
maximum resistance of the equivalent system and F BU the maximum resistance of the real structural
system. The second point corresponds to the yielding strength F y*, which can be defined graphically, on
the criterion of approximately equal areas of the sections defined above and below the intersection of
the real and the idealized curves for the maximum displacement du* that corresponds to a reduction of
the resistance ≤0,15Fbu*.
Where q∗ = Se T ∗ m∗ Fy∗ is the ratio between the acceleration in the structure with unlimited elastic
behaviour, Se(T*), and the structure with limited strength Fy*/m*.
In cases where q∗ ≤ 1 then d∗max = d∗e,max .
PERFORMANCE REQUIREMENTS
According to KANEPE section 2.2, the objectives of the assessment or redesign (Table 2.1) consist of
combinations of both a performance level and a seismic action, given an "acceptable probability of
exceedance within the life cycle of the building" (design earthquake), as shown in Table 2.1 of KANEPE
below.
Probability of Target Building Performance Levels
exceedance of
seismic action
within a
conventional Immediate Occupancy Life Safety Collapse Prevention
life cycle of 50
years
10% A1 B1 C1
50% A2 B2 C2
The target building performance levels refer to the state of damage in the structure defined through
three limit states, namely Immediate Occupancy (A), Life Safety (B) and Collapse Prevention (C).
Tolerable DRL
The tolerable data reliability level corresponds to a state of knowledge where the overall structural
geometry and member sizes are known from survey or from original outline construction drawings
used for both the original construction and any subsequent modifications, as well as a sufficient
sample of dimensions of both overall geometry and member sizes checked on site. In case of significant
discrepancies from the outline construction drawings a fuller dimensional survey is performed. The
structural details are not known from detailed construction drawings and are assumed based on
simulated design in accordance with usual practice at the time of construction. Limited inspections
performed in the most critical elements should prove that the assumptions correspond to the actual
situation. Information on the mechanical properties of the construction materials isn’t available so
default values are assumed in accordance with standards at the time of construction accompanied by
limited in-situ testing in the most critical elements.
Structural evaluation based on this state of knowledge is performed through linear analysis methods,
either static or dynamic.
Sufficient DRL
The sufficient data reliability level corresponds to a state of knowledge where the overall structural
geometry and member sizes are known from extended survey or from outline construction drawings
used for both the original construction and any subsequent modifications, as well as a sufficient
sample of dimensions of both overall geometry and member sizes. The structural details are known
from an extended in-situ inspection or from incomplete detailed construction drawings in combination
with limited in-situ inspections in the most critical elements, which confirms that the available
information corresponds to the actual situation. Information on the mechanical properties of the
construction materials is available from extended in-situ testing or from original design specifications
and limited in-situ testing.
Structural evaluation based on this state of knowledge is performed through linear or nonlinear
analysis methods, either static or dynamic.
High DRL
The high reliability level corresponds to a state of knowledge where the overall structural geometry
and member sizes are known from a comprehensive survey or from the complete set of outline
construction drawings used for both the original construction and subsequent modifications, as well as
a sufficient sample of both overall geometry and member sizes checked on site. The structural details
are known from comprehensive in-situ inspection or from a complete set of detailed construction
drawings in combination with limited in-situ inspections in the most critical elements, which prove
that the available information corresponds to the actual situation. Information on the mechanical
properties of the construction materials is available from comprehensive in-situ testing or from
original test reports and limited in-situ testing.
Appendix H 549
Structural evaluation based on this state of knowledge is performed through linear or nonlinear
analysis methods, either static or dynamic.
Safety Factors
The recommended values for the safety and partial factors corresponding to the achieved data
reliability level, as defined in section 4.5 of KANEPE, are introduced in the Safety Factors module. Users
may edit the assigned values.
Deformation Capacity
The deformation capacity of beams, columns and walls is defined in terms of the chord rotation θ, that
is the angle between the tangent to the axis at the yielding end and the chord connecting that end with
the end of the shear span (Ls=M/V=moment/shear at the end section). The chord rotation is also equal
to the element drift ratio, which is the deflection at the end of the shear span with respect to the
tangent to the axis at the yielding end divided by the shear span.
Deformation capacity of beams and columns is highly influenced by the lack of appropriate seismic
resistant detailing in longitudinal reinforcement, as well as whether there are smooth bars and the
accessibility of area of intervention. Inadequate development of splicing along the span (beams) and
height (columns); and inadequate embedment into beam-column joints can control the members
response to seismic action, drastically limiting its capacity in respect to the situation in which the
reinforcement is considered fully effective. The above limitations to the deformation capacity are taken
into consideration.
550 SeismoStruct User Manual
The value for the chord rotation capacity for the performance level of immediate occupancy (A) is the
value of the chord rotation capacity at flexural yield, θy, which is calculated from the equations (S.2a)
and (S.2b) of KANEPE:
For beams and columns:
1
L s +α V z h r y db fy
θy = 1 r y
+ 0,0014 1 + 1,5 + (S.2a) KANEPE
3 Ls 8 fc
For walls:
1
L s +α V z r y db fy
θy = 1 r y
+ 0,0013 + (S.2b) KANEPE
3 8 fc
Where Ls is the ratio between bending moment, M, and shear force, V; and aV is equal to 1,0 if the value
of the shear force VR1, which causes diagonal cracking of the element, is less than the value of the shear
force during flexural yielding VMu=My/Ls, or 0 otherwise.
The value for the chord rotation capacity for the performance level of life safety (B) is calculated from
the following equation, according to section 9.3.1 of KANEPE.
θd = 0,5 θy + θum 𝛾Rd
Where θy is calculated according to (S.2a) and (S.2b) equations and θum according to (S.11a) and
(S.11b) equations of KANEPE.
The value for the chord rotation capacity for the performance level of collapse prevention (C) is the
mean value of the chord rotation capacity at failure, which is calculated according to equation S.11a of
KANEPE, from the following expressions:
For beams and columns designed and constructed based on post-1985 provisions on seismic
design, from:
0,225 f yw
max 0,01;ω ′ αρ s
θum = 0,016 ∙ (0,3ν ) fc ∙ αs 0,35
25 fc (1,25100 ρ d ) (S.11a) KANEPE
max 0,01;ω−ω ′
For walls with rectangular section designed and constructed based on post-1985 provisions
on seismic design, taking into consideration the paragraph ii) of the commentary of section
7.2.4.1b, from:
0,225 f yw
max 0,01;ω ′ αρ sx
θum = 0,01 ∙ (0,3ν ) fc ∙ αs 0,35
25 fc (1,25100 ρ d ) (S.11a) KANEPE
max 0,01;ω−ω ′
The values above are divided by the γRd factor, according to section 9.3.1 of KANEPE.
The total chord rotation capacity at ultimate of concrete members under cyclic loading may be also
calculated as the sum of the chord rotation at yielding and the plastic part of the chord rotation
capacity calculated from the following expression:
For beams and columns designed and constructed based on post-1985 provisions on seismic
design, from:
0,3 f yw
pl max 0,01;ω ′ αρ s
θum = θu − θy = 0,0145 ∙ (0,25ν ) fc 0,2
αs 0,35
25 fc (1,275100 ρ d )
max 0,01;ω−ω ′
(S.11b) KANEPE
For walls with rectangular section designed and constructed based on post-1985 provisions
on seismic design, taking into consideration the paragraph ii) of the commentary of section
7.2.4.1b, from:
0,3 f yw
pl max 0,01;ω ′ αρ s
θum = θu − θy = 0,0087 ∙ (0,25ν ) fc 0,2
αs 0,35
25 fc (1,275100 ρ d )
max 0,01;ω−ω ′
(S.11b) KANEPE
For elements with deformed bars designed and constructed according the pre-1985 rules applying in
Greece, the values calculated based on equations S.11a and S.11b above need to be divided by 1.2.
Appendix H 551
The yield curvature of the end section is calculated according to the following equation (Appendix 7A
of KANEPE), for the sections whose compressive zone is of constant width and for the case that the
section’s yielding is due to steel yielding.
fy
φy = 1 r y = (A.1) KANEPE
E s 1−ξ y d
If the section yields due to the deformation non-linearities of the concrete in compression, that is for
deformation of the edge compressive fibre larger than εc ≈ 1.8 fc Ec , then the yield curvature is
calculated according to the following expression, of Appendix 7A of KANEPE:
εc 1.8f c
φy = 1 r y = ≈ (A.2) KANEPE
ξy d Ec ξy d
The lower from the two values above is used for the calculation of the chord rotation capacity.
According to section 7.2.4 of KANEPE the chord rotation capacity is highly influenced by several
factors such as the year of construction. If the structure has been constructed with Regulations before
1985 then the mean values of chord rotation capacity and the plastic part of the mean chord rotation
are divided by 1.2. Moreover, if the deformed longitudinal bars have straight ends lapped starting at
the end section of the member, the plastic part of chord rotation is calculated with the value of the
compression reinforcement ratio, ω’, doubled over the value applying outside the lap splice. In
addition, in sections where the reinforcement lap length l b is less than the minimum lap length for
ultimate deformation lbu,min, the plastic part of the chord rotation capacity is multiplied by the ratio
lb/lbu,min (information about the calculation of lbu,min can be found in section 7.2.4 of KANEPE, while the
value for chord rotation at yielding, θy accounts for the effect of the lapping in accordance with section
7.2.2 of KANEPE). Finally, if smooth (plain) longitudinal bars are applied, the values obtained for
ribbed bars are multiplied with a factor equal to 95% and in case of having elements with
reinforcement lap length lb less than 15db, the mean value of the chord rotation at failure is multiplied
by a factor available in section 7.2.4 of KANEPE.
In the case of circular column sections, the equations above cannot be employed for the calculation of
the elements’ chord rotation capacity. In SeismoStruct the following equations suggested by D. Biskinis
and M.N. Fardis [2013] are employed for θy and θu.
LV + αV z 2 Ls φy dbL fy
θy = φy + 0.0027 1 − min 1; + αsl
3 15 D 8 fc
Where fy and fc values are in MPa, αV=1 if VRc<VMy, VRc is calculated according to Eurocode 2 (CEN
2004), otherwise αV=0, and αsl=0 if pull-out of the tension bars from their anchorage zone beyond the
yielding end is physically impossible, otherwise αsl=1.
θu = θy + φu − φy Lpl 1 − 0.5 Lpl Ls + αsl Δθu,slip γel
Where γel is equal to 2.0 for elements designed with the pre-1985 provisions about seismic design and
to 1.0 for elements designed and constructed according to the post-1985 rules applying in Greece,
Δθu,slip and Lpl are calculated according to the following equations:
Δθu,slip = 10dbl φu + φy 2
1 Ls
Lpl = 0.6D 1 + min 9;
6 D
Users are advised to refer to the relevant publications for the definition of the other parameters and
further details on the expression.
552 SeismoStruct User Manual
Concrete Jacketing
The values of the jacketed members for 𝑀𝑦∗ , 𝜃𝑦∗ and 𝜃𝑢∗ that are adopted in the capacity verifications
depend on the corresponding values calculated under the requirements of section 8.2.1 of KANEPE,
according to the following equations of section 8.2.1.5(η) of KANEPE:
The yield moment:
𝑀𝑦∗ = 0.90𝑀𝑦
The chord rotation at yield:
𝜃𝑦∗ = 1.25𝜃𝑦
The ultimate chord rotation:
𝜃𝑢∗ = 0.80𝜃𝑢
FRP wrapping
The contribution of the FRP wrapping to members’ capacity is taken into account, according to Annex
A of EN1998-3:2005, as described below:
The effect of FRP wrapping on the members' flexural resistance at yielding, computed in accordance
with section 7.2.2, is neglected.
The total chord rotation capacity and its plastic part for the members of rectangular sections with
corners rounded is calculated through the expressions (S.11a) and (S.11b), respectively, with the
exponent of the term due to confinement increased by αρfff,e, where α is the confinement effectiveness
factor, ρf the FRP ratio parallel to the loading direction and f f,e the effectiveness stress given from the
(A.35) equation of EC8: Part 3.
Shear Capacity
Shear capacity is calculated through the following expression according to Annex 7C of KANEPE, as
controlled by the stirrups, accounting also for the reduction due to the plastic part of ductility demand.
VR =
h−x pl
min N; 0,55Ac fc + 1 − 0,05 min 5; μθ 0,16 max 0,5; 100ρtot 1 − 0,16 min 5; αs fc Ac + Vw
2L s
(C.1) KANEPE
The shear strength of a shear wall may not be taken greater than the value corresponding to failure by
web crushing, VR,max, which under cyclic loading is calculated according to Annex 7C of KANEPE. from
the following expression:
pl N
VR,max = 0,85 1 − 0,06min 5; μθ 1 + 1,8min 0,15; 1 + 0,25max 1,75; 100ρtot ∙
A c fc
shear failure happens before flexural yielding. The sliding resistance may be calculated from the
following equation of Appendix 7C of KANEPE:
VR,SLS = Vi + Vf + Vd (C.6) KANEPE
with
Vi = Asi fyi cos φ (C.7) KANEPE
(C.14) KANEPE
Users are advised to refer to the relevant publication for the definition of the parameters and further
details on the expression.
The equations (C.1)-(C.3) and (C.4) may be used for walls with shear ratio αs≥1.0. For walls with low
shear ratio αs≤1.2, the shear capacity should be calculated from the following equation of Appendix 7C
of KANEPE:
VR,squat = Vsi + Vc (C.15) KANEPE
with
𝜌h bw min d − x tan 𝜃cr , Ls fyh
Vs = min (C.16) KANEPE
𝜌v bw min Ls tan 𝜃cr , d − x fyv + As fy tan 𝜃cr
and
2 N
Vc = 1 + 150ρ 1 − 0.725αs Ac fct 1 + (C.17) KANEPE
3 A c f ct
Users are advised to refer to the relevant publication for the definition of the parameters and further
details on the expressions.
Concrete Jacketing
The value for the shear capacity, 𝑉𝑅∗ , of the jacketed members that is adopted in the capacity
verifications depend on the corresponding value calculated under the requirements of section 8.2.1 of
KANEPE, according to the following equation of section 8.2.1.5(η) of KANEPE:
VR∗ = 0.9VR
FRP wrapping
The cyclic resistance VR, may be calculated from expression (C.1) of KANEPE adding in Vw the
contribution of the FRP jacket to the shear resistance. The contribution of the FRP jacket to V jd is
computed through the following expression:
Vjd = ςjd ρj bw hj,ef cotθ + cotα sin2 α (8.13) KANEPE
554 SeismoStruct User Manual
where ρf is the geometric ratio of the FRP, calculated according to (S8.8) equation of KANEPE.
Masonry Elements
All the masonry element checks are carried out according to Eurocodes.
CAPACITY CURVE
Each pushover analysis leads to a capacity curve, which is a relationship between the total base shear
and the horizontal displacement of a representative point of the structure, termed “control node”, with
the values of the control displacement ranging between zero and a maximum value defined by the
user.
TARGET DISPLACEMENT
The target displacement t (§ 5.7.4.2) shall be calculated taking into account all the relevant factors
affecting the displacement of a building that responds inelastically. It is permitted to consider the
displacement of an elastic single degree of freedom system with a fundamental period equal to the
fundamental period of the building that is subjected to the seismic actions for which the verification is
made. An appropriate correction is needed in order to derive the corresponding displacement of the
building assumed to be responding as an elastic-perfectly plastic system.
If a more accurate method is not used, the target displacement δ t can be calculated using the following
equation and be corrected (where necessary) according to §5.7.4.2 as follows:
δt = C0 ∙ C1 ∙ C2 ∙ C3 ∙ Te2 4π2 Se(T) (5.6) KANEPE
where Se(T) is the elastic spectral pseudo-acceleration (derived from the EC8 spectrum) corresponding
to the equivalent fundamental period of the structure Τe (the latter calculated using the point of
contraflexure in the force-displacement diagram of the system, as defined in equation S5.5 of § 5.7.3.5),
and C0, C1, C2 and C3 are correction factors that are defined as follows:
C0: Coefficient that relates the spectral displacement of the equivalent elastic system of stiffness Κ e
(Sd=[Te2/4π2] Se(T)), with the actual displacement δt of the top of the structure, which is assumed to be
responding as an elasto-plastic system (§ 5.7.3.4). The values of this coefficient can be taken equal to
1.0, 1.2, 1.3, 1.4, 1.5, for a number of storeys equal to 1, 2, 3, 5, and ≥ 10, respectively.
The ratio C1=δinel/δel of the maximum inelastic displacement of a building to the corresponding elastic
displacement may be obtained from the following relationships:
C1=1.0 for Τe ≥ ΤC , and
C1=[1.0+(R-1)TC/Τe]/R for Τe < ΤC ,
where ΤC is the corner period initiating the descending branch of the response spectrum (EC8-Part1)
and R=Vel/Vy the ratio of the elastic demand over the yield strength of the structure. This ratio can be
estimated from the relationship:
Se g
R= ∙ Cm (S5.7) KANEPE
Vy W
where the yield strength Vy is calculated by appropriate bilinearisation of the base shear vs. top
displacement relationship of the building, as defined in §5.7.3.4. For simplicity, (and conservatively),
the ratio Vy/W in equation can be taken equal to 0.15 for buildings with a dual structural system, and
0.10 for buildings with a pure frame system.
C2: Coefficient that takes into account the influence of the shape of the hysteresis loop at the maximum
displacement. Its values may be obtained from Table S5.1.
Appendix H 555
Figure 5.2 of KANEPE Idealisation of a (indicative) capacity curve with a bilinear curve
The equivalent lateral stiffness Ke is determined as the secant stiffness that corresponds to a force
equal to the 60% of the yielding force Vy, the latter defined by the intersection of the lines above. The
normalized inclination (α) of the second branch is determined by a straight line passing through the
point of the (actual) non-linear capacity curve that corresponds to the ultimate displacement (δ u),
beyond which a significant drop of the strength of the structure is observed (Figure 5.2). In any case,
the derived value of α must be positive (or zero), but not larger than 0.10 (in order to be compatible
556 SeismoStruct User Manual
with the other assumptions made by the method for estimating the target displacement δ t, such as the
coefficient C1). The recommended fraction of the resistance reduction is 15%, provided that no
primary vertical member has reached failure at this level (in such a case, the bilinearisation of the
curve shall be made for the displacement that corresponds to this failure).
where T is the elastic fundamental period in the direction under examination, and is derived by
eigenvalue analysis, K0 is the corresponding elastic lateral stiffness, and Ke is the equivalent lateral
stiffness.
Appendix H6 - TBDY
In this appendix the parameters used for the structures assessment according to the Turkish
Earthquake Building Regulations-TBDY are presented.
PERFORMANCE REQUIREMENTS
According to TBDY sections 2.2, 3.4 and 3.5, the objectives of the assessment or redesign consist of
combinations of both a performance level and a seismic action, given an "acceptable probability of
exceedance within the life cycle of the building" (design earthquake), as shown in the table below.
Target Building Performance Levels
Seismic Hazard
Level Continuous Use Immediate Occupancy Life Safety Collapse Prevention
(KK) (HK) (CG) (BP)
DD-4 d
a b c
(68%/50 years)
DD-3 h
e f g
(50%/50 years)
DD-2 l
i j k
(10%/50 years)
DD-1 p
m n o
(2%/50 years)
Building Performance Levels.
The target building performance levels refer to the state of damage in the structure defined through
four limit states, namely Continuous Use (KK), Immediate Occupancy (HK), Life Safety (CG) and
Collapse Prevention (BP).
however, the structure retains its ability to bear the prescribed vertical loads (during and for a period
after the earthquake), but without other substantial safety factor against total or partial collapse.
The criteria for the selection of the Performance Objectives may be found in TBDY.
Limited Knowledge
The limited knowledge level corresponds to a state of knowledge where information is obtained from
design drawings with sufficient information to analyse component demands and calculate component
capacities. The design drawings show the configuration of the gravity load system and seismic-force-
resisting system with sufficient details. Information is verified by a visual condition assessment. In the
absence of sufficient information from design drawings, incomplete or nonexistent information is
supplemented by a comprehensive condition assessment, including destructive and non-destructive
investigation.
Comprehensive Knowledge
The comprehensive knowledge level corresponds to a state of knowledge where information is
obtained from construction documents including design drawings, specifications, material tests
records, and quality assurance reports covering original construction and subsequent modifications to
the structure. Information is verified by a visual condition assessment. In cases where construction
documents are incomplete, missing information is supplemented by comprehensive condition
assessment, including destructive and non-destructive investigation. In the absence of material test
records and quality assurance reports, material properties are determined by comprehensive
materials testing in accordance to TBDY, Chapter 15.
Knowledge Factors
In the following table of section 15.2.12 of TBDY the confidence factors for each knowledge level are
shown.
Safety Factors
In TBDY the safety factors are directly incorporated in the member’s strengths and deformation limits.
Appendix H 559
Deformation Capacity
The deformation capacity of beams, columns and walls is defined in terms of the chord rotation θ, that
is the angle between the tangent to the axis at the yielding end and the chord connecting that end with
the end of the shear span (Ls=M/V=moment/shear at the end section). The chord rotation is also equal
to the element drift ratio, which is the deflection at the end of the shear span with respect to the
tangent to the axis at the yielding end divided by the shear span.
Chord rotation capacity of beams and columns is highly influenced by the lack of appropriate seismic
resistant detailing in longitudinal reinforcement, as well as whether there are smooth bars. Inadequate
development of splicing along the span (beams) and height (columns), and inadequate embedment
into beam-column joints can control the members’ response to seismic action, drastically limiting its
capacity in respect to the situation in which the reinforcement is considered fully effective. The above
limitations to the deformation capacity are taken into consideration.
The value for the chord rotation capacity for the performance levels of continuous use (KK) and
immediate occupancy (HK) is the value of the chord rotation capacity at flexural yield, θy, which is
calculated from the equations 5.3 and 5.8b of TBDY:
φ y Ls h φ y d b f ye
θy = + 0,0015η 1 + 1,5 + (5.3) TBDY
3 Ls 8 f ce
Where Ls is the ratio between bending moment, M, and shear force, V; and η is equal to 1,0 for beams
and columns and 0,5 for walls.
(HK )
θp =0 (5.8b) TBDY
The value for the chord rotation capacity for the performance level of life safety (CG) is calculated from
the following equation:
(CG )
θ(CG ) = θy + θp
Where θy is calculated according to (5.3) equation and θp(CG) according to (5.7b) equation of TBDY:
(CG ) (GO )
θp = 0,75θp (5.7b) TBDY
The value θp(GO) is calculated from the following equation:
(GO ) 2 Lp
θp = φu − φy Lp 1 − 0,5 + 4,5φu db (5.6) TBDY
3 Ls
The value for the chord rotation capacity for the performance level of collapse prevention (BP) is the
value of the chord rotation capacity at failure, which is calculated as the sum of the chord rotation at
yielding and the plastic part of the chord rotation capacity, according to equations 5.3 and 5.6 of TBDY.
θu = θy + θp
The yield curvature of the end section is calculated according to the following equation (Appendix 7A
of KANEPE), for the sections whose compressive zone is of constant width and for the case that the
section’s yielding is due to steel yielding.
fy
φy = 1 r y = (A.1) KANEPE
E s 1−ξ y d
If the section yields due to the deformation nonlinearities of the concrete in compression, that is for
deformation of the edge compressive fibre larger than εc ≈ 1.8 fc Ec , then the yield curvature is
calculated according to the following expression, of Appendix 7A of KANEPE:
560 SeismoStruct User Manual
εc 1.8f c
φy = 1 r y = ≈ (A.2) KANEPE
ξy d Ec ξy d
The lower from the two values above is used for the calculation of the chord rotation capacity.
The equations proposed by D. Biskinis [2007] are employed for the calculation of the ultimate
curvature at the end section. If the failure is due to steel rupture, then the ultimate curvature is
calculated according to the following expression:
εsu
φsu =
1 − ξsu d
If the section fails by crushing of the extreme concrete fibres, then the ultimate curvature is calculated
according to the following expression:
εcu
φcu =
ξcu d
Users are advised to refer to the relevant publications for the definition of the other parameters and
further details on the expression.
In the case of circular column sections, the equations above cannot be employed for the calculation of
the elements’ yield and ultimate curvatures. In SeismoBuild the equations suggested by D. Biskinis and
M. N. Fardis [2013] are employed for φy and φu.
Concrete Jacketing
The values of the jacketed members for θy∗ and θu∗ that are adopted in the capacity verifications depend
on the corresponding values calculated under the requirements of section 5 of TBDY, according to the
following limitations of section 15.10.1 of TBDY:
The chord rotation at yield:
θy∗ = 0.90θy
The ultimate chord rotation:
θu∗ = 0.90θu
FRP wrapping
The contribution of the FRP wrapping to members’ capacity is taken into account in the calculation of
the yield and ultimate curvature due to concrete failure.
Shear Capacity
Shear capacity is calculated through the following expression according to Appendix 15B of TBDY, as
controlled by the stirrups, accounting also for the increment due to the FRP wrapping.
Vr = Vc + Vw + Vf ≤ Vmax (15B.1) TBDY
where Vc is calculated according to equations 8.1 and 8.4 of TS500:
𝑁𝑑
Vcr = 0.65fctd bw d 1 + 𝛾 (8.1) TS500
𝐴𝑐
The contribution of the FRP jacket to the shear resistance is computed through the following
expression:
Appendix H 561
2 n f t f w f E f 𝜀f d
Vf = (15B.2) TBDY
sf
The shear strength of a member may not be taken greater than the value corresponding to failure by
web crushing, Vmax, which is calculated according to the following expression:
Vmax ≤ 0.22 fcd bw d (8.7) TS500
Concrete Jacketing
The value for the shear capacity, 𝑉𝑅∗ , of the jacketed members that is adopted in the capacity
verifications depend on the corresponding value calculated under the requirements of the Appendix
15B of TBDY, according to the following limitations of section 15.10.1 of TBDY:
VR∗ = 0.9VR
FRP wrapping
The contribution of the FRP jacket to the shear resistance is taken into account according to section
15B.3 of the Appendix 15B of TBDY, as shown above.
Masonry Elements
All the masonry element checks are carried out according to ASCE 41-17.
CAPACITY CURVE
Each pushover analysis leads to a capacity curve, which is a relationship between the total base shear
and the horizontal displacement of a representative point of the structure, termed “control node”, with
the values of the control displacement ranging between zero and a maximum value defined by the
user.
TARGET DISPLACEMENT
The target displacement is defined as the seismic demand derived from the elastic response spectrum
in terms of displacement of an equivalent single-degree-of-freedom system. To define the target
displacement of a MDOF system a number of steps have to be followed according to Appendix 5B of
TBDY.
The target displacement shall be calculated in accordance with equation (5B.12) of TBDY.
(X)
d1,max = Sdi (T1 ) (5B.12) TBDY
where
Sdi T1 = CR Sde T1 (5B.13) TBDY
Sde(T1) is the elastic spectral pseudo-acceleration corresponding to the equivalent fundamental period
of the structure T1 and CR is a modification factor to relate expected maximum inelastic displacements
to displacements calculated for linear elastic response. The value for CR is computed according to the
equation below:
μ R y ,T 1
CR = (5B.14) TBDY
Ry
where Ry is the yield reduction factor calculated from the following equation:
fe S ae T 1
Ry = = (5B.15) TBDY
fy αy 1
The equation (5B.14) for the modification factor CR takes the following form by using the equations
(5B.16) of TBDY:
CR = 1 for T1>TB (5B.17a) TBDY
562 SeismoStruct User Manual
TB
1+ R y −1
T1
CR = ≥ 1 for T1≤TB (5B.17b) TBDY
Ry